elf32-ppc.c revision 1.8 1 1.1 christos /* PowerPC-specific support for 32-bit ELF
2 1.8 christos Copyright (C) 1994-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 1.1 christos Written by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support.
4 1.1 christos
5 1.1 christos This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
6 1.1 christos
7 1.1 christos This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 1.1 christos it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 1.1 christos the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 1.1 christos (at your option) any later version.
11 1.1 christos
12 1.1 christos This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 1.1 christos but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 1.1 christos MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 1.1 christos GNU General Public License for more details.
16 1.1 christos
17 1.1 christos You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 1.1 christos along with this program; if not, write to the
19 1.1 christos Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor,
20 1.1 christos Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
21 1.1 christos
22 1.1 christos
23 1.1 christos /* This file is based on a preliminary PowerPC ELF ABI. The
24 1.1 christos information may not match the final PowerPC ELF ABI. It includes
25 1.1 christos suggestions from the in-progress Embedded PowerPC ABI, and that
26 1.1 christos information may also not match. */
27 1.1 christos
28 1.1 christos #include "sysdep.h"
29 1.1 christos #include <stdarg.h>
30 1.1 christos #include "bfd.h"
31 1.1 christos #include "bfdlink.h"
32 1.1 christos #include "libbfd.h"
33 1.1 christos #include "elf-bfd.h"
34 1.1 christos #include "elf/ppc.h"
35 1.1 christos #include "elf32-ppc.h"
36 1.1 christos #include "elf-vxworks.h"
37 1.1 christos #include "dwarf2.h"
38 1.7 christos #include "opcode/ppc.h"
39 1.1 christos
40 1.1 christos typedef enum split16_format_type
41 1.1 christos {
42 1.1 christos split16a_type = 0,
43 1.1 christos split16d_type
44 1.1 christos }
45 1.1 christos split16_format_type;
46 1.1 christos
47 1.1 christos /* RELA relocations are used here. */
48 1.1 christos
49 1.1 christos static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc
50 1.1 christos (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
51 1.1 christos static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc
52 1.1 christos (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
53 1.1 christos
54 1.1 christos /* Branch prediction bit for branch taken relocs. */
55 1.1 christos #define BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT 0x200000
56 1.1 christos /* Mask to set RA in memory instructions. */
57 1.1 christos #define RA_REGISTER_MASK 0x001f0000
58 1.1 christos /* Value to shift register by to insert RA. */
59 1.1 christos #define RA_REGISTER_SHIFT 16
60 1.1 christos
61 1.1 christos /* The name of the dynamic interpreter. This is put in the .interp
62 1.1 christos section. */
63 1.1 christos #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER "/usr/lib/ld.so.1"
64 1.1 christos
65 1.1 christos /* For old-style PLT. */
66 1.1 christos /* The number of single-slot PLT entries (the rest use two slots). */
67 1.1 christos #define PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES 8192
68 1.1 christos
69 1.1 christos /* For new-style .glink and .plt. */
70 1.1 christos #define GLINK_PLTRESOLVE 16*4
71 1.8 christos #define GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE(htab, h) \
72 1.8 christos ((4*4 \
73 1.8 christos + (h != NULL \
74 1.8 christos && h == htab->tls_get_addr \
75 1.8 christos && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt ? 8*4 : 0) \
76 1.8 christos + (1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align) - 1) \
77 1.8 christos & -(1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align))
78 1.1 christos
79 1.1 christos /* VxWorks uses its own plt layout, filled in by the static linker. */
80 1.1 christos
81 1.1 christos /* The standard VxWorks PLT entry. */
82 1.1 christos #define VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE 32
83 1.1 christos static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry
84 1.1 christos [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
85 1.1 christos {
86 1.8 christos 0x3d800000, /* lis r12,0 */
87 1.8 christos 0x818c0000, /* lwz r12,0(r12) */
88 1.8 christos 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
89 1.8 christos 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
90 1.8 christos 0x39600000, /* li r11,0 */
91 1.8 christos 0x48000000, /* b 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> */
92 1.8 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
93 1.8 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
94 1.1 christos };
95 1.1 christos static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
96 1.1 christos [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
97 1.1 christos {
98 1.1 christos 0x3d9e0000, /* addis r12,r30,0 */
99 1.1 christos 0x818c0000, /* lwz r12,0(r12) */
100 1.1 christos 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
101 1.1 christos 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
102 1.1 christos 0x39600000, /* li r11,0 */
103 1.1 christos 0x48000000, /* b 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> 14: R_PPC_REL24 .PLTresolve */
104 1.1 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
105 1.1 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
106 1.1 christos };
107 1.1 christos
108 1.1 christos /* The initial VxWorks PLT entry. */
109 1.1 christos #define VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE 32
110 1.1 christos static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry
111 1.1 christos [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
112 1.1 christos {
113 1.8 christos 0x3d800000, /* lis r12,0 */
114 1.8 christos 0x398c0000, /* addi r12,r12,0 */
115 1.8 christos 0x800c0008, /* lwz r0,8(r12) */
116 1.8 christos 0x7c0903a6, /* mtctr r0 */
117 1.8 christos 0x818c0004, /* lwz r12,4(r12) */
118 1.8 christos 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
119 1.8 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
120 1.8 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
121 1.1 christos };
122 1.1 christos static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
123 1.1 christos [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
124 1.1 christos {
125 1.1 christos 0x819e0008, /* lwz r12,8(r30) */
126 1.8 christos 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
127 1.1 christos 0x819e0004, /* lwz r12,4(r30) */
128 1.8 christos 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
129 1.8 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
130 1.8 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
131 1.8 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
132 1.8 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
133 1.1 christos };
134 1.1 christos
135 1.1 christos /* For executables, we have some additional relocations in
136 1.1 christos .rela.plt.unloaded, for the kernel loader. */
137 1.1 christos
138 1.1 christos /* The number of non-JMP_SLOT relocations per PLT0 slot. */
139 1.1 christos #define VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS 3
140 1.1 christos /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot. */
141 1.1 christos #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS 2
142 1.8 christos /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot when creating
143 1.1 christos a shared library. */
144 1.1 christos #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS_SHLIB 0
145 1.1 christos
146 1.1 christos /* Some instructions. */
147 1.1 christos #define ADDIS_11_11 0x3d6b0000
148 1.1 christos #define ADDIS_11_30 0x3d7e0000
149 1.1 christos #define ADDIS_12_12 0x3d8c0000
150 1.1 christos #define ADDI_11_11 0x396b0000
151 1.1 christos #define ADD_0_11_11 0x7c0b5a14
152 1.1 christos #define ADD_3_12_2 0x7c6c1214
153 1.1 christos #define ADD_11_0_11 0x7d605a14
154 1.1 christos #define B 0x48000000
155 1.3 christos #define BA 0x48000002
156 1.1 christos #define BCL_20_31 0x429f0005
157 1.1 christos #define BCTR 0x4e800420
158 1.1 christos #define BEQLR 0x4d820020
159 1.1 christos #define CMPWI_11_0 0x2c0b0000
160 1.1 christos #define LIS_11 0x3d600000
161 1.1 christos #define LIS_12 0x3d800000
162 1.1 christos #define LWZU_0_12 0x840c0000
163 1.1 christos #define LWZ_0_12 0x800c0000
164 1.1 christos #define LWZ_11_3 0x81630000
165 1.1 christos #define LWZ_11_11 0x816b0000
166 1.1 christos #define LWZ_11_30 0x817e0000
167 1.1 christos #define LWZ_12_3 0x81830000
168 1.1 christos #define LWZ_12_12 0x818c0000
169 1.1 christos #define MR_0_3 0x7c601b78
170 1.1 christos #define MR_3_0 0x7c030378
171 1.1 christos #define MFLR_0 0x7c0802a6
172 1.1 christos #define MFLR_12 0x7d8802a6
173 1.1 christos #define MTCTR_0 0x7c0903a6
174 1.1 christos #define MTCTR_11 0x7d6903a6
175 1.1 christos #define MTLR_0 0x7c0803a6
176 1.1 christos #define NOP 0x60000000
177 1.1 christos #define SUB_11_11_12 0x7d6c5850
178 1.1 christos
179 1.1 christos /* Offset of tp and dtp pointers from start of TLS block. */
180 1.1 christos #define TP_OFFSET 0x7000
181 1.1 christos #define DTP_OFFSET 0x8000
182 1.1 christos
183 1.1 christos /* The value of a defined global symbol. */
184 1.1 christos #define SYM_VAL(SYM) \
185 1.1 christos ((SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma \
186 1.1 christos + (SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_offset \
187 1.1 christos + (SYM)->root.u.def.value)
188 1.1 christos
189 1.8 christos /* Relocation HOWTO's. */
191 1.8 christos /* Like other ELF RELA targets that don't apply multiple
192 1.8 christos field-altering relocations to the same localation, src_mask is
193 1.8 christos always zero and pcrel_offset is the same as pc_relative.
194 1.8 christos PowerPC can always use a zero bitpos, even when the field is not at
195 1.8 christos the LSB. For example, a REL24 could use rightshift=2, bisize=24
196 1.8 christos and bitpos=2 which matches the ABI description, or as we do here,
197 1.8 christos rightshift=0, bitsize=26 and bitpos=0. */
198 1.8 christos #define HOW(type, size, bitsize, mask, rightshift, pc_relative, \
199 1.8 christos complain, special_func) \
200 1.8 christos HOWTO (type, rightshift, size, bitsize, pc_relative, 0, \
201 1.8 christos complain_overflow_ ## complain, special_func, \
202 1.8 christos #type, FALSE, 0, mask, pc_relative)
203 1.1 christos
204 1.1 christos static reloc_howto_type *ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_max];
205 1.1 christos
206 1.1 christos static reloc_howto_type ppc_elf_howto_raw[] = {
207 1.8 christos /* This reloc does nothing. */
208 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_NONE, 3, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
209 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
210 1.1 christos
211 1.8 christos /* A standard 32 bit relocation. */
212 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
213 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
214 1.1 christos
215 1.1 christos /* An absolute 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
216 1.8 christos FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
217 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
218 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
219 1.1 christos
220 1.8 christos /* A standard 16 bit relocation. */
221 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
222 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
223 1.1 christos
224 1.8 christos /* A 16 bit relocation without overflow. */
225 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
226 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
227 1.1 christos
228 1.8 christos /* The high order 16 bits of an address. */
229 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
230 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
231 1.1 christos
232 1.1 christos /* The high order 16 bits of an address, plus 1 if the contents of
233 1.8 christos the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
234 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
235 1.1 christos ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
236 1.1 christos
237 1.1 christos /* An absolute 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
238 1.8 christos FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
239 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
240 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
241 1.1 christos
242 1.1 christos /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
243 1.1 christos indicate that the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two
244 1.8 christos bits must be zero. */
245 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
246 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
247 1.1 christos
248 1.1 christos /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
249 1.1 christos indicate that the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower
250 1.8 christos two bits must be zero. */
251 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
252 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
253 1.1 christos
254 1.8 christos /* A relative 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
255 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
256 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
257 1.1 christos
258 1.8 christos /* A relative 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
259 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL14, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
260 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
261 1.1 christos
262 1.1 christos /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
263 1.1 christos the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two bits must be
264 1.8 christos zero. */
265 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
266 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
267 1.1 christos
268 1.1 christos /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
269 1.1 christos the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower two bits must
270 1.8 christos be zero. */
271 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
272 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
273 1.1 christos
274 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but referring to the GOT table entry for the
275 1.8 christos symbol. */
276 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
277 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
278 1.1 christos
279 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the GOT table entry for
280 1.8 christos the symbol. */
281 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
282 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
283 1.1 christos
284 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the GOT table entry for
285 1.8 christos the symbol. */
286 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
287 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
288 1.1 christos
289 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the GOT table entry for
290 1.8 christos the symbol. */
291 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
292 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
293 1.1 christos
294 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but referring to the procedure linkage table
295 1.8 christos entry for the symbol. */
296 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
297 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
298 1.1 christos
299 1.1 christos /* This is used only by the dynamic linker. The symbol should exist
300 1.1 christos both in the object being run and in some shared library. The
301 1.1 christos dynamic linker copies the data addressed by the symbol from the
302 1.1 christos shared library into the object, because the object being
303 1.8 christos run has to have the data at some particular address. */
304 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_COPY, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
305 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
306 1.1 christos
307 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but used when setting global offset table
308 1.8 christos entries. */
309 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GLOB_DAT, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
310 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
311 1.1 christos
312 1.8 christos /* Marks a procedure linkage table entry for a symbol. */
313 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_JMP_SLOT, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
314 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
315 1.1 christos
316 1.1 christos /* Used only by the dynamic linker. When the object is run, this
317 1.1 christos longword is set to the load address of the object, plus the
318 1.8 christos addend. */
319 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_RELATIVE, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
320 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
321 1.1 christos
322 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but uses the value of the symbol within the
323 1.1 christos object rather than the final value. Normally used for
324 1.8 christos _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
325 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_LOCAL24PC, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
326 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
327 1.1 christos
328 1.8 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but may be unaligned. */
329 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_UADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
330 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
331 1.1 christos
332 1.8 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but may be unaligned. */
333 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_UADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
334 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
335 1.1 christos
336 1.8 christos /* 32-bit PC relative */
337 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, TRUE, dont,
338 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
339 1.1 christos
340 1.1 christos /* 32-bit relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
341 1.8 christos FIXME: not supported. */
342 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLT32, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
343 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
344 1.1 christos
345 1.1 christos /* 32-bit PC relative relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
346 1.8 christos FIXME: not supported. */
347 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL32, 2, 32, 0, 0, TRUE, dont,
348 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
349 1.1 christos
350 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the PLT table entry for
351 1.8 christos the symbol. */
352 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
353 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
354 1.1 christos
355 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the PLT table entry for
356 1.8 christos the symbol. */
357 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
358 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
359 1.1 christos
360 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the PLT table entry for
361 1.8 christos the symbol. */
362 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
363 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
364 1.1 christos
365 1.1 christos /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA_BASE_, for use with
366 1.8 christos small data items. */
367 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_SDAREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
368 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
369 1.1 christos
370 1.8 christos /* 16-bit section relative relocation. */
371 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
372 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
373 1.1 christos
374 1.8 christos /* 16-bit lower half section relative relocation. */
375 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
376 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
377 1.1 christos
378 1.8 christos /* 16-bit upper half section relative relocation. */
379 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
380 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
381 1.1 christos
382 1.8 christos /* 16-bit upper half adjusted section relative relocation. */
383 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
384 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
385 1.1 christos
386 1.8 christos /* Marker relocs for TLS. */
387 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_TLS, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
388 1.8 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
389 1.8 christos
390 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_TLSGD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
391 1.8 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
392 1.8 christos
393 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_TLSLD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
394 1.8 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
395 1.8 christos
396 1.8 christos /* Marker relocs on inline plt call instructions. */
397 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLTSEQ, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
398 1.8 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
399 1.8 christos
400 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLTCALL, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
401 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
402 1.1 christos
403 1.1 christos /* Computes the load module index of the load module that contains the
404 1.8 christos definition of its TLS sym. */
405 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_DTPMOD32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
406 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
407 1.1 christos
408 1.1 christos /* Computes a dtv-relative displacement, the difference between the value
409 1.1 christos of sym+add and the base address of the thread-local storage block that
410 1.8 christos contains the definition of sym, minus 0x8000. */
411 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
412 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
413 1.1 christos
414 1.8 christos /* A 16 bit dtprel reloc. */
415 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
416 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
417 1.1 christos
418 1.8 christos /* Like DTPREL16, but no overflow. */
419 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
420 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
421 1.1 christos
422 1.8 christos /* Like DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
423 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
424 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
425 1.1 christos
426 1.8 christos /* Like DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
427 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
428 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
429 1.1 christos
430 1.1 christos /* Computes a tp-relative displacement, the difference between the value of
431 1.8 christos sym+add and the value of the thread pointer (r13). */
432 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_TPREL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
433 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
434 1.1 christos
435 1.8 christos /* A 16 bit tprel reloc. */
436 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
437 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
438 1.1 christos
439 1.8 christos /* Like TPREL16, but no overflow. */
440 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
441 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
442 1.1 christos
443 1.8 christos /* Like TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
444 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
445 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
446 1.1 christos
447 1.8 christos /* Like TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
448 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
449 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
450 1.1 christos
451 1.1 christos /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
452 1.1 christos with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes the offset
453 1.8 christos to the first entry. */
454 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
455 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
456 1.1 christos
457 1.8 christos /* Like GOT_TLSGD16, but no overflow. */
458 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
459 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
460 1.1 christos
461 1.8 christos /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
462 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
463 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
464 1.1 christos
465 1.8 christos /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
466 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
467 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
468 1.1 christos
469 1.1 christos /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
470 1.1 christos with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and zero, and computes the offset to the
471 1.8 christos first entry. */
472 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
473 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
474 1.1 christos
475 1.8 christos /* Like GOT_TLSLD16, but no overflow. */
476 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
477 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
478 1.1 christos
479 1.8 christos /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
480 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
481 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
482 1.1 christos
483 1.8 christos /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
484 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
485 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
486 1.1 christos
487 1.1 christos /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes
488 1.8 christos the offset to the entry. */
489 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
490 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
491 1.1 christos
492 1.8 christos /* Like GOT_DTPREL16, but no overflow. */
493 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
494 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
495 1.1 christos
496 1.8 christos /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
497 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
498 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
499 1.1 christos
500 1.8 christos /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
501 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
502 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
503 1.1 christos
504 1.1 christos /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@tprel, and computes the
505 1.8 christos offset to the entry. */
506 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
507 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
508 1.1 christos
509 1.8 christos /* Like GOT_TPREL16, but no overflow. */
510 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
511 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
512 1.1 christos
513 1.8 christos /* Like GOT_TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
514 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
515 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
516 1.1 christos
517 1.8 christos /* Like GOT_TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
518 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
519 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
520 1.1 christos
521 1.1 christos /* The remaining relocs are from the Embedded ELF ABI, and are not
522 1.1 christos in the SVR4 ELF ABI. */
523 1.1 christos
524 1.8 christos /* 32 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
525 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
526 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
527 1.1 christos
528 1.8 christos /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
529 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
530 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
531 1.1 christos
532 1.8 christos /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
533 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
534 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
535 1.1 christos
536 1.8 christos /* The high order 16 bits of the addend minus the symbol. */
537 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
538 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
539 1.1 christos
540 1.1 christos /* The high order 16 bits of the result of the addend minus the address,
541 1.1 christos plus 1 if the contents of the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number,
542 1.8 christos is negative. */
543 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
544 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
545 1.1 christos
546 1.1 christos /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
547 1.1 christos address in the .sdata section, and returning the offset from
548 1.8 christos _SDA_BASE_ for that relocation. */
549 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
550 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
551 1.1 christos
552 1.1 christos /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
553 1.1 christos address in the .sdata2 section, and returning the offset from
554 1.8 christos _SDA2_BASE_ for that relocation. */
555 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
556 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
557 1.1 christos
558 1.1 christos /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA2_BASE_, for use with
559 1.8 christos small data items. */
560 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
561 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
562 1.1 christos
563 1.1 christos /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling in the 16 bit
564 1.1 christos signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the register
565 1.8 christos field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13). */
566 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA21, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
567 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
568 1.1 christos
569 1.1 christos /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF */
570 1.1 christos /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16 */
571 1.1 christos /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO */
572 1.1 christos /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI */
573 1.1 christos /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA */
574 1.1 christos /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD */
575 1.1 christos
576 1.1 christos /* PC relative relocation against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling
577 1.1 christos in the 16 bit signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the
578 1.8 christos register field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13). */
579 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
580 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
581 1.1 christos
582 1.8 christos /* A relative 8 bit branch. */
583 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL8, 1, 8, 0xff, 1, TRUE, signed,
584 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
585 1.1 christos
586 1.8 christos /* A relative 15 bit branch. */
587 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL15, 2, 16, 0xfffe, 0, TRUE, signed,
588 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
589 1.1 christos
590 1.8 christos /* A relative 24 bit branch. */
591 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL24, 2, 25, 0x1fffffe, 0, TRUE, signed,
592 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
593 1.1 christos
594 1.8 christos /* The 16 LSBS in split16a format. */
595 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
596 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
597 1.1 christos
598 1.8 christos /* The 16 LSBS in split16d format. */
599 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
600 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
601 1.1 christos
602 1.8 christos /* Bits 16-31 split16a format. */
603 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
604 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
605 1.1 christos
606 1.8 christos /* Bits 16-31 split16d format. */
607 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
608 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
609 1.1 christos
610 1.8 christos /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16a format. */
611 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
612 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
613 1.1 christos
614 1.8 christos /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16d format. */
615 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
616 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
617 1.3 christos
618 1.3 christos /* This reloc is like R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 but only applies to e_add16i
619 1.3 christos instructions. If the register base is 0 then the linker changes
620 1.8 christos the e_add16i to an e_li instruction. */
621 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
622 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
623 1.3 christos
624 1.8 christos /* Like R_PPC_VLE_SDA21 but ignore overflow. */
625 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
626 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
627 1.1 christos
628 1.8 christos /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format. */
629 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
630 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
631 1.1 christos
632 1.8 christos /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format. */
633 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
634 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
635 1.1 christos
636 1.8 christos /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format. */
637 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
638 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
639 1.1 christos
640 1.8 christos /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format. */
641 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
642 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
643 1.1 christos
644 1.8 christos /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16a format. */
645 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
646 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
647 1.1 christos
648 1.8 christos /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16d format. */
649 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
650 1.8 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
651 1.8 christos
652 1.8 christos /* e_li split20 format. */
653 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20, 2, 20, 0x1f7fff, 0, FALSE, dont,
654 1.8 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
655 1.8 christos
656 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_IRELATIVE, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
657 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
658 1.1 christos
659 1.8 christos /* A 16 bit relative relocation. */
660 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, signed,
661 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
662 1.1 christos
663 1.8 christos /* A 16 bit relative relocation without overflow. */
664 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, dont,
665 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
666 1.1 christos
667 1.8 christos /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address. */
668 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
669 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
670 1.1 christos
671 1.1 christos /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address, plus 1 if the contents of
672 1.8 christos the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
673 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
674 1.1 christos ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
675 1.6 christos
676 1.8 christos /* Like R_PPC_REL16_HA but for split field in addpcis. */
677 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, TRUE, signed,
678 1.6 christos ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
679 1.7 christos
680 1.8 christos /* A split-field reloc for addpcis, non-relative (gas internal use only). */
681 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, FALSE, signed,
682 1.7 christos ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
683 1.1 christos
684 1.8 christos /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable hierarchy. */
685 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
686 1.1 christos NULL),
687 1.1 christos
688 1.8 christos /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable member usage. */
689 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
690 1.1 christos NULL),
691 1.1 christos
692 1.8 christos /* Phony reloc to handle AIX style TOC entries. */
693 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_TOC16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
694 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
695 1.1 christos };
696 1.1 christos
697 1.1 christos /* Initialize the ppc_elf_howto_table, so that linear accesses can be done. */
699 1.1 christos
700 1.1 christos static void
701 1.1 christos ppc_elf_howto_init (void)
702 1.1 christos {
703 1.1 christos unsigned int i, type;
704 1.1 christos
705 1.1 christos for (i = 0;
706 1.1 christos i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
707 1.1 christos i++)
708 1.1 christos {
709 1.1 christos type = ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].type;
710 1.1 christos if (type >= (sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table)
711 1.1 christos / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table[0])))
712 1.1 christos abort ();
713 1.1 christos ppc_elf_howto_table[type] = &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
714 1.1 christos }
715 1.1 christos }
716 1.1 christos
717 1.1 christos static reloc_howto_type *
718 1.1 christos ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
719 1.1 christos bfd_reloc_code_real_type code)
720 1.1 christos {
721 1.1 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r;
722 1.1 christos
723 1.1 christos /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
724 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
725 1.1 christos ppc_elf_howto_init ();
726 1.1 christos
727 1.1 christos switch (code)
728 1.1 christos {
729 1.1 christos default:
730 1.1 christos return NULL;
731 1.1 christos
732 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_NONE: r = R_PPC_NONE; break;
733 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_32: r = R_PPC_ADDR32; break;
734 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA26: r = R_PPC_ADDR24; break;
735 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
736 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16; break;
737 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
738 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_LO16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_LO; break;
739 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HI; break;
740 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HA; break;
741 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16: r = R_PPC_ADDR14; break;
742 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN; break;
743 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN; break;
744 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B26: r = R_PPC_REL24; break;
745 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16: r = R_PPC_REL14; break;
746 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN; break;
747 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN; break;
748 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
749 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16; break;
750 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
751 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_LO16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_LO; break;
752 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_HI; break;
753 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_HA; break;
754 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_24_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC_PLTREL24; break;
755 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_COPY: r = R_PPC_COPY; break;
756 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GLOB_DAT: r = R_PPC_GLOB_DAT; break;
757 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_LOCAL24PC: r = R_PPC_LOCAL24PC; break;
758 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL32; break;
759 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_32_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT32; break;
760 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_32_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC_PLTREL32; break;
761 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
762 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_LO; break;
763 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_HI; break;
764 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_HA; break;
765 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_GPREL16: r = R_PPC_SDAREL16; break;
766 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
767 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF; break;
768 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
769 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_LO16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO; break;
770 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI; break;
771 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA; break;
772 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_CTOR: r = R_PPC_ADDR32; break;
773 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
774 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TOC16: r = R_PPC_TOC16; break;
775 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLS: r = R_PPC_TLS; break;
776 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSGD: r = R_PPC_TLSGD; break;
777 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSLD: r = R_PPC_TLSLD; break;
778 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPMOD: r = R_PPC_DTPMOD32; break;
779 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
780 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16: r = R_PPC_TPREL16; break;
781 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
782 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO; break;
783 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HI; break;
784 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA; break;
785 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL: r = R_PPC_TPREL32; break;
786 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
787 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16; break;
788 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
789 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO; break;
790 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI; break;
791 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA; break;
792 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL: r = R_PPC_DTPREL32; break;
793 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16; break;
794 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO; break;
795 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI; break;
796 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA; break;
797 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16; break;
798 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO; break;
799 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI; break;
800 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA; break;
801 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16; break;
802 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO; break;
803 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI; break;
804 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA; break;
805 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16; break;
806 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO; break;
807 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI; break;
808 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA; break;
809 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR32: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32; break;
810 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16; break;
811 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO; break;
812 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI; break;
813 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA; break;
814 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDAI16: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16; break;
815 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16; break;
816 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL; break;
817 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA21: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA21; break;
818 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_MRKREF: r = R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF; break;
819 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16; break;
820 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO; break;
821 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI; break;
822 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA; break;
823 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD: r = R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD; break;
824 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSDA: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA; break;
825 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL8: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL8; break;
826 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL15: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL15; break;
827 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL24: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL24; break;
828 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16A; break;
829 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16D; break;
830 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16A; break;
831 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16D; break;
832 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16A; break;
833 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16D; break;
834 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21: r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21; break;
835 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO: r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO; break;
836 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
837 1.1 christos r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A;
838 1.1 christos break;
839 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
840 1.1 christos r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D;
841 1.1 christos break;
842 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
843 1.1 christos r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A;
844 1.1 christos break;
845 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
846 1.1 christos r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D;
847 1.1 christos break;
848 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
849 1.1 christos r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A;
850 1.1 christos break;
851 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
852 1.1 christos r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D;
853 1.1 christos break;
854 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16; break;
855 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_LO; break;
856 1.7 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_HI; break;
857 1.6 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_HA; break;
858 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_16DX_HA: r = R_PPC_16DX_HA; break;
859 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_REL16DX_HA: r = R_PPC_REL16DX_HA; break;
860 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT: r = R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT; break;
861 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY: r = R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY; break;
862 1.1 christos }
863 1.1 christos
864 1.1 christos return ppc_elf_howto_table[r];
865 1.1 christos };
866 1.1 christos
867 1.1 christos static reloc_howto_type *
868 1.1 christos ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
869 1.1 christos const char *r_name)
870 1.1 christos {
871 1.1 christos unsigned int i;
872 1.1 christos
873 1.1 christos for (i = 0;
874 1.1 christos i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
875 1.1 christos i++)
876 1.1 christos if (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name != NULL
877 1.1 christos && strcasecmp (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name, r_name) == 0)
878 1.1 christos return &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
879 1.1 christos
880 1.1 christos return NULL;
881 1.1 christos }
882 1.1 christos
883 1.8 christos /* Set the howto pointer for a PowerPC ELF reloc. */
884 1.7 christos
885 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
886 1.1 christos ppc_elf_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd,
887 1.1 christos arelent *cache_ptr,
888 1.5 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *dst)
889 1.5 christos {
890 1.1 christos unsigned int r_type;
891 1.1 christos
892 1.1 christos /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
893 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
894 1.5 christos ppc_elf_howto_init ();
895 1.5 christos
896 1.5 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info);
897 1.7 christos if (r_type >= R_PPC_max)
898 1.8 christos {
899 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
900 1.5 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
901 1.8 christos abfd, r_type);
902 1.5 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
903 1.8 christos return FALSE;
904 1.5 christos }
905 1.1 christos
906 1.1 christos cache_ptr->howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
907 1.1 christos
908 1.8 christos /* Just because the above assert didn't trigger doesn't mean that
909 1.1 christos ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info) is necessarily a valid relocation. */
910 1.7 christos if (cache_ptr->howto == NULL)
911 1.8 christos {
912 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
913 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
914 1.1 christos abfd, r_type);
915 1.8 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
916 1.1 christos
917 1.8 christos return FALSE;
918 1.8 christos }
919 1.1 christos
920 1.1 christos return TRUE;
921 1.1 christos }
922 1.1 christos
923 1.1 christos /* Handle the R_PPC_ADDR16_HA and R_PPC_REL16_HA relocs. */
924 1.7 christos
925 1.1 christos static bfd_reloc_status_type
926 1.1 christos ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd,
927 1.7 christos arelent *reloc_entry,
928 1.1 christos asymbol *symbol,
929 1.1 christos void *data,
930 1.1 christos asection *input_section,
931 1.1 christos bfd *output_bfd,
932 1.6 christos char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
933 1.6 christos {
934 1.6 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
935 1.6 christos long insn;
936 1.1 christos bfd_size_type octets;
937 1.1 christos bfd_vma value;
938 1.1 christos
939 1.1 christos if (output_bfd != NULL)
940 1.1 christos {
941 1.1 christos reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
942 1.1 christos return bfd_reloc_ok;
943 1.6 christos }
944 1.6 christos
945 1.6 christos reloc_entry->addend += 0x8000;
946 1.6 christos r_type = reloc_entry->howto->type;
947 1.6 christos if (r_type != R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
948 1.6 christos return bfd_reloc_continue;
949 1.6 christos
950 1.6 christos value = 0;
951 1.6 christos if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
952 1.6 christos value = symbol->value;
953 1.6 christos value += (reloc_entry->addend
954 1.6 christos + symbol->section->output_offset
955 1.6 christos + symbol->section->output_section->vma);
956 1.6 christos value -= (reloc_entry->address
957 1.6 christos + input_section->output_offset
958 1.6 christos + input_section->output_section->vma);
959 1.6 christos value >>= 16;
960 1.6 christos
961 1.6 christos octets = reloc_entry->address * bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd);
962 1.6 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
963 1.6 christos insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
964 1.6 christos insn |= (value & 0xffc1) | ((value & 0x3e) << 15);
965 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
966 1.1 christos return bfd_reloc_ok;
967 1.1 christos }
968 1.1 christos
969 1.1 christos static bfd_reloc_status_type
970 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc (bfd *abfd,
971 1.1 christos arelent *reloc_entry,
972 1.1 christos asymbol *symbol,
973 1.1 christos void *data,
974 1.1 christos asection *input_section,
975 1.1 christos bfd *output_bfd,
976 1.1 christos char **error_message)
977 1.1 christos {
978 1.1 christos /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
979 1.1 christos call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
980 1.1 christos link time. */
981 1.1 christos if (output_bfd != NULL)
982 1.1 christos return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
983 1.1 christos input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
984 1.1 christos
985 1.1 christos if (error_message != NULL)
986 1.1 christos {
987 1.1 christos static char buf[60];
988 1.1 christos sprintf (buf, _("generic linker can't handle %s"),
989 1.1 christos reloc_entry->howto->name);
990 1.1 christos *error_message = buf;
991 1.1 christos }
992 1.1 christos return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
993 1.1 christos }
994 1.1 christos
995 1.1 christos /* Sections created by the linker. */
997 1.1 christos
998 1.1 christos typedef struct elf_linker_section
999 1.1 christos {
1000 1.1 christos /* Pointer to the bfd section. */
1001 1.1 christos asection *section;
1002 1.1 christos /* Section name. */
1003 1.1 christos const char *name;
1004 1.1 christos /* Associated bss section name. */
1005 1.1 christos const char *bss_name;
1006 1.1 christos /* Associated symbol name. */
1007 1.1 christos const char *sym_name;
1008 1.1 christos /* Associated symbol. */
1009 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sym;
1010 1.1 christos } elf_linker_section_t;
1011 1.1 christos
1012 1.1 christos /* Linked list of allocated pointer entries. This hangs off of the
1013 1.1 christos symbol lists, and provides allows us to return different pointers,
1014 1.1 christos based on different addend's. */
1015 1.1 christos
1016 1.1 christos typedef struct elf_linker_section_pointers
1017 1.1 christos {
1018 1.1 christos /* next allocated pointer for this symbol */
1019 1.1 christos struct elf_linker_section_pointers *next;
1020 1.1 christos /* offset of pointer from beginning of section */
1021 1.1 christos bfd_vma offset;
1022 1.1 christos /* addend used */
1023 1.1 christos bfd_vma addend;
1024 1.1 christos /* which linker section this is */
1025 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_t *lsect;
1026 1.1 christos } elf_linker_section_pointers_t;
1027 1.1 christos
1028 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata
1029 1.1 christos {
1030 1.1 christos struct elf_obj_tdata elf;
1031 1.1 christos
1032 1.1 christos /* A mapping from local symbols to offsets into the various linker
1033 1.1 christos sections added. This is index by the symbol index. */
1034 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_pointers_t **linker_section_pointers;
1035 1.1 christos
1036 1.1 christos /* Flags used to auto-detect plt type. */
1037 1.1 christos unsigned int makes_plt_call : 1;
1038 1.1 christos unsigned int has_rel16 : 1;
1039 1.1 christos };
1040 1.1 christos
1041 1.1 christos #define ppc_elf_tdata(bfd) \
1042 1.1 christos ((struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata *) (bfd)->tdata.any)
1043 1.1 christos
1044 1.1 christos #define elf_local_ptr_offsets(bfd) \
1045 1.1 christos (ppc_elf_tdata (bfd)->linker_section_pointers)
1046 1.1 christos
1047 1.1 christos #define is_ppc_elf(bfd) \
1048 1.1 christos (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \
1049 1.1 christos && elf_object_id (bfd) == PPC32_ELF_DATA)
1050 1.1 christos
1051 1.1 christos /* Override the generic function because we store some extras. */
1052 1.1 christos
1053 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
1054 1.1 christos ppc_elf_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
1055 1.1 christos {
1056 1.1 christos return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata),
1057 1.6 christos PPC32_ELF_DATA);
1058 1.6 christos }
1059 1.6 christos
1060 1.6 christos /* When defaulting arch/mach, decode apuinfo to find a better match. */
1061 1.6 christos
1062 1.6 christos bfd_boolean
1063 1.6 christos _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (bfd *abfd)
1064 1.6 christos {
1065 1.6 christos unsigned long mach = 0;
1066 1.6 christos asection *s;
1067 1.6 christos unsigned char *contents;
1068 1.6 christos
1069 1.6 christos if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32
1070 1.6 christos && bfd_big_endian (abfd))
1071 1.6 christos {
1072 1.6 christos
1073 1.6 christos for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
1074 1.6 christos if ((elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1075 1.6 christos break;
1076 1.6 christos if (s != NULL)
1077 1.6 christos mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
1078 1.6 christos }
1079 1.6 christos
1080 1.6 christos if (mach == 0)
1081 1.6 christos {
1082 1.6 christos s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1083 1.6 christos if (s != NULL && bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &contents))
1084 1.6 christos {
1085 1.6 christos unsigned int apuinfo_size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + 4);
1086 1.6 christos unsigned int i;
1087 1.6 christos
1088 1.6 christos for (i = 20; i < apuinfo_size + 20 && i + 4 <= s->size; i += 4)
1089 1.6 christos {
1090 1.6 christos unsigned int val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + i);
1091 1.6 christos switch (val >> 16)
1092 1.6 christos {
1093 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_PMR:
1094 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_RFMCI:
1095 1.6 christos if (mach == 0)
1096 1.6 christos mach = bfd_mach_ppc_titan;
1097 1.6 christos break;
1098 1.6 christos
1099 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_ISEL:
1100 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_CACHELCK:
1101 1.6 christos if (mach == bfd_mach_ppc_titan)
1102 1.6 christos mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500mc;
1103 1.6 christos break;
1104 1.6 christos
1105 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_SPE:
1106 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_EFS:
1107 1.7 christos case PPC_APUINFO_BRLOCK:
1108 1.6 christos if (mach != bfd_mach_ppc_vle)
1109 1.6 christos mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500;
1110 1.6 christos break;
1111 1.6 christos
1112 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_VLE:
1113 1.6 christos mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
1114 1.6 christos break;
1115 1.6 christos
1116 1.6 christos default:
1117 1.6 christos mach = -1ul;
1118 1.6 christos }
1119 1.6 christos }
1120 1.6 christos free (contents);
1121 1.6 christos }
1122 1.6 christos }
1123 1.6 christos
1124 1.6 christos if (mach != 0 && mach != -1ul)
1125 1.6 christos {
1126 1.6 christos const bfd_arch_info_type *arch;
1127 1.6 christos
1128 1.6 christos for (arch = abfd->arch_info->next; arch; arch = arch->next)
1129 1.6 christos if (arch->mach == mach)
1130 1.6 christos {
1131 1.6 christos abfd->arch_info = arch;
1132 1.6 christos break;
1133 1.6 christos }
1134 1.6 christos }
1135 1.1 christos return TRUE;
1136 1.6 christos }
1137 1.1 christos
1138 1.1 christos /* Fix bad default arch selected for a 32 bit input bfd when the
1139 1.1 christos default is 64 bit. Also select arch based on apuinfo. */
1140 1.1 christos
1141 1.6 christos static bfd_boolean
1142 1.6 christos ppc_elf_object_p (bfd *abfd)
1143 1.6 christos {
1144 1.6 christos if (!abfd->arch_info->the_default)
1145 1.1 christos return TRUE;
1146 1.1 christos
1147 1.1 christos if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 64)
1148 1.1 christos {
1149 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
1150 1.1 christos
1151 1.1 christos if (i_ehdr->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
1152 1.1 christos {
1153 1.1 christos /* Relies on arch after 64 bit default being 32 bit default. */
1154 1.1 christos abfd->arch_info = abfd->arch_info->next;
1155 1.6 christos BFD_ASSERT (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32);
1156 1.1 christos }
1157 1.1 christos }
1158 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (abfd);
1159 1.1 christos }
1160 1.1 christos
1161 1.1 christos /* Function to set whether a module needs the -mrelocatable bit set. */
1162 1.1 christos
1163 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
1164 1.1 christos ppc_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
1165 1.1 christos {
1166 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
1167 1.1 christos || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
1168 1.1 christos
1169 1.1 christos elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
1170 1.1 christos elf_flags_init (abfd) = TRUE;
1171 1.1 christos return TRUE;
1172 1.1 christos }
1173 1.1 christos
1174 1.1 christos /* Support for core dump NOTE sections. */
1175 1.1 christos
1176 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
1177 1.1 christos ppc_elf_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1178 1.1 christos {
1179 1.1 christos int offset;
1180 1.1 christos unsigned int size;
1181 1.1 christos
1182 1.1 christos switch (note->descsz)
1183 1.1 christos {
1184 1.1 christos default:
1185 1.1 christos return FALSE;
1186 1.1 christos
1187 1.1 christos case 268: /* Linux/PPC. */
1188 1.1 christos /* pr_cursig */
1189 1.1 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_16 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
1190 1.1 christos
1191 1.1 christos /* pr_pid */
1192 1.1 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 24);
1193 1.1 christos
1194 1.1 christos /* pr_reg */
1195 1.1 christos offset = 72;
1196 1.1 christos size = 192;
1197 1.1 christos
1198 1.1 christos break;
1199 1.1 christos }
1200 1.1 christos
1201 1.1 christos /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
1202 1.1 christos return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
1203 1.1 christos size, note->descpos + offset);
1204 1.1 christos }
1205 1.1 christos
1206 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
1207 1.1 christos ppc_elf_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1208 1.1 christos {
1209 1.1 christos switch (note->descsz)
1210 1.1 christos {
1211 1.1 christos default:
1212 1.1 christos return FALSE;
1213 1.1 christos
1214 1.1 christos case 128: /* Linux/PPC elf_prpsinfo. */
1215 1.1 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
1216 1.1 christos = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 16);
1217 1.1 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
1218 1.1 christos = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 32, 16);
1219 1.1 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
1220 1.1 christos = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 48, 80);
1221 1.1 christos }
1222 1.1 christos
1223 1.1 christos /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
1224 1.1 christos onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
1225 1.1 christos implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
1226 1.1 christos
1227 1.1 christos {
1228 1.1 christos char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
1229 1.1 christos int n = strlen (command);
1230 1.1 christos
1231 1.1 christos if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
1232 1.1 christos command[n - 1] = '\0';
1233 1.1 christos }
1234 1.1 christos
1235 1.1 christos return TRUE;
1236 1.1 christos }
1237 1.1 christos
1238 1.1 christos static char *
1239 1.1 christos ppc_elf_write_core_note (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz, int note_type, ...)
1240 1.1 christos {
1241 1.1 christos switch (note_type)
1242 1.1 christos {
1243 1.1 christos default:
1244 1.1 christos return NULL;
1245 1.8 christos
1246 1.1 christos case NT_PRPSINFO:
1247 1.1 christos {
1248 1.1 christos char data[128] ATTRIBUTE_NONSTRING;
1249 1.1 christos va_list ap;
1250 1.1 christos
1251 1.8 christos va_start (ap, note_type);
1252 1.8 christos memset (data, 0, sizeof (data));
1253 1.8 christos strncpy (data + 32, va_arg (ap, const char *), 16);
1254 1.8 christos #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1255 1.8 christos DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH;
1256 1.8 christos /* GCC 8.0 and 8.1 warn about 80 equals destination size with
1257 1.8 christos -Wstringop-truncation:
1258 1.8 christos https://gcc.gnu.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=85643
1259 1.1 christos */
1260 1.8 christos DIAGNOSTIC_IGNORE_STRINGOP_TRUNCATION;
1261 1.8 christos #endif
1262 1.8 christos strncpy (data + 48, va_arg (ap, const char *), 80);
1263 1.1 christos #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1264 1.1 christos DIAGNOSTIC_POP;
1265 1.1 christos #endif
1266 1.1 christos va_end (ap);
1267 1.1 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1268 1.1 christos "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1269 1.1 christos }
1270 1.1 christos
1271 1.1 christos case NT_PRSTATUS:
1272 1.1 christos {
1273 1.1 christos char data[268];
1274 1.1 christos va_list ap;
1275 1.1 christos long pid;
1276 1.1 christos int cursig;
1277 1.1 christos const void *greg;
1278 1.1 christos
1279 1.1 christos va_start (ap, note_type);
1280 1.1 christos memset (data, 0, 72);
1281 1.1 christos pid = va_arg (ap, long);
1282 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, pid, data + 24);
1283 1.1 christos cursig = va_arg (ap, int);
1284 1.1 christos bfd_put_16 (abfd, cursig, data + 12);
1285 1.1 christos greg = va_arg (ap, const void *);
1286 1.1 christos memcpy (data + 72, greg, 192);
1287 1.1 christos memset (data + 264, 0, 4);
1288 1.1 christos va_end (ap);
1289 1.1 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1290 1.1 christos "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1291 1.1 christos }
1292 1.1 christos }
1293 1.1 christos }
1294 1.1 christos
1295 1.1 christos static flagword
1296 1.1 christos ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags (char *flag_name)
1297 1.1 christos {
1298 1.1 christos
1299 1.1 christos if (!strcmp (flag_name, "SHF_PPC_VLE"))
1300 1.1 christos return SHF_PPC_VLE;
1301 1.1 christos
1302 1.1 christos return 0;
1303 1.1 christos }
1304 1.1 christos
1305 1.1 christos /* Return address for Ith PLT stub in section PLT, for relocation REL
1306 1.1 christos or (bfd_vma) -1 if it should not be included. */
1307 1.1 christos
1308 1.1 christos static bfd_vma
1309 1.1 christos ppc_elf_plt_sym_val (bfd_vma i ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1310 1.1 christos const asection *plt ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1311 1.1 christos const arelent *rel)
1312 1.1 christos {
1313 1.1 christos return rel->address;
1314 1.1 christos }
1315 1.1 christos
1316 1.1 christos /* Handle a PowerPC specific section when reading an object file. This
1317 1.1 christos is called when bfd_section_from_shdr finds a section with an unknown
1318 1.1 christos type. */
1319 1.1 christos
1320 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
1321 1.1 christos ppc_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
1322 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
1323 1.1 christos const char *name,
1324 1.1 christos int shindex)
1325 1.1 christos {
1326 1.1 christos asection *newsect;
1327 1.1 christos flagword flags;
1328 1.1 christos
1329 1.1 christos if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
1330 1.1 christos return FALSE;
1331 1.1 christos
1332 1.1 christos newsect = hdr->bfd_section;
1333 1.1 christos flags = bfd_get_section_flags (abfd, newsect);
1334 1.1 christos if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE)
1335 1.1 christos flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1336 1.1 christos
1337 1.1 christos if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_ORDERED)
1338 1.1 christos flags |= SEC_SORT_ENTRIES;
1339 1.1 christos
1340 1.1 christos bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, newsect, flags);
1341 1.1 christos return TRUE;
1342 1.1 christos }
1343 1.1 christos
1344 1.1 christos /* Set up any other section flags and such that may be necessary. */
1345 1.1 christos
1346 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
1347 1.1 christos ppc_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1348 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr,
1349 1.1 christos asection *asect)
1350 1.1 christos {
1351 1.1 christos if ((asect->flags & SEC_SORT_ENTRIES) != 0)
1352 1.1 christos shdr->sh_type = SHT_ORDERED;
1353 1.1 christos
1354 1.1 christos return TRUE;
1355 1.1 christos }
1356 1.1 christos
1357 1.1 christos /* If we have .sbss2 or .PPC.EMB.sbss0 output sections, we
1358 1.1 christos need to bump up the number of section headers. */
1359 1.1 christos
1360 1.1 christos static int
1361 1.1 christos ppc_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd,
1362 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1363 1.1 christos {
1364 1.1 christos asection *s;
1365 1.1 christos int ret = 0;
1366 1.1 christos
1367 1.1 christos s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".sbss2");
1368 1.1 christos if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1369 1.1 christos ++ret;
1370 1.1 christos
1371 1.1 christos s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0");
1372 1.1 christos if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1373 1.1 christos ++ret;
1374 1.1 christos
1375 1.1 christos return ret;
1376 1.1 christos }
1377 1.1 christos
1378 1.1 christos /* Modify the segment map for VLE executables. */
1379 1.1 christos
1380 1.1 christos bfd_boolean
1381 1.7 christos ppc_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
1382 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1383 1.1 christos {
1384 1.1 christos struct elf_segment_map *m;
1385 1.1 christos
1386 1.1 christos /* At this point in the link, output sections have already been sorted by
1387 1.1 christos LMA and assigned to segments. All that is left to do is to ensure
1388 1.1 christos there is no mixing of VLE & non-VLE sections in a text segment.
1389 1.1 christos If we find that case, we split the segment.
1390 1.1 christos We maintain the original output section order. */
1391 1.7 christos
1392 1.7 christos for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
1393 1.7 christos {
1394 1.7 christos struct elf_segment_map *n;
1395 1.7 christos bfd_size_type amt;
1396 1.7 christos unsigned int j, k;
1397 1.1 christos unsigned int p_flags;
1398 1.1 christos
1399 1.7 christos if (m->p_type != PT_LOAD || m->count == 0)
1400 1.1 christos continue;
1401 1.7 christos
1402 1.7 christos for (p_flags = PF_R, j = 0; j != m->count; ++j)
1403 1.7 christos {
1404 1.7 christos if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
1405 1.7 christos p_flags |= PF_W;
1406 1.7 christos if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
1407 1.7 christos {
1408 1.7 christos p_flags |= PF_X;
1409 1.7 christos if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1410 1.7 christos p_flags |= PF_PPC_VLE;
1411 1.7 christos break;
1412 1.7 christos }
1413 1.7 christos }
1414 1.7 christos if (j != m->count)
1415 1.1 christos while (++j != m->count)
1416 1.7 christos {
1417 1.7 christos unsigned int p_flags1 = PF_R;
1418 1.7 christos
1419 1.7 christos if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
1420 1.7 christos p_flags1 |= PF_W;
1421 1.7 christos if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
1422 1.7 christos {
1423 1.7 christos p_flags1 |= PF_X;
1424 1.7 christos if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1425 1.7 christos p_flags1 |= PF_PPC_VLE;
1426 1.7 christos if (((p_flags1 ^ p_flags) & PF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1427 1.7 christos break;
1428 1.7 christos }
1429 1.7 christos p_flags |= p_flags1;
1430 1.7 christos }
1431 1.7 christos /* If we're splitting a segment which originally contained rw
1432 1.7 christos sections then those sections might now only be in one of the
1433 1.7 christos two parts. So always set p_flags if splitting, even if we
1434 1.7 christos are being called for objcopy with p_flags_valid set. */
1435 1.7 christos if (j != m->count || !m->p_flags_valid)
1436 1.7 christos {
1437 1.7 christos m->p_flags_valid = 1;
1438 1.1 christos m->p_flags = p_flags;
1439 1.1 christos }
1440 1.7 christos if (j == m->count)
1441 1.1 christos continue;
1442 1.1 christos
1443 1.1 christos /* Sections 0..j-1 stay in this (current) segment,
1444 1.1 christos the remainder are put in a new segment.
1445 1.1 christos The scan resumes with the new segment. */
1446 1.1 christos
1447 1.1 christos amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
1448 1.8 christos amt += (m->count - j - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
1449 1.1 christos n = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
1450 1.1 christos if (n == NULL)
1451 1.1 christos return FALSE;
1452 1.1 christos
1453 1.7 christos n->p_type = PT_LOAD;
1454 1.7 christos n->count = m->count - j;
1455 1.7 christos for (k = 0; k < n->count; ++k)
1456 1.1 christos n->sections[k] = m->sections[j + k];
1457 1.1 christos m->count = j;
1458 1.1 christos m->p_size_valid = 0;
1459 1.1 christos n->next = m->next;
1460 1.1 christos m->next = n;
1461 1.1 christos }
1462 1.1 christos
1463 1.1 christos return TRUE;
1464 1.1 christos }
1465 1.1 christos
1466 1.1 christos /* Add extra PPC sections -- Note, for now, make .sbss2 and
1467 1.1 christos .PPC.EMB.sbss0 a normal section, and not a bss section so
1468 1.1 christos that the linker doesn't crater when trying to make more than
1469 1.1 christos 2 sections. */
1470 1.6 christos
1471 1.6 christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_elf_special_sections[] =
1472 1.6 christos {
1473 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
1474 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1475 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1476 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1477 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1478 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tags"), 0, SHT_ORDERED, SHF_ALLOC },
1479 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (APUINFO_SECTION_NAME), 0, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
1480 1.1 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sbss0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1481 1.1 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sdata0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1482 1.1 christos { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
1483 1.1 christos };
1484 1.8 christos
1485 1.1 christos /* This is what we want for new plt/got. */
1486 1.1 christos static struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_alt_plt =
1487 1.7 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC };
1488 1.1 christos
1489 1.1 christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
1490 1.1 christos ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
1491 1.1 christos {
1492 1.1 christos const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
1493 1.1 christos
1494 1.1 christos /* See if this is one of the special sections. */
1495 1.1 christos if (sec->name == NULL)
1496 1.1 christos return NULL;
1497 1.1 christos
1498 1.1 christos ssect = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, ppc_elf_special_sections,
1499 1.1 christos sec->use_rela_p);
1500 1.1 christos if (ssect != NULL)
1501 1.1 christos {
1502 1.1 christos if (ssect == ppc_elf_special_sections && (sec->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
1503 1.1 christos ssect = &ppc_alt_plt;
1504 1.1 christos return ssect;
1505 1.1 christos }
1506 1.1 christos
1507 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
1508 1.1 christos }
1509 1.1 christos
1510 1.1 christos /* Very simple linked list structure for recording apuinfo values. */
1512 1.1 christos typedef struct apuinfo_list
1513 1.1 christos {
1514 1.1 christos struct apuinfo_list *next;
1515 1.1 christos unsigned long value;
1516 1.1 christos }
1517 1.1 christos apuinfo_list;
1518 1.1 christos
1519 1.1 christos static apuinfo_list *head;
1520 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean apuinfo_set;
1521 1.1 christos
1522 1.1 christos static void
1523 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_init (void)
1524 1.1 christos {
1525 1.1 christos head = NULL;
1526 1.1 christos apuinfo_set = FALSE;
1527 1.1 christos }
1528 1.1 christos
1529 1.1 christos static void
1530 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_add (unsigned long value)
1531 1.1 christos {
1532 1.1 christos apuinfo_list *entry = head;
1533 1.1 christos
1534 1.1 christos while (entry != NULL)
1535 1.1 christos {
1536 1.1 christos if (entry->value == value)
1537 1.1 christos return;
1538 1.1 christos entry = entry->next;
1539 1.1 christos }
1540 1.1 christos
1541 1.1 christos entry = bfd_malloc (sizeof (* entry));
1542 1.1 christos if (entry == NULL)
1543 1.1 christos return;
1544 1.1 christos
1545 1.1 christos entry->value = value;
1546 1.1 christos entry->next = head;
1547 1.1 christos head = entry;
1548 1.1 christos }
1549 1.1 christos
1550 1.1 christos static unsigned
1551 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_length (void)
1552 1.1 christos {
1553 1.1 christos apuinfo_list *entry;
1554 1.1 christos unsigned long count;
1555 1.1 christos
1556 1.1 christos for (entry = head, count = 0;
1557 1.1 christos entry;
1558 1.1 christos entry = entry->next)
1559 1.1 christos ++ count;
1560 1.1 christos
1561 1.1 christos return count;
1562 1.1 christos }
1563 1.1 christos
1564 1.1 christos static inline unsigned long
1565 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_element (unsigned long number)
1566 1.1 christos {
1567 1.1 christos apuinfo_list * entry;
1568 1.1 christos
1569 1.1 christos for (entry = head;
1570 1.1 christos entry && number --;
1571 1.1 christos entry = entry->next)
1572 1.1 christos ;
1573 1.1 christos
1574 1.1 christos return entry ? entry->value : 0;
1575 1.1 christos }
1576 1.1 christos
1577 1.1 christos static void
1578 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_finish (void)
1579 1.1 christos {
1580 1.1 christos apuinfo_list *entry;
1581 1.1 christos
1582 1.1 christos for (entry = head; entry;)
1583 1.1 christos {
1584 1.1 christos apuinfo_list *next = entry->next;
1585 1.1 christos free (entry);
1586 1.1 christos entry = next;
1587 1.1 christos }
1588 1.1 christos
1589 1.1 christos head = NULL;
1590 1.1 christos }
1591 1.1 christos
1592 1.1 christos /* Scan the input BFDs and create a linked list of
1593 1.1 christos the APUinfo values that will need to be emitted. */
1594 1.1 christos
1595 1.1 christos static void
1596 1.1 christos ppc_elf_begin_write_processing (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
1597 1.1 christos {
1598 1.1 christos bfd *ibfd;
1599 1.1 christos asection *asec;
1600 1.1 christos char *buffer = NULL;
1601 1.1 christos bfd_size_type largest_input_size = 0;
1602 1.1 christos unsigned i;
1603 1.1 christos unsigned long length;
1604 1.1 christos const char *error_message = NULL;
1605 1.1 christos
1606 1.1 christos if (link_info == NULL)
1607 1.1 christos return;
1608 1.3 christos
1609 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_init ();
1610 1.1 christos
1611 1.1 christos /* Read in the input sections contents. */
1612 1.1 christos for (ibfd = link_info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
1613 1.1 christos {
1614 1.1 christos unsigned long datum;
1615 1.1 christos
1616 1.7 christos asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1617 1.8 christos if (asec == NULL)
1618 1.1 christos continue;
1619 1.1 christos
1620 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
1621 1.1 christos error_message = _("corrupt %s section in %pB");
1622 1.1 christos length = asec->size;
1623 1.1 christos if (length < 20)
1624 1.1 christos goto fail;
1625 1.1 christos
1626 1.1 christos apuinfo_set = TRUE;
1627 1.1 christos if (largest_input_size < asec->size)
1628 1.1 christos {
1629 1.1 christos if (buffer)
1630 1.1 christos free (buffer);
1631 1.1 christos largest_input_size = asec->size;
1632 1.1 christos buffer = bfd_malloc (largest_input_size);
1633 1.1 christos if (!buffer)
1634 1.1 christos return;
1635 1.1 christos }
1636 1.7 christos
1637 1.8 christos if (bfd_seek (ibfd, asec->filepos, SEEK_SET) != 0
1638 1.1 christos || (bfd_bread (buffer, length, ibfd) != length))
1639 1.1 christos {
1640 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
1641 1.1 christos error_message = _("unable to read in %s section from %pB");
1642 1.1 christos goto fail;
1643 1.1 christos }
1644 1.1 christos
1645 1.1 christos /* Verify the contents of the header. Note - we have to
1646 1.1 christos extract the values this way in order to allow for a
1647 1.1 christos host whose endian-ness is different from the target. */
1648 1.1 christos datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer);
1649 1.1 christos if (datum != sizeof APUINFO_LABEL)
1650 1.1 christos goto fail;
1651 1.1 christos
1652 1.1 christos datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 8);
1653 1.1 christos if (datum != 0x2)
1654 1.1 christos goto fail;
1655 1.1 christos
1656 1.1 christos if (strcmp (buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL) != 0)
1657 1.1 christos goto fail;
1658 1.1 christos
1659 1.1 christos /* Get the number of bytes used for apuinfo entries. */
1660 1.1 christos datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 4);
1661 1.1 christos if (datum + 20 != length)
1662 1.1 christos goto fail;
1663 1.1 christos
1664 1.1 christos /* Scan the apuinfo section, building a list of apuinfo numbers. */
1665 1.1 christos for (i = 0; i < datum; i += 4)
1666 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_add (bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 20 + i));
1667 1.1 christos }
1668 1.1 christos
1669 1.1 christos error_message = NULL;
1670 1.1 christos
1671 1.1 christos if (apuinfo_set)
1672 1.1 christos {
1673 1.1 christos /* Compute the size of the output section. */
1674 1.1 christos unsigned num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
1675 1.1 christos
1676 1.1 christos /* Set the output section size, if it exists. */
1677 1.1 christos asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1678 1.7 christos
1679 1.8 christos if (asec && ! bfd_set_section_size (abfd, asec, 20 + num_entries * 4))
1680 1.1 christos {
1681 1.1 christos ibfd = abfd;
1682 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
1683 1.1 christos error_message = _("warning: unable to set size of %s section in %pB");
1684 1.1 christos }
1685 1.1 christos }
1686 1.1 christos
1687 1.1 christos fail:
1688 1.8 christos if (buffer)
1689 1.1 christos free (buffer);
1690 1.1 christos
1691 1.1 christos if (error_message)
1692 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (error_message, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME, ibfd);
1693 1.1 christos }
1694 1.1 christos
1695 1.1 christos /* Prevent the output section from accumulating the input sections'
1696 1.1 christos contents. We have already stored this in our linked list structure. */
1697 1.1 christos
1698 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
1699 1.1 christos ppc_elf_write_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1700 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1701 1.1 christos asection *asec,
1702 1.1 christos bfd_byte *contents ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1703 1.1 christos {
1704 1.1 christos return apuinfo_set && strcmp (asec->name, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME) == 0;
1705 1.1 christos }
1706 1.1 christos
1707 1.1 christos /* Finally we can generate the output section. */
1708 1.1 christos
1709 1.1 christos static void
1710 1.1 christos ppc_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean linker ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1711 1.1 christos {
1712 1.1 christos bfd_byte *buffer;
1713 1.1 christos asection *asec;
1714 1.1 christos unsigned i;
1715 1.1 christos unsigned num_entries;
1716 1.1 christos bfd_size_type length;
1717 1.1 christos
1718 1.1 christos asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1719 1.1 christos if (asec == NULL)
1720 1.1 christos return;
1721 1.1 christos
1722 1.1 christos if (!apuinfo_set)
1723 1.1 christos return;
1724 1.1 christos
1725 1.1 christos length = asec->size;
1726 1.1 christos if (length < 20)
1727 1.1 christos return;
1728 1.7 christos
1729 1.8 christos buffer = bfd_malloc (length);
1730 1.1 christos if (buffer == NULL)
1731 1.1 christos {
1732 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler
1733 1.1 christos (_("failed to allocate space for new APUinfo section"));
1734 1.1 christos return;
1735 1.1 christos }
1736 1.1 christos
1737 1.1 christos /* Create the apuinfo header. */
1738 1.1 christos num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
1739 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, sizeof APUINFO_LABEL, buffer);
1740 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, num_entries * 4, buffer + 4);
1741 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, 0x2, buffer + 8);
1742 1.1 christos strcpy ((char *) buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL);
1743 1.1 christos
1744 1.1 christos length = 20;
1745 1.1 christos for (i = 0; i < num_entries; i++)
1746 1.1 christos {
1747 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, apuinfo_list_element (i), buffer + length);
1748 1.8 christos length += 4;
1749 1.1 christos }
1750 1.1 christos
1751 1.8 christos if (length != asec->size)
1752 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to compute new APUinfo section"));
1753 1.1 christos
1754 1.1 christos if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, asec, buffer, (file_ptr) 0, length))
1755 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to install new APUinfo section"));
1756 1.1 christos
1757 1.1 christos free (buffer);
1758 1.1 christos
1759 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_finish ();
1760 1.1 christos }
1761 1.8 christos
1762 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
1764 1.1 christos is_nonpic_glink_stub (bfd *abfd, asection *glink, bfd_vma off)
1765 1.1 christos {
1766 1.1 christos bfd_byte buf[4 * 4];
1767 1.1 christos
1768 1.1 christos if (!bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf, off, sizeof buf))
1769 1.1 christos return FALSE;
1770 1.1 christos
1771 1.1 christos return ((bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 0) & 0xffff0000) == LIS_11
1772 1.1 christos && (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 4) & 0xffff0000) == LWZ_11_11
1773 1.1 christos && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 8) == MTCTR_11
1774 1.1 christos && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 12) == BCTR);
1775 1.1 christos }
1776 1.1 christos
1777 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
1778 1.1 christos section_covers_vma (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section, void *ptr)
1779 1.1 christos {
1780 1.1 christos bfd_vma vma = *(bfd_vma *) ptr;
1781 1.1 christos return ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
1782 1.1 christos && section->vma <= vma
1783 1.1 christos && vma < section->vma + section->size);
1784 1.1 christos }
1785 1.1 christos
1786 1.1 christos static long
1787 1.1 christos ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd, long symcount, asymbol **syms,
1788 1.1 christos long dynsymcount, asymbol **dynsyms,
1789 1.1 christos asymbol **ret)
1790 1.8 christos {
1791 1.1 christos bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
1792 1.1 christos asection *plt, *relplt, *dynamic, *glink;
1793 1.8 christos bfd_vma glink_vma = 0;
1794 1.1 christos bfd_vma resolv_vma = 0;
1795 1.1 christos bfd_vma stub_off;
1796 1.1 christos asymbol *s;
1797 1.1 christos arelent *p;
1798 1.1 christos long count, i, stub_delta;
1799 1.1 christos size_t size;
1800 1.1 christos char *names;
1801 1.1 christos bfd_byte buf[4];
1802 1.1 christos
1803 1.1 christos *ret = NULL;
1804 1.1 christos
1805 1.1 christos if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
1806 1.1 christos return 0;
1807 1.1 christos
1808 1.1 christos if (dynsymcount <= 0)
1809 1.1 christos return 0;
1810 1.1 christos
1811 1.1 christos relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.plt");
1812 1.1 christos if (relplt == NULL)
1813 1.1 christos return 0;
1814 1.1 christos
1815 1.1 christos plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
1816 1.1 christos if (plt == NULL)
1817 1.1 christos return 0;
1818 1.1 christos
1819 1.1 christos /* Call common code to handle old-style executable PLTs. */
1820 1.1 christos if (elf_section_flags (plt) & SHF_EXECINSTR)
1821 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (abfd, symcount, syms,
1822 1.1 christos dynsymcount, dynsyms, ret);
1823 1.1 christos
1824 1.1 christos /* If this object was prelinked, the prelinker stored the address
1825 1.1 christos of .glink at got[1]. If it wasn't prelinked, got[1] will be zero. */
1826 1.1 christos dynamic = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1827 1.1 christos if (dynamic != NULL)
1828 1.1 christos {
1829 1.1 christos bfd_byte *dynbuf, *extdyn, *extdynend;
1830 1.1 christos size_t extdynsize;
1831 1.1 christos void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1832 1.1 christos
1833 1.1 christos if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, dynamic, &dynbuf))
1834 1.1 christos return -1;
1835 1.1 christos
1836 1.1 christos extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1837 1.1 christos swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1838 1.1 christos
1839 1.1 christos extdyn = dynbuf;
1840 1.1 christos extdynend = extdyn + dynamic->size;
1841 1.1 christos for (; extdyn < extdynend; extdyn += extdynsize)
1842 1.1 christos {
1843 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1844 1.1 christos (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1845 1.1 christos
1846 1.1 christos if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1847 1.1 christos break;
1848 1.1 christos
1849 1.1 christos if (dyn.d_tag == DT_PPC_GOT)
1850 1.1 christos {
1851 1.1 christos unsigned int g_o_t = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1852 1.1 christos asection *got = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got");
1853 1.1 christos if (got != NULL
1854 1.1 christos && bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, got, buf,
1855 1.1 christos g_o_t - got->vma + 4, 4))
1856 1.1 christos glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1857 1.1 christos break;
1858 1.1 christos }
1859 1.1 christos }
1860 1.1 christos free (dynbuf);
1861 1.1 christos }
1862 1.1 christos
1863 1.1 christos /* Otherwise we read the first plt entry. */
1864 1.1 christos if (glink_vma == 0)
1865 1.1 christos {
1866 1.1 christos if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, plt, buf, 0, 4))
1867 1.1 christos glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1868 1.1 christos }
1869 1.1 christos
1870 1.1 christos if (glink_vma == 0)
1871 1.1 christos return 0;
1872 1.1 christos
1873 1.1 christos /* The .glink section usually does not survive the final
1874 1.1 christos link; search for the section (usually .text) where the
1875 1.1 christos glink stubs now reside. */
1876 1.1 christos glink = bfd_sections_find_if (abfd, section_covers_vma, &glink_vma);
1877 1.1 christos if (glink == NULL)
1878 1.1 christos return 0;
1879 1.1 christos
1880 1.1 christos /* Determine glink PLT resolver by reading the relative branch
1881 1.1 christos from the first glink stub. */
1882 1.1 christos if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
1883 1.1 christos glink_vma - glink->vma, 4))
1884 1.1 christos {
1885 1.1 christos unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1886 1.1 christos
1887 1.1 christos /* The first glink stub may either branch to the resolver ... */
1888 1.1 christos insn ^= B;
1889 1.1 christos if ((insn & ~0x3fffffc) == 0)
1890 1.1 christos resolv_vma = glink_vma + (insn ^ 0x2000000) - 0x2000000;
1891 1.1 christos
1892 1.1 christos /* ... or fall through a bunch of NOPs. */
1893 1.1 christos else if ((insn ^ B ^ NOP) == 0)
1894 1.1 christos for (i = 4;
1895 1.1 christos bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
1896 1.1 christos glink_vma - glink->vma + i, 4);
1897 1.1 christos i += 4)
1898 1.1 christos if (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf) != NOP)
1899 1.1 christos {
1900 1.1 christos resolv_vma = glink_vma + i;
1901 1.1 christos break;
1902 1.1 christos }
1903 1.1 christos }
1904 1.8 christos
1905 1.8 christos count = relplt->size / sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
1906 1.8 christos /* If the stubs are those for -shared/-pie then we might have
1907 1.8 christos multiple stubs for each plt entry. If that is the case then
1908 1.8 christos there is no way to associate stubs with their plt entries short
1909 1.8 christos of figuring out the GOT pointer value used in the stub.
1910 1.8 christos The offsets tested here need to cover all possible values of
1911 1.8 christos GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE for other than __tls_get_addr_opt. */
1912 1.1 christos stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1913 1.1 christos for (stub_delta = 16; stub_delta <= 32; stub_delta += 8)
1914 1.1 christos if (is_nonpic_glink_stub (abfd, glink, stub_off - stub_delta))
1915 1.1 christos break;
1916 1.1 christos if (stub_delta > 32)
1917 1.1 christos return 0;
1918 1.1 christos
1919 1.1 christos slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
1920 1.1 christos if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
1921 1.1 christos return -1;
1922 1.1 christos
1923 1.1 christos size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
1924 1.1 christos p = relplt->relocation;
1925 1.1 christos for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p++)
1926 1.1 christos {
1927 1.1 christos size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
1928 1.1 christos if (p->addend != 0)
1929 1.1 christos size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
1930 1.1 christos }
1931 1.1 christos
1932 1.1 christos size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink");
1933 1.1 christos
1934 1.1 christos if (resolv_vma)
1935 1.1 christos size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
1936 1.8 christos
1937 1.1 christos s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size);
1938 1.5 christos if (s == NULL)
1939 1.5 christos return -1;
1940 1.1 christos
1941 1.1 christos stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1942 1.1 christos names = (char *) (s + count + 1 + (resolv_vma != 0));
1943 1.8 christos p = relplt->relocation + count - 1;
1944 1.8 christos for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
1945 1.8 christos {
1946 1.1 christos size_t len;
1947 1.1 christos
1948 1.1 christos stub_off -= stub_delta;
1949 1.1 christos if (strcmp ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, "__tls_get_addr_opt") == 0)
1950 1.1 christos stub_off -= 32;
1951 1.1 christos *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
1952 1.1 christos /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
1953 1.8 christos we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
1954 1.1 christos if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
1955 1.1 christos s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
1956 1.1 christos s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1957 1.1 christos s->section = glink;
1958 1.1 christos s->value = stub_off;
1959 1.1 christos s->name = names;
1960 1.1 christos s->udata.p = NULL;
1961 1.1 christos len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
1962 1.1 christos memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
1963 1.1 christos names += len;
1964 1.1 christos if (p->addend != 0)
1965 1.1 christos {
1966 1.1 christos memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
1967 1.1 christos names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
1968 1.1 christos bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, names, p->addend);
1969 1.5 christos names += strlen (names);
1970 1.1 christos }
1971 1.1 christos memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
1972 1.1 christos names += sizeof ("@plt");
1973 1.1 christos ++s;
1974 1.1 christos --p;
1975 1.1 christos }
1976 1.1 christos
1977 1.1 christos /* Add a symbol at the start of the glink branch table. */
1978 1.1 christos memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
1979 1.1 christos s->the_bfd = abfd;
1980 1.1 christos s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1981 1.1 christos s->section = glink;
1982 1.1 christos s->value = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1983 1.1 christos s->name = names;
1984 1.1 christos memcpy (names, "__glink", sizeof ("__glink"));
1985 1.1 christos names += sizeof ("__glink");
1986 1.1 christos s++;
1987 1.1 christos count++;
1988 1.1 christos
1989 1.1 christos if (resolv_vma)
1990 1.1 christos {
1991 1.1 christos /* Add a symbol for the glink PLT resolver. */
1992 1.1 christos memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
1993 1.1 christos s->the_bfd = abfd;
1994 1.1 christos s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1995 1.1 christos s->section = glink;
1996 1.1 christos s->value = resolv_vma - glink->vma;
1997 1.1 christos s->name = names;
1998 1.1 christos memcpy (names, "__glink_PLTresolve", sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve"));
1999 1.1 christos names += sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
2000 1.1 christos s++;
2001 1.1 christos count++;
2002 1.1 christos }
2003 1.1 christos
2004 1.1 christos return count;
2005 1.1 christos }
2006 1.1 christos
2007 1.1 christos /* The following functions are specific to the ELF linker, while
2009 1.1 christos functions above are used generally. They appear in this file more
2010 1.1 christos or less in the order in which they are called. eg.
2011 1.1 christos ppc_elf_check_relocs is called early in the link process,
2012 1.1 christos ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections is one of the last functions
2013 1.1 christos called. */
2014 1.1 christos
2015 1.1 christos /* Track PLT entries needed for a given symbol. We might need more
2016 1.1 christos than one glink entry per symbol when generating a pic binary. */
2017 1.1 christos struct plt_entry
2018 1.1 christos {
2019 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *next;
2020 1.1 christos
2021 1.1 christos /* -fPIC uses multiple GOT sections, one per file, called ".got2".
2022 1.1 christos This field stores the offset into .got2 used to initialise the
2023 1.1 christos GOT pointer reg. It will always be at least 32768. (Current
2024 1.1 christos gcc always uses an offset of 32768, but ld -r will pack .got2
2025 1.1 christos sections together resulting in larger offsets). */
2026 1.1 christos bfd_vma addend;
2027 1.1 christos
2028 1.1 christos /* The .got2 section. */
2029 1.1 christos asection *sec;
2030 1.1 christos
2031 1.1 christos /* PLT refcount or offset. */
2032 1.1 christos union
2033 1.1 christos {
2034 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma refcount;
2035 1.1 christos bfd_vma offset;
2036 1.8 christos } plt;
2037 1.8 christos
2038 1.8 christos /* .glink stub offset. */
2039 1.1 christos bfd_vma glink_offset;
2040 1.1 christos };
2041 1.1 christos
2042 1.1 christos /* Of those relocs that might be copied as dynamic relocs, this
2043 1.1 christos function selects those that must be copied when linking a shared
2044 1.1 christos library or PIE, even when the symbol is local. */
2045 1.1 christos
2046 1.1 christos static int
2047 1.8 christos must_be_dyn_reloc (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2048 1.8 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2049 1.8 christos {
2050 1.8 christos switch (r_type)
2051 1.1 christos {
2052 1.1 christos default:
2053 1.1 christos /* Only relative relocs can be resolved when the object load
2054 1.1 christos address isn't fixed. DTPREL32 is excluded because the
2055 1.1 christos dynamic linker needs to differentiate global dynamic from
2056 1.1 christos local dynamic __tls_index pairs when PPC_OPT_TLS is set. */
2057 1.1 christos return 1;
2058 1.1 christos
2059 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL24:
2060 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14:
2061 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
2062 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
2063 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL32:
2064 1.1 christos return 0;
2065 1.8 christos
2066 1.8 christos case R_PPC_TPREL32:
2067 1.8 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16:
2068 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
2069 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
2070 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
2071 1.1 christos /* These relocations are relative but in a shared library the
2072 1.1 christos linker doesn't know the thread pointer base. */
2073 1.1 christos return bfd_link_dll (info);
2074 1.1 christos }
2075 1.1 christos }
2076 1.1 christos
2077 1.1 christos /* If ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS is non-zero, the linker will try to avoid
2078 1.1 christos copying dynamic variables from a shared lib into an app's dynbss
2079 1.1 christos section, and instead use a dynamic relocation to point into the
2080 1.1 christos shared lib. */
2081 1.1 christos #define ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS 1
2082 1.1 christos
2083 1.1 christos /* Used to track dynamic relocations for local symbols. */
2084 1.1 christos struct ppc_dyn_relocs
2085 1.1 christos {
2086 1.1 christos struct ppc_dyn_relocs *next;
2087 1.1 christos
2088 1.1 christos /* The input section of the reloc. */
2089 1.1 christos asection *sec;
2090 1.1 christos
2091 1.1 christos /* Total number of relocs copied for the input section. */
2092 1.1 christos unsigned int count : 31;
2093 1.1 christos
2094 1.1 christos /* Whether this entry is for STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols. */
2095 1.1 christos unsigned int ifunc : 1;
2096 1.1 christos };
2097 1.1 christos
2098 1.1 christos /* PPC ELF linker hash entry. */
2099 1.1 christos
2100 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry
2101 1.1 christos {
2102 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry elf;
2103 1.1 christos
2104 1.1 christos /* If this symbol is used in the linker created sections, the processor
2105 1.1 christos specific backend uses this field to map the field into the offset
2106 1.8 christos from the beginning of the section. */
2107 1.8 christos elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_pointer;
2108 1.8 christos
2109 1.8 christos /* Track dynamic relocs copied for this symbol. */
2110 1.8 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs *dyn_relocs;
2111 1.8 christos
2112 1.8 christos /* Contexts in which symbol is used in the GOT.
2113 1.8 christos Bits are or'd into the mask as the corresponding relocs are
2114 1.8 christos encountered during check_relocs, with TLS_TLS being set when any
2115 1.8 christos of the other TLS bits are set. tls_optimize clears bits when
2116 1.8 christos optimizing to indicate the corresponding GOT entry type is not
2117 1.8 christos needed. If set, TLS_TLS is never cleared. tls_optimize may also
2118 1.8 christos set TLS_TPRELGD when a GD reloc turns into a TPREL one. We use a
2119 1.8 christos separate flag rather than setting TPREL just for convenience in
2120 1.8 christos distinguishing the two cases.
2121 1.8 christos These flags are also kept for local symbols. */
2122 1.8 christos #define TLS_TLS 1 /* Any TLS reloc. */
2123 1.8 christos #define TLS_GD 2 /* GD reloc. */
2124 1.8 christos #define TLS_LD 4 /* LD reloc. */
2125 1.8 christos #define TLS_TPREL 8 /* TPREL reloc, => IE. */
2126 1.8 christos #define TLS_DTPREL 16 /* DTPREL reloc, => LD. */
2127 1.8 christos #define TLS_MARK 32 /* __tls_get_addr call marked. */
2128 1.8 christos #define TLS_TPRELGD 64 /* TPREL reloc resulting from GD->IE. */
2129 1.8 christos unsigned char tls_mask;
2130 1.1 christos
2131 1.1 christos /* The above field is also used to mark function symbols. In which
2132 1.1 christos case TLS_TLS will be 0. */
2133 1.5 christos #define PLT_IFUNC 2 /* STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
2134 1.5 christos #define PLT_KEEP 4 /* inline plt call requires plt entry. */
2135 1.5 christos #define NON_GOT 256 /* local symbol plt, not stored. */
2136 1.5 christos
2137 1.5 christos /* Nonzero if we have seen a small data relocation referring to this
2138 1.1 christos symbol. */
2139 1.1 christos unsigned char has_sda_refs : 1;
2140 1.1 christos
2141 1.1 christos /* Flag use of given relocations. */
2142 1.1 christos unsigned char has_addr16_ha : 1;
2143 1.1 christos unsigned char has_addr16_lo : 1;
2144 1.1 christos };
2145 1.1 christos
2146 1.1 christos #define ppc_elf_hash_entry(ent) ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) (ent))
2147 1.1 christos
2148 1.3 christos /* PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2149 1.3 christos
2150 1.3 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table
2151 1.1 christos {
2152 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_table elf;
2153 1.1 christos
2154 1.1 christos /* Various options passed from the linker. */
2155 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_params *params;
2156 1.1 christos
2157 1.1 christos /* Short-cuts to get to dynamic linker sections. */
2158 1.8 christos asection *glink;
2159 1.8 christos asection *dynsbss;
2160 1.1 christos asection *relsbss;
2161 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_t sdata[2];
2162 1.1 christos asection *sbss;
2163 1.1 christos asection *glink_eh_frame;
2164 1.1 christos asection *pltlocal;
2165 1.1 christos asection *relpltlocal;
2166 1.1 christos
2167 1.1 christos /* The (unloaded but important) .rela.plt.unloaded on VxWorks. */
2168 1.1 christos asection *srelplt2;
2169 1.1 christos
2170 1.1 christos /* Shortcut to __tls_get_addr. */
2171 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *tls_get_addr;
2172 1.1 christos
2173 1.1 christos /* The bfd that forced an old-style PLT. */
2174 1.1 christos bfd *old_bfd;
2175 1.1 christos
2176 1.1 christos /* TLS local dynamic got entry handling. */
2177 1.1 christos union {
2178 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma refcount;
2179 1.1 christos bfd_vma offset;
2180 1.1 christos } tlsld_got;
2181 1.1 christos
2182 1.1 christos /* Offset of branch table to PltResolve function in glink. */
2183 1.1 christos bfd_vma glink_pltresolve;
2184 1.1 christos
2185 1.1 christos /* Size of reserved GOT entries. */
2186 1.1 christos unsigned int got_header_size;
2187 1.1 christos /* Non-zero if allocating the header left a gap. */
2188 1.1 christos unsigned int got_gap;
2189 1.1 christos
2190 1.7 christos /* The type of PLT we have chosen to use. */
2191 1.7 christos enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type;
2192 1.7 christos
2193 1.7 christos /* True if the target system is VxWorks. */
2194 1.7 christos unsigned int is_vxworks:1;
2195 1.8 christos
2196 1.8 christos /* Whether there exist local gnu indirect function resolvers,
2197 1.8 christos referenced by dynamic relocations. */
2198 1.8 christos unsigned int local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2199 1.8 christos unsigned int maybe_local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2200 1.8 christos
2201 1.1 christos /* Set if tls optimization is enabled. */
2202 1.1 christos unsigned int do_tls_opt:1;
2203 1.1 christos
2204 1.1 christos /* Set if inline plt calls should be converted to direct calls. */
2205 1.1 christos unsigned int can_convert_all_inline_plt:1;
2206 1.1 christos
2207 1.1 christos /* The size of PLT entries. */
2208 1.1 christos int plt_entry_size;
2209 1.1 christos /* The distance between adjacent PLT slots. */
2210 1.1 christos int plt_slot_size;
2211 1.1 christos /* The size of the first PLT entry. */
2212 1.1 christos int plt_initial_entry_size;
2213 1.1 christos
2214 1.1 christos /* Small local sym cache. */
2215 1.1 christos struct sym_cache sym_cache;
2216 1.1 christos };
2217 1.1 christos
2218 1.1 christos /* Rename some of the generic section flags to better document how they
2219 1.1 christos are used for ppc32. The flags are only valid for ppc32 elf objects. */
2220 1.1 christos
2221 1.8 christos /* Nonzero if this section has TLS related relocations. */
2222 1.8 christos #define has_tls_reloc sec_flg0
2223 1.8 christos
2224 1.1 christos /* Nonzero if this section has a call to __tls_get_addr. */
2225 1.1 christos #define has_tls_get_addr_call sec_flg1
2226 1.1 christos
2227 1.1 christos /* Flag set when PLTCALL relocs are detected. */
2228 1.1 christos #define has_pltcall sec_flg2
2229 1.1 christos
2230 1.1 christos /* Get the PPC ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure. */
2231 1.1 christos
2232 1.1 christos #define ppc_elf_hash_table(p) \
2233 1.1 christos (elf_hash_table_id ((struct elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) \
2234 1.1 christos == PPC32_ELF_DATA ? ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) : NULL)
2235 1.1 christos
2236 1.1 christos /* Create an entry in a PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2237 1.1 christos
2238 1.1 christos static struct bfd_hash_entry *
2239 1.1 christos ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
2240 1.1 christos struct bfd_hash_table *table,
2241 1.1 christos const char *string)
2242 1.1 christos {
2243 1.1 christos /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
2244 1.1 christos subclass. */
2245 1.1 christos if (entry == NULL)
2246 1.1 christos {
2247 1.1 christos entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table,
2248 1.1 christos sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry));
2249 1.1 christos if (entry == NULL)
2250 1.1 christos return entry;
2251 1.1 christos }
2252 1.1 christos
2253 1.1 christos /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
2254 1.1 christos entry = _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
2255 1.1 christos if (entry != NULL)
2256 1.1 christos {
2257 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->linker_section_pointer = NULL;
2258 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
2259 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->tls_mask = 0;
2260 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->has_sda_refs = 0;
2261 1.1 christos }
2262 1.1 christos
2263 1.1 christos return entry;
2264 1.1 christos }
2265 1.1 christos
2266 1.6 christos /* Create a PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2267 1.8 christos
2268 1.1 christos static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
2269 1.1 christos ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
2270 1.1 christos {
2271 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *ret;
2272 1.1 christos static struct ppc_elf_params default_params
2273 1.1 christos = { PLT_OLD, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 12, 0, 0, 0 };
2274 1.1 christos
2275 1.1 christos ret = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table));
2276 1.1 christos if (ret == NULL)
2277 1.1 christos return NULL;
2278 1.1 christos
2279 1.1 christos if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->elf, abfd,
2280 1.1 christos ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc,
2281 1.1 christos sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry),
2282 1.1 christos PPC32_ELF_DATA))
2283 1.1 christos {
2284 1.1 christos free (ret);
2285 1.1 christos return NULL;
2286 1.1 christos }
2287 1.3 christos
2288 1.3 christos ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.refcount = 0;
2289 1.1 christos ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.glist = NULL;
2290 1.1 christos ret->elf.init_plt_offset.offset = 0;
2291 1.1 christos ret->elf.init_plt_offset.glist = NULL;
2292 1.1 christos
2293 1.1 christos ret->params = &default_params;
2294 1.1 christos
2295 1.1 christos ret->sdata[0].name = ".sdata";
2296 1.1 christos ret->sdata[0].sym_name = "_SDA_BASE_";
2297 1.1 christos ret->sdata[0].bss_name = ".sbss";
2298 1.1 christos
2299 1.1 christos ret->sdata[1].name = ".sdata2";
2300 1.1 christos ret->sdata[1].sym_name = "_SDA2_BASE_";
2301 1.1 christos ret->sdata[1].bss_name = ".sbss2";
2302 1.1 christos
2303 1.1 christos ret->plt_entry_size = 12;
2304 1.3 christos ret->plt_slot_size = 8;
2305 1.3 christos ret->plt_initial_entry_size = 72;
2306 1.3 christos
2307 1.3 christos return &ret->elf.root;
2308 1.3 christos }
2309 1.3 christos
2310 1.3 christos /* Hook linker params into hash table. */
2311 1.3 christos
2312 1.3 christos void
2313 1.6 christos ppc_elf_link_params (struct bfd_link_info *info, struct ppc_elf_params *params)
2314 1.3 christos {
2315 1.3 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2316 1.1 christos
2317 1.1 christos if (htab)
2318 1.1 christos htab->params = params;
2319 1.1 christos params->pagesize_p2 = bfd_log2 (params->pagesize);
2320 1.1 christos }
2321 1.1 christos
2322 1.1 christos /* Create .got and the related sections. */
2323 1.1 christos
2324 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
2325 1.1 christos ppc_elf_create_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2326 1.1 christos {
2327 1.7 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2328 1.1 christos
2329 1.1 christos if (!_bfd_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info))
2330 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2331 1.7 christos
2332 1.7 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2333 1.7 christos if (!htab->is_vxworks)
2334 1.1 christos {
2335 1.1 christos /* The powerpc .got has a blrl instruction in it. Mark it
2336 1.1 christos executable. */
2337 1.1 christos flagword flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2338 1.1 christos | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2339 1.1 christos if (!bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, htab->elf.sgot, flags))
2340 1.3 christos return FALSE;
2341 1.3 christos }
2342 1.3 christos
2343 1.3 christos return TRUE;
2344 1.3 christos }
2345 1.3 christos
2346 1.3 christos /* Create a special linker section, used for R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16 and
2347 1.3 christos R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16 pointers. These sections become part of .sdata
2348 1.3 christos and .sdata2. Create _SDA_BASE_ and _SDA2_BASE too. */
2349 1.3 christos
2350 1.3 christos static bfd_boolean
2351 1.3 christos ppc_elf_create_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
2352 1.3 christos struct bfd_link_info *info,
2353 1.3 christos flagword flags,
2354 1.3 christos elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
2355 1.3 christos {
2356 1.3 christos asection *s;
2357 1.3 christos
2358 1.3 christos flags |= (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
2359 1.3 christos | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2360 1.3 christos
2361 1.3 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, lsect->name, flags);
2362 1.3 christos if (s == NULL)
2363 1.3 christos return FALSE;
2364 1.3 christos lsect->section = s;
2365 1.3 christos
2366 1.3 christos /* Define the sym on the first section of this name. */
2367 1.3 christos s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, lsect->name);
2368 1.3 christos
2369 1.3 christos lsect->sym = _bfd_elf_define_linkage_sym (abfd, info, s, lsect->sym_name);
2370 1.1 christos if (lsect->sym == NULL)
2371 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2372 1.1 christos lsect->sym->root.u.def.value = 0x8000;
2373 1.1 christos return TRUE;
2374 1.1 christos }
2375 1.1 christos
2376 1.8 christos static bfd_boolean
2377 1.1 christos ppc_elf_create_glink (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2378 1.1 christos {
2379 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2380 1.1 christos asection *s;
2381 1.1 christos flagword flags;
2382 1.8 christos int p2align;
2383 1.8 christos
2384 1.8 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2385 1.1 christos | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2386 1.8 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".glink", flags);
2387 1.1 christos htab->glink = s;
2388 1.1 christos p2align = htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 6 : 4;
2389 1.1 christos if (p2align < htab->params->plt_stub_align)
2390 1.1 christos p2align = htab->params->plt_stub_align;
2391 1.1 christos if (s == NULL
2392 1.1 christos || !bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, p2align))
2393 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2394 1.1 christos
2395 1.1 christos if (!info->no_ld_generated_unwind_info)
2396 1.1 christos {
2397 1.1 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2398 1.1 christos | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2399 1.1 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".eh_frame", flags);
2400 1.1 christos htab->glink_eh_frame = s;
2401 1.1 christos if (s == NULL
2402 1.7 christos || !bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 2))
2403 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2404 1.1 christos }
2405 1.1 christos
2406 1.1 christos flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2407 1.1 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".iplt", flags);
2408 1.1 christos htab->elf.iplt = s;
2409 1.1 christos if (s == NULL
2410 1.7 christos || !bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 4))
2411 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2412 1.1 christos
2413 1.1 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2414 1.3 christos | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2415 1.8 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.iplt", flags);
2416 1.8 christos htab->elf.irelplt = s;
2417 1.8 christos if (s == NULL
2418 1.8 christos || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 2))
2419 1.8 christos return FALSE;
2420 1.8 christos
2421 1.8 christos /* Local plt entries. */
2422 1.8 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD
2423 1.8 christos | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2424 1.8 christos htab->pltlocal = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".branch_lt",
2425 1.8 christos flags);
2426 1.8 christos if (htab->pltlocal == NULL
2427 1.8 christos || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, htab->pltlocal, 2))
2428 1.8 christos return FALSE;
2429 1.8 christos
2430 1.8 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
2431 1.8 christos {
2432 1.8 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY
2433 1.8 christos | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2434 1.8 christos htab->relpltlocal
2435 1.3 christos = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.branch_lt", flags);
2436 1.3 christos if (htab->relpltlocal == NULL
2437 1.3 christos || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, htab->relpltlocal, 2))
2438 1.3 christos return FALSE;
2439 1.3 christos }
2440 1.3 christos
2441 1.3 christos if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, 0,
2442 1.3 christos &htab->sdata[0]))
2443 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2444 1.1 christos
2445 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, SEC_READONLY,
2446 1.1 christos &htab->sdata[1]))
2447 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2448 1.1 christos
2449 1.1 christos return TRUE;
2450 1.1 christos }
2451 1.1 christos
2452 1.1 christos /* We have to create .dynsbss and .rela.sbss here so that they get mapped
2453 1.1 christos to output sections (just like _bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections has
2454 1.1 christos to create .dynbss and .rela.bss). */
2455 1.1 christos
2456 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
2457 1.1 christos ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2458 1.1 christos {
2459 1.7 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2460 1.1 christos asection *s;
2461 1.1 christos flagword flags;
2462 1.1 christos
2463 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2464 1.1 christos
2465 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL
2466 1.1 christos && !ppc_elf_create_got (abfd, info))
2467 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2468 1.1 christos
2469 1.1 christos if (!_bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info))
2470 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2471 1.1 christos
2472 1.1 christos if (htab->glink == NULL
2473 1.1 christos && !ppc_elf_create_glink (abfd, info))
2474 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2475 1.1 christos
2476 1.6 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".dynsbss",
2477 1.1 christos SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2478 1.1 christos htab->dynsbss = s;
2479 1.1 christos if (s == NULL)
2480 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2481 1.1 christos
2482 1.1 christos if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
2483 1.1 christos {
2484 1.1 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2485 1.1 christos | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2486 1.1 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.sbss", flags);
2487 1.1 christos htab->relsbss = s;
2488 1.1 christos if (s == NULL
2489 1.1 christos || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 2))
2490 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2491 1.7 christos }
2492 1.1 christos
2493 1.1 christos if (htab->is_vxworks
2494 1.1 christos && !elf_vxworks_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info, &htab->srelplt2))
2495 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2496 1.1 christos
2497 1.1 christos s = htab->elf.splt;
2498 1.1 christos flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2499 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
2500 1.1 christos /* The VxWorks PLT is a loaded section with contents. */
2501 1.1 christos flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY;
2502 1.1 christos return bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, s, flags);
2503 1.1 christos }
2504 1.1 christos
2505 1.1 christos /* Copy the extra info we tack onto an elf_link_hash_entry. */
2506 1.1 christos
2507 1.1 christos static void
2508 1.1 christos ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2509 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
2510 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
2511 1.1 christos {
2512 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *edir, *eind;
2513 1.1 christos
2514 1.7 christos edir = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir;
2515 1.7 christos eind = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind;
2516 1.1 christos
2517 1.1 christos edir->tls_mask |= eind->tls_mask;
2518 1.8 christos edir->has_sda_refs |= eind->has_sda_refs;
2519 1.1 christos
2520 1.1 christos if (edir->elf.versioned != versioned_hidden)
2521 1.1 christos edir->elf.ref_dynamic |= eind->elf.ref_dynamic;
2522 1.8 christos edir->elf.ref_regular |= eind->elf.ref_regular;
2523 1.8 christos edir->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= eind->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
2524 1.8 christos edir->elf.non_got_ref |= eind->elf.non_got_ref;
2525 1.8 christos edir->elf.needs_plt |= eind->elf.needs_plt;
2526 1.1 christos edir->elf.pointer_equality_needed |= eind->elf.pointer_equality_needed;
2527 1.1 christos
2528 1.1 christos /* If we were called to copy over info for a weak sym, that's all. */
2529 1.1 christos if (eind->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
2530 1.1 christos return;
2531 1.1 christos
2532 1.1 christos if (eind->dyn_relocs != NULL)
2533 1.1 christos {
2534 1.1 christos if (edir->dyn_relocs != NULL)
2535 1.1 christos {
2536 1.1 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
2537 1.1 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
2538 1.1 christos
2539 1.1 christos /* Add reloc counts against the indirect sym to the direct sym
2540 1.1 christos list. Merge any entries against the same section. */
2541 1.1 christos for (pp = &eind->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
2542 1.1 christos {
2543 1.1 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs *q;
2544 1.1 christos
2545 1.1 christos for (q = edir->dyn_relocs; q != NULL; q = q->next)
2546 1.1 christos if (q->sec == p->sec)
2547 1.1 christos {
2548 1.1 christos q->pc_count += p->pc_count;
2549 1.1 christos q->count += p->count;
2550 1.1 christos *pp = p->next;
2551 1.1 christos break;
2552 1.1 christos }
2553 1.1 christos if (q == NULL)
2554 1.1 christos pp = &p->next;
2555 1.1 christos }
2556 1.1 christos *pp = edir->dyn_relocs;
2557 1.1 christos }
2558 1.1 christos
2559 1.1 christos edir->dyn_relocs = eind->dyn_relocs;
2560 1.1 christos eind->dyn_relocs = NULL;
2561 1.1 christos }
2562 1.1 christos
2563 1.1 christos /* Copy over the GOT refcount entries that we may have already seen to
2564 1.1 christos the symbol which just became indirect. */
2565 1.1 christos edir->elf.got.refcount += eind->elf.got.refcount;
2566 1.1 christos eind->elf.got.refcount = 0;
2567 1.1 christos
2568 1.1 christos /* And plt entries. */
2569 1.1 christos if (eind->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
2570 1.1 christos {
2571 1.1 christos if (edir->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
2572 1.1 christos {
2573 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **entp;
2574 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
2575 1.1 christos
2576 1.1 christos for (entp = &eind->elf.plt.plist; (ent = *entp) != NULL; )
2577 1.1 christos {
2578 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *dent;
2579 1.1 christos
2580 1.1 christos for (dent = edir->elf.plt.plist; dent != NULL; dent = dent->next)
2581 1.1 christos if (dent->sec == ent->sec && dent->addend == ent->addend)
2582 1.1 christos {
2583 1.1 christos dent->plt.refcount += ent->plt.refcount;
2584 1.1 christos *entp = ent->next;
2585 1.1 christos break;
2586 1.1 christos }
2587 1.1 christos if (dent == NULL)
2588 1.1 christos entp = &ent->next;
2589 1.1 christos }
2590 1.1 christos *entp = edir->elf.plt.plist;
2591 1.1 christos }
2592 1.1 christos
2593 1.1 christos edir->elf.plt.plist = eind->elf.plt.plist;
2594 1.1 christos eind->elf.plt.plist = NULL;
2595 1.1 christos }
2596 1.1 christos
2597 1.1 christos if (eind->elf.dynindx != -1)
2598 1.1 christos {
2599 1.1 christos if (edir->elf.dynindx != -1)
2600 1.1 christos _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
2601 1.1 christos edir->elf.dynstr_index);
2602 1.1 christos edir->elf.dynindx = eind->elf.dynindx;
2603 1.1 christos edir->elf.dynstr_index = eind->elf.dynstr_index;
2604 1.1 christos eind->elf.dynindx = -1;
2605 1.1 christos eind->elf.dynstr_index = 0;
2606 1.1 christos }
2607 1.1 christos }
2608 1.1 christos
2609 1.1 christos /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
2610 1.1 christos file. We use it to put .comm items in .sbss, and not .bss. */
2611 1.1 christos
2612 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
2613 1.1 christos ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
2614 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info,
2615 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
2616 1.6 christos const char **namep ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2617 1.1 christos flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2618 1.1 christos asection **secp,
2619 1.1 christos bfd_vma *valp)
2620 1.1 christos {
2621 1.1 christos if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
2622 1.1 christos && !bfd_link_relocatable (info)
2623 1.1 christos && is_ppc_elf (info->output_bfd)
2624 1.1 christos && sym->st_size <= elf_gp_size (abfd))
2625 1.1 christos {
2626 1.1 christos /* Common symbols less than or equal to -G nn bytes are automatically
2627 1.1 christos put into .sbss. */
2628 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2629 1.1 christos
2630 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2631 1.1 christos if (htab->sbss == NULL)
2632 1.1 christos {
2633 1.1 christos flagword flags = SEC_IS_COMMON | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2634 1.1 christos
2635 1.1 christos if (!htab->elf.dynobj)
2636 1.1 christos htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2637 1.1 christos
2638 1.1 christos htab->sbss = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (htab->elf.dynobj,
2639 1.1 christos ".sbss",
2640 1.1 christos flags);
2641 1.1 christos if (htab->sbss == NULL)
2642 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2643 1.1 christos }
2644 1.1 christos
2645 1.1 christos *secp = htab->sbss;
2646 1.1 christos *valp = sym->st_size;
2647 1.1 christos }
2648 1.1 christos
2649 1.1 christos return TRUE;
2650 1.1 christos }
2651 1.1 christos
2652 1.1 christos /* Find a linker generated pointer with a given addend and type. */
2654 1.1 christos
2655 1.1 christos static elf_linker_section_pointers_t *
2656 1.1 christos elf_find_pointer_linker_section
2657 1.1 christos (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_pointers,
2658 1.1 christos bfd_vma addend,
2659 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
2660 1.1 christos {
2661 1.1 christos for ( ; linker_pointers != NULL; linker_pointers = linker_pointers->next)
2662 1.1 christos if (lsect == linker_pointers->lsect && addend == linker_pointers->addend)
2663 1.1 christos return linker_pointers;
2664 1.3 christos
2665 1.3 christos return NULL;
2666 1.3 christos }
2667 1.3 christos
2668 1.1 christos /* Allocate a pointer to live in a linker created section. */
2669 1.1 christos
2670 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
2671 1.1 christos elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
2672 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
2673 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2674 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
2675 1.1 christos {
2676 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr_linker_section_ptr = NULL;
2677 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
2678 1.1 christos unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2679 1.1 christos bfd_size_type amt;
2680 1.1 christos
2681 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
2682 1.1 christos
2683 1.1 christos /* Is this a global symbol? */
2684 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
2685 1.1 christos {
2686 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
2687 1.1 christos
2688 1.1 christos /* Has this symbol already been allocated? If so, our work is done. */
2689 1.1 christos eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2690 1.1 christos if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (eh->linker_section_pointer,
2691 1.1 christos rel->r_addend,
2692 1.1 christos lsect))
2693 1.1 christos return TRUE;
2694 1.1 christos
2695 1.1 christos ptr_linker_section_ptr = &eh->linker_section_pointer;
2696 1.1 christos }
2697 1.1 christos else
2698 1.1 christos {
2699 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
2700 1.1 christos
2701 1.1 christos /* Allocation of a pointer to a local symbol. */
2702 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd);
2703 1.1 christos
2704 1.1 christos /* Allocate a table to hold the local symbols if first time. */
2705 1.1 christos if (!ptr)
2706 1.1 christos {
2707 1.1 christos unsigned int num_symbols = elf_symtab_hdr (abfd).sh_info;
2708 1.1 christos
2709 1.1 christos amt = num_symbols;
2710 1.1 christos amt *= sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *);
2711 1.1 christos ptr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
2712 1.1 christos
2713 1.1 christos if (!ptr)
2714 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2715 1.1 christos
2716 1.1 christos elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd) = ptr;
2717 1.1 christos }
2718 1.1 christos
2719 1.1 christos /* Has this symbol already been allocated? If so, our work is done. */
2720 1.1 christos if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (ptr[r_symndx],
2721 1.1 christos rel->r_addend,
2722 1.1 christos lsect))
2723 1.1 christos return TRUE;
2724 1.1 christos
2725 1.1 christos ptr_linker_section_ptr = &ptr[r_symndx];
2726 1.1 christos }
2727 1.1 christos
2728 1.1 christos /* Allocate space for a pointer in the linker section, and allocate
2729 1.1 christos a new pointer record from internal memory. */
2730 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (ptr_linker_section_ptr != NULL);
2731 1.1 christos amt = sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t);
2732 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2733 1.1 christos
2734 1.1 christos if (!linker_section_ptr)
2735 1.3 christos return FALSE;
2736 1.3 christos
2737 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr->next = *ptr_linker_section_ptr;
2738 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr->addend = rel->r_addend;
2739 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr->lsect = lsect;
2740 1.1 christos *ptr_linker_section_ptr = linker_section_ptr;
2741 1.1 christos
2742 1.1 christos if (!bfd_set_section_alignment (lsect->section->owner, lsect->section, 2))
2743 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2744 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr->offset = lsect->section->size;
2745 1.1 christos lsect->section->size += 4;
2746 1.1 christos
2747 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
2748 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr,
2749 1.1 christos "Create pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld, section size = %ld\n",
2750 1.1 christos lsect->name, (long) linker_section_ptr->offset,
2751 1.1 christos (long) lsect->section->size);
2752 1.1 christos #endif
2753 1.1 christos
2754 1.1 christos return TRUE;
2755 1.1 christos }
2756 1.1 christos
2757 1.1 christos static struct plt_entry **
2758 1.8 christos update_local_sym_info (bfd *abfd,
2759 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
2760 1.1 christos unsigned long r_symndx,
2761 1.1 christos int tls_type)
2762 1.1 christos {
2763 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
2764 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt;
2765 1.1 christos unsigned char *local_got_tls_masks;
2766 1.1 christos
2767 1.1 christos if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2768 1.1 christos {
2769 1.1 christos bfd_size_type size = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
2770 1.1 christos
2771 1.1 christos size *= (sizeof (*local_got_refcounts)
2772 1.1 christos + sizeof (*local_plt)
2773 1.1 christos + sizeof (*local_got_tls_masks));
2774 1.8 christos local_got_refcounts = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size);
2775 1.8 christos if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2776 1.8 christos return NULL;
2777 1.1 christos elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) = local_got_refcounts;
2778 1.1 christos }
2779 1.1 christos
2780 1.1 christos local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_refcounts + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2781 1.1 christos local_got_tls_masks = (unsigned char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2782 1.1 christos local_got_tls_masks[r_symndx] |= tls_type & 0xff;
2783 1.1 christos if ((tls_type & NON_GOT) == 0)
2784 1.1 christos local_got_refcounts[r_symndx] += 1;
2785 1.1 christos return local_plt + r_symndx;
2786 1.1 christos }
2787 1.1 christos
2788 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
2789 1.1 christos update_plt_info (bfd *abfd, struct plt_entry **plist,
2790 1.1 christos asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
2791 1.1 christos {
2792 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
2793 1.1 christos
2794 1.1 christos if (addend < 32768)
2795 1.1 christos sec = NULL;
2796 1.1 christos for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
2797 1.1 christos if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
2798 1.1 christos break;
2799 1.1 christos if (ent == NULL)
2800 1.1 christos {
2801 1.1 christos bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*ent);
2802 1.1 christos ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2803 1.1 christos if (ent == NULL)
2804 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2805 1.1 christos ent->next = *plist;
2806 1.1 christos ent->sec = sec;
2807 1.1 christos ent->addend = addend;
2808 1.1 christos ent->plt.refcount = 0;
2809 1.1 christos *plist = ent;
2810 1.1 christos }
2811 1.1 christos ent->plt.refcount += 1;
2812 1.1 christos return TRUE;
2813 1.1 christos }
2814 1.1 christos
2815 1.1 christos static struct plt_entry *
2816 1.1 christos find_plt_ent (struct plt_entry **plist, asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
2817 1.1 christos {
2818 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
2819 1.1 christos
2820 1.1 christos if (addend < 32768)
2821 1.1 christos sec = NULL;
2822 1.1 christos for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
2823 1.1 christos if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
2824 1.1 christos break;
2825 1.1 christos return ent;
2826 1.1 christos }
2827 1.1 christos
2828 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
2829 1.1 christos is_branch_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2830 1.1 christos {
2831 1.1 christos return (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
2832 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_LOCAL24PC
2833 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_REL24
2834 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_REL14
2835 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
2836 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN
2837 1.8 christos || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR24
2838 1.8 christos || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14
2839 1.8 christos || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
2840 1.8 christos || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN
2841 1.8 christos || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_REL24);
2842 1.8 christos }
2843 1.8 christos
2844 1.8 christos /* Relocs on inline plt call sequence insns prior to the call. */
2845 1.8 christos
2846 1.8 christos static bfd_boolean
2847 1.8 christos is_plt_seq_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2848 1.1 christos {
2849 1.1 christos return (r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA
2850 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2851 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2852 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLTSEQ);
2853 1.8 christos }
2854 1.1 christos
2855 1.1 christos static void
2856 1.1 christos bad_shared_reloc (bfd *abfd, enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2857 1.1 christos {
2858 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler
2859 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
2860 1.1 christos (_("%pB: relocation %s cannot be used when making a shared object"),
2861 1.1 christos abfd,
2862 1.1 christos ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
2863 1.1 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
2864 1.1 christos }
2865 1.1 christos
2866 1.1 christos /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
2867 1.1 christos allocate space in the global offset table or procedure linkage
2868 1.1 christos table. */
2869 1.1 christos
2870 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
2871 1.1 christos ppc_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd,
2872 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info,
2873 1.1 christos asection *sec,
2874 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
2875 1.1 christos {
2876 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2877 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2878 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
2879 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
2880 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
2881 1.1 christos asection *got2, *sreloc;
2882 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *tga;
2883 1.1 christos
2884 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
2885 1.1 christos return TRUE;
2886 1.1 christos
2887 1.1 christos /* Don't do anything special with non-loaded, non-alloced sections.
2888 1.1 christos In particular, any relocs in such sections should not affect GOT
2889 1.1 christos and PLT reference counting (ie. we don't allow them to create GOT
2890 1.8 christos or PLT entries), there's no possibility or desire to optimize TLS
2891 1.1 christos relocs, and there's not much point in propagating relocs to shared
2892 1.1 christos libs that the dynamic linker won't relocate. */
2893 1.1 christos if ((sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
2894 1.1 christos return TRUE;
2895 1.1 christos
2896 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
2897 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_check_relocs called for section %pA in %pB",
2898 1.1 christos sec, abfd);
2899 1.1 christos #endif
2900 1.1 christos
2901 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
2902 1.1 christos
2903 1.1 christos /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
2904 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
2905 1.1 christos ppc_elf_howto_init ();
2906 1.1 christos
2907 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2908 1.1 christos if (htab->glink == NULL)
2909 1.1 christos {
2910 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2911 1.1 christos htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2912 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_create_glink (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
2913 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2914 1.1 christos }
2915 1.1 christos tga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
2916 1.1 christos FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
2917 1.1 christos symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
2918 1.1 christos sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
2919 1.1 christos got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
2920 1.1 christos sreloc = NULL;
2921 1.1 christos
2922 1.6 christos rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
2923 1.8 christos for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
2924 1.8 christos {
2925 1.1 christos unsigned long r_symndx;
2926 1.1 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
2927 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
2928 1.1 christos int tls_type;
2929 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **ifunc;
2930 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **pltent;
2931 1.1 christos bfd_vma addend;
2932 1.1 christos
2933 1.1 christos r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2934 1.1 christos if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
2935 1.1 christos h = NULL;
2936 1.1 christos else
2937 1.1 christos {
2938 1.1 christos h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
2939 1.1 christos while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
2940 1.1 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
2941 1.7 christos h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
2942 1.1 christos }
2943 1.1 christos
2944 1.1 christos /* If a relocation refers to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_, create the .got.
2945 1.1 christos This shows up in particular in an R_PPC_ADDR32 in the eabi
2946 1.1 christos startup code. */
2947 1.1 christos if (h != NULL
2948 1.1 christos && htab->elf.sgot == NULL
2949 1.1 christos && strcmp (h->root.root.string, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_") == 0)
2950 1.1 christos {
2951 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2952 1.1 christos htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2953 1.6 christos if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
2954 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2955 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (h == htab->elf.hgot);
2956 1.1 christos }
2957 1.1 christos
2958 1.1 christos tls_type = 0;
2959 1.1 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
2960 1.1 christos ifunc = NULL;
2961 1.1 christos if (h == NULL && !htab->is_vxworks)
2962 1.1 christos {
2963 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
2964 1.1 christos abfd, r_symndx);
2965 1.8 christos if (isym == NULL)
2966 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2967 1.1 christos
2968 1.1 christos if (ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
2969 1.1 christos {
2970 1.1 christos /* Set PLT_IFUNC flag for this sym, no GOT entry yet. */
2971 1.1 christos ifunc = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
2972 1.6 christos NON_GOT | PLT_IFUNC);
2973 1.8 christos if (ifunc == NULL)
2974 1.8 christos return FALSE;
2975 1.8 christos
2976 1.8 christos /* STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols must have a PLT entry;
2977 1.1 christos In a non-pie executable even when there are
2978 1.8 christos no plt calls. */
2979 1.1 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
2980 1.8 christos || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
2981 1.8 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2982 1.8 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2983 1.8 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA)
2984 1.8 christos {
2985 1.8 christos addend = 0;
2986 1.8 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
2987 1.1 christos ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
2988 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)
2989 1.1 christos && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
2990 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2991 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2992 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
2993 1.1 christos addend = rel->r_addend;
2994 1.1 christos if (!update_plt_info (abfd, ifunc, got2, addend))
2995 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2996 1.1 christos }
2997 1.1 christos }
2998 1.1 christos }
2999 1.1 christos
3000 1.1 christos if (!htab->is_vxworks
3001 1.1 christos && is_branch_reloc (r_type)
3002 1.1 christos && h != NULL
3003 1.1 christos && h == tga)
3004 1.1 christos {
3005 1.1 christos if (rel != relocs
3006 1.1 christos && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSGD
3007 1.1 christos || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSLD))
3008 1.1 christos /* We have a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a marker
3009 1.1 christos reloc. */
3010 1.1 christos ;
3011 1.1 christos else
3012 1.1 christos /* Mark this section as having an old-style call. */
3013 1.1 christos sec->has_tls_get_addr_call = 1;
3014 1.1 christos }
3015 1.8 christos
3016 1.8 christos switch (r_type)
3017 1.8 christos {
3018 1.8 christos case R_PPC_TLSGD:
3019 1.8 christos case R_PPC_TLSLD:
3020 1.8 christos /* These special tls relocs tie a call to __tls_get_addr with
3021 1.8 christos its parameter symbol. */
3022 1.8 christos if (h != NULL)
3023 1.8 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK;
3024 1.1 christos else
3025 1.1 christos if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
3026 1.1 christos NON_GOT | TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
3027 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3028 1.1 christos break;
3029 1.1 christos
3030 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
3031 1.1 christos break;
3032 1.1 christos
3033 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
3034 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
3035 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
3036 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
3037 1.1 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
3038 1.1 christos goto dogottls;
3039 1.1 christos
3040 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
3041 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
3042 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
3043 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
3044 1.8 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
3045 1.1 christos goto dogottls;
3046 1.1 christos
3047 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
3048 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
3049 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
3050 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
3051 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_dll (info))
3052 1.1 christos info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
3053 1.1 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
3054 1.1 christos goto dogottls;
3055 1.1 christos
3056 1.7 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
3057 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
3058 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
3059 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
3060 1.1 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
3061 1.1 christos dogottls:
3062 1.1 christos sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
3063 1.1 christos /* Fall through. */
3064 1.7 christos
3065 1.1 christos /* GOT16 relocations */
3066 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16:
3067 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
3068 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
3069 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
3070 1.1 christos /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry. */
3071 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
3072 1.1 christos {
3073 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
3074 1.1 christos htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
3075 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
3076 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3077 1.1 christos }
3078 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
3079 1.1 christos {
3080 1.1 christos h->got.refcount += 1;
3081 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= tls_type;
3082 1.1 christos }
3083 1.6 christos else
3084 1.1 christos /* This is a global offset table entry for a local symbol. */
3085 1.1 christos if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx, tls_type))
3086 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3087 1.1 christos
3088 1.1 christos /* We may also need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3089 1.1 christos an ifunc. */
3090 1.1 christos if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3091 1.1 christos {
3092 1.6 christos if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3093 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3094 1.1 christos }
3095 1.1 christos break;
3096 1.1 christos
3097 1.3 christos /* Indirect .sdata relocation. */
3098 1.3 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
3099 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
3100 1.1 christos {
3101 1.1 christos bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3102 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3103 1.1 christos }
3104 1.1 christos htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3105 1.1 christos if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[0],
3106 1.1 christos h, rel))
3107 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3108 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
3109 1.1 christos {
3110 1.6 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3111 1.1 christos h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3112 1.1 christos }
3113 1.1 christos break;
3114 1.1 christos
3115 1.3 christos /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation. */
3116 1.3 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
3117 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
3118 1.1 christos {
3119 1.1 christos bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3120 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3121 1.1 christos }
3122 1.1 christos htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3123 1.1 christos if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[1],
3124 1.1 christos h, rel))
3125 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3126 1.3 christos if (h != NULL)
3127 1.3 christos {
3128 1.7 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3129 1.3 christos h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3130 1.1 christos }
3131 1.1 christos break;
3132 1.1 christos
3133 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
3134 1.1 christos htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3135 1.1 christos /* Fall through. */
3136 1.1 christos
3137 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
3138 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
3139 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
3140 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
3141 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
3142 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
3143 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
3144 1.1 christos {
3145 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3146 1.1 christos h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3147 1.1 christos }
3148 1.1 christos break;
3149 1.1 christos
3150 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
3151 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
3152 1.8 christos case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
3153 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
3154 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
3155 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
3156 1.6 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
3157 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
3158 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
3159 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
3160 1.1 christos break;
3161 1.3 christos
3162 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
3163 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
3164 1.1 christos {
3165 1.1 christos bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3166 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3167 1.1 christos }
3168 1.1 christos htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3169 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
3170 1.1 christos {
3171 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3172 1.1 christos h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3173 1.6 christos }
3174 1.1 christos break;
3175 1.1 christos
3176 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
3177 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
3178 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
3179 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
3180 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
3181 1.1 christos {
3182 1.1 christos bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3183 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3184 1.1 christos }
3185 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
3186 1.1 christos {
3187 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3188 1.1 christos h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3189 1.1 christos }
3190 1.6 christos break;
3191 1.1 christos
3192 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
3193 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
3194 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
3195 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
3196 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
3197 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
3198 1.1 christos {
3199 1.1 christos bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3200 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3201 1.1 christos }
3202 1.8 christos if (h != NULL)
3203 1.8 christos h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3204 1.8 christos break;
3205 1.8 christos
3206 1.8 christos case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
3207 1.8 christos if (h == NULL)
3208 1.8 christos break;
3209 1.1 christos ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
3210 1.1 christos goto pltentry;
3211 1.1 christos
3212 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
3213 1.1 christos sec->has_pltcall = 1;
3214 1.8 christos /* Fall through. */
3215 1.1 christos
3216 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLT32:
3217 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
3218 1.6 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
3219 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
3220 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
3221 1.8 christos pltentry:
3222 1.8 christos #ifdef DEBUG
3223 1.8 christos fprintf (stderr, "Reloc requires a PLT entry\n");
3224 1.8 christos #endif
3225 1.1 christos /* This symbol requires a procedure linkage table entry. */
3226 1.1 christos if (h == NULL)
3227 1.1 christos {
3228 1.8 christos pltent = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
3229 1.8 christos NON_GOT | PLT_KEEP);
3230 1.1 christos if (pltent == NULL)
3231 1.8 christos return FALSE;
3232 1.1 christos }
3233 1.8 christos else
3234 1.8 christos {
3235 1.8 christos if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
3236 1.8 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= PLT_KEEP;
3237 1.8 christos h->needs_plt = 1;
3238 1.8 christos pltent = &h->plt.plist;
3239 1.8 christos }
3240 1.8 christos addend = 0;
3241 1.8 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3242 1.1 christos && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
3243 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
3244 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
3245 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
3246 1.1 christos addend = rel->r_addend;
3247 1.1 christos if (!update_plt_info (abfd, pltent, got2, addend))
3248 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3249 1.1 christos break;
3250 1.1 christos
3251 1.1 christos /* The following relocations don't need to propagate the
3252 1.1 christos relocation if linking a shared object since they are
3253 1.1 christos section relative. */
3254 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
3255 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
3256 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
3257 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
3258 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
3259 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
3260 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
3261 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
3262 1.6 christos case R_PPC_TOC16:
3263 1.1 christos break;
3264 1.1 christos
3265 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16:
3266 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
3267 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
3268 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
3269 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
3270 1.1 christos ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_rel16 = 1;
3271 1.1 christos break;
3272 1.1 christos
3273 1.1 christos /* These are just markers. */
3274 1.7 christos case R_PPC_TLS:
3275 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
3276 1.1 christos case R_PPC_NONE:
3277 1.1 christos case R_PPC_max:
3278 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELAX:
3279 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
3280 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
3281 1.1 christos case R_PPC_16DX_HA:
3282 1.1 christos break;
3283 1.1 christos
3284 1.1 christos /* These should only appear in dynamic objects. */
3285 1.1 christos case R_PPC_COPY:
3286 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
3287 1.1 christos case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
3288 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
3289 1.1 christos case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
3290 1.1 christos break;
3291 1.1 christos
3292 1.1 christos /* These aren't handled yet. We'll report an error later. */
3293 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR30:
3294 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
3295 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
3296 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
3297 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
3298 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
3299 1.1 christos break;
3300 1.1 christos
3301 1.3 christos /* This refers only to functions defined in the shared library. */
3302 1.3 christos case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
3303 1.3 christos if (h != NULL && h == htab->elf.hgot && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3304 1.3 christos {
3305 1.3 christos htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3306 1.3 christos htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3307 1.1 christos }
3308 1.1 christos if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
3309 1.1 christos {
3310 1.1 christos h->needs_plt = 1;
3311 1.1 christos if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3312 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3313 1.1 christos }
3314 1.1 christos break;
3315 1.1 christos
3316 1.1 christos /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
3317 1.1 christos Reconstruct it for later use during GC. */
3318 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
3319 1.1 christos if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
3320 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3321 1.1 christos break;
3322 1.1 christos
3323 1.1 christos /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
3324 1.1 christos used. Record for later use during GC. */
3325 1.8 christos case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
3326 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (h != NULL);
3327 1.1 christos if (h != NULL
3328 1.1 christos && !bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_addend))
3329 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3330 1.1 christos break;
3331 1.8 christos
3332 1.1 christos /* We shouldn't really be seeing TPREL32. */
3333 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL32:
3334 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16:
3335 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
3336 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
3337 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
3338 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_dll (info))
3339 1.1 christos info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
3340 1.1 christos goto dodyn;
3341 1.1 christos
3342 1.1 christos /* Nor these. */
3343 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
3344 1.6 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
3345 1.1 christos goto dodyn;
3346 1.1 christos
3347 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL32:
3348 1.1 christos if (h == NULL
3349 1.1 christos && got2 != NULL
3350 1.1 christos && (sec->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
3351 1.1 christos && bfd_link_pic (info)
3352 1.1 christos && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3353 1.1 christos {
3354 1.1 christos /* Old -fPIC gcc code has .long LCTOC1-LCFx just before
3355 1.1 christos the start of a function, which assembles to a REL32
3356 1.1 christos reference to .got2. If we detect one of these, then
3357 1.1 christos force the old PLT layout because the linker cannot
3358 1.1 christos reliably deduce the GOT pointer value needed for
3359 1.1 christos PLT call stubs. */
3360 1.1 christos asection *s;
3361 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
3362 1.1 christos
3363 1.1 christos isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
3364 1.1 christos abfd, r_symndx);
3365 1.1 christos if (isym == NULL)
3366 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3367 1.1 christos
3368 1.1 christos s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
3369 1.1 christos if (s == got2)
3370 1.1 christos {
3371 1.1 christos htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3372 1.1 christos htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3373 1.1 christos }
3374 1.1 christos }
3375 1.1 christos if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
3376 1.1 christos break;
3377 1.1 christos /* fall through */
3378 1.1 christos
3379 1.6 christos case R_PPC_ADDR32:
3380 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16:
3381 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
3382 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
3383 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
3384 1.1 christos case R_PPC_UADDR32:
3385 1.1 christos case R_PPC_UADDR16:
3386 1.1 christos if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3387 1.1 christos {
3388 1.1 christos /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3389 1.5 christos a function defined in a dynamic object. */
3390 1.5 christos if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3391 1.5 christos return FALSE;
3392 1.5 christos
3393 1.1 christos /* We may need a copy reloc too. */
3394 1.1 christos h->non_got_ref = 1;
3395 1.1 christos h->pointer_equality_needed = 1;
3396 1.1 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
3397 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha = 1;
3398 1.1 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
3399 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo = 1;
3400 1.1 christos }
3401 1.1 christos goto dodyn;
3402 1.1 christos
3403 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL24:
3404 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14:
3405 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
3406 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
3407 1.1 christos if (h == NULL)
3408 1.1 christos break;
3409 1.1 christos if (h == htab->elf.hgot)
3410 1.1 christos {
3411 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3412 1.1 christos {
3413 1.1 christos htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3414 1.1 christos htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3415 1.1 christos }
3416 1.1 christos break;
3417 1.6 christos }
3418 1.1 christos /* fall through */
3419 1.1 christos
3420 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR24:
3421 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14:
3422 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
3423 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
3424 1.1 christos if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3425 1.1 christos {
3426 1.1 christos /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3427 1.1 christos a function defined in a dynamic object. */
3428 1.1 christos h->needs_plt = 1;
3429 1.1 christos if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3430 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3431 1.1 christos break;
3432 1.1 christos }
3433 1.1 christos
3434 1.1 christos dodyn:
3435 1.1 christos /* If we are creating a shared library, and this is a reloc
3436 1.1 christos against a global symbol, or a non PC relative reloc
3437 1.1 christos against a local symbol, then we need to copy the reloc
3438 1.1 christos into the shared library. However, if we are linking with
3439 1.1 christos -Bsymbolic, we do not need to copy a reloc against a
3440 1.1 christos global symbol which is defined in an object we are
3441 1.1 christos including in the link (i.e., DEF_REGULAR is set). At
3442 1.1 christos this point we have not seen all the input files, so it is
3443 1.1 christos possible that DEF_REGULAR is not set now but will be set
3444 1.1 christos later (it is never cleared). In case of a weak definition,
3445 1.1 christos DEF_REGULAR may be cleared later by a strong definition in
3446 1.1 christos a shared library. We account for that possibility below by
3447 1.1 christos storing information in the dyn_relocs field of the hash
3448 1.1 christos table entry. A similar situation occurs when creating
3449 1.6 christos shared libraries and symbol visibility changes render the
3450 1.1 christos symbol local.
3451 1.1 christos
3452 1.1 christos If on the other hand, we are creating an executable, we
3453 1.1 christos may need to keep relocations for symbols satisfied by a
3454 1.1 christos dynamic library if we manage to avoid copy relocs for the
3455 1.1 christos symbol. */
3456 1.6 christos if ((bfd_link_pic (info)
3457 1.1 christos && (must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)
3458 1.1 christos || (h != NULL
3459 1.1 christos && (!SYMBOLIC_BIND (info, h)
3460 1.1 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
3461 1.1 christos || !h->def_regular))))
3462 1.1 christos || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
3463 1.1 christos && !bfd_link_pic (info)
3464 1.1 christos && h != NULL
3465 1.1 christos && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
3466 1.1 christos || !h->def_regular)))
3467 1.1 christos {
3468 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
3469 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr,
3470 1.1 christos "ppc_elf_check_relocs needs to "
3471 1.1 christos "create relocation for %s\n",
3472 1.1 christos (h && h->root.root.string
3473 1.1 christos ? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
3474 1.1 christos #endif
3475 1.1 christos if (sreloc == NULL)
3476 1.1 christos {
3477 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
3478 1.1 christos htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
3479 1.1 christos
3480 1.1 christos sreloc = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_reloc_section
3481 1.1 christos (sec, htab->elf.dynobj, 2, abfd, /*rela?*/ TRUE);
3482 1.1 christos
3483 1.1 christos if (sreloc == NULL)
3484 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3485 1.1 christos }
3486 1.1 christos
3487 1.1 christos /* If this is a global symbol, we count the number of
3488 1.1 christos relocations we need for this symbol. */
3489 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
3490 1.1 christos {
3491 1.1 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
3492 1.1 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
3493 1.1 christos
3494 1.1 christos rel_head = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs;
3495 1.1 christos p = *rel_head;
3496 1.1 christos if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec)
3497 1.1 christos {
3498 1.1 christos p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
3499 1.1 christos if (p == NULL)
3500 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3501 1.1 christos p->next = *rel_head;
3502 1.1 christos *rel_head = p;
3503 1.1 christos p->sec = sec;
3504 1.1 christos p->count = 0;
3505 1.1 christos p->pc_count = 0;
3506 1.1 christos }
3507 1.1 christos p->count += 1;
3508 1.1 christos if (!must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
3509 1.1 christos p->pc_count += 1;
3510 1.1 christos }
3511 1.1 christos else
3512 1.1 christos {
3513 1.1 christos /* Track dynamic relocs needed for local syms too.
3514 1.1 christos We really need local syms available to do this
3515 1.1 christos easily. Oh well. */
3516 1.1 christos struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
3517 1.1 christos struct ppc_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
3518 1.1 christos bfd_boolean is_ifunc;
3519 1.1 christos asection *s;
3520 1.1 christos void *vpp;
3521 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
3522 1.1 christos
3523 1.1 christos isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
3524 1.1 christos abfd, r_symndx);
3525 1.1 christos if (isym == NULL)
3526 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3527 1.1 christos
3528 1.1 christos s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
3529 1.1 christos if (s == NULL)
3530 1.1 christos s = sec;
3531 1.1 christos
3532 1.1 christos vpp = &elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel;
3533 1.1 christos rel_head = (struct ppc_dyn_relocs **) vpp;
3534 1.1 christos is_ifunc = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC;
3535 1.1 christos p = *rel_head;
3536 1.1 christos if (p != NULL && p->sec == sec && p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
3537 1.1 christos p = p->next;
3538 1.1 christos if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec || p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
3539 1.1 christos {
3540 1.1 christos p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
3541 1.1 christos if (p == NULL)
3542 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3543 1.1 christos p->next = *rel_head;
3544 1.1 christos *rel_head = p;
3545 1.1 christos p->sec = sec;
3546 1.1 christos p->ifunc = is_ifunc;
3547 1.1 christos p->count = 0;
3548 1.1 christos }
3549 1.1 christos p->count += 1;
3550 1.1 christos }
3551 1.1 christos }
3552 1.1 christos
3553 1.7 christos break;
3554 1.7 christos }
3555 1.8 christos }
3556 1.7 christos
3557 1.1 christos return TRUE;
3558 1.7 christos }
3559 1.1 christos
3560 1.1 christos /* Warn for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP attributes between IBFD
3562 1.1 christos and OBFD, and merge non-conflicting ones. */
3563 1.1 christos bfd_boolean
3564 1.1 christos _bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3565 1.1 christos {
3566 1.1 christos bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
3567 1.1 christos obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
3568 1.7 christos obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
3569 1.1 christos bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
3570 1.1 christos
3571 1.7 christos in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3572 1.7 christos out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3573 1.8 christos
3574 1.7 christos in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
3575 1.7 christos out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
3576 1.1 christos
3577 1.7 christos if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3578 1.7 christos {
3579 1.8 christos int in_fp = in_attr->i & 3;
3580 1.7 christos int out_fp = out_attr->i & 3;
3581 1.8 christos static bfd *last_fp, *last_ld;
3582 1.7 christos
3583 1.7 christos if (in_fp == 0)
3584 1.8 christos ;
3585 1.8 christos else if (out_fp == 0)
3586 1.8 christos {
3587 1.8 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3588 1.8 christos out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
3589 1.8 christos last_fp = ibfd;
3590 1.8 christos }
3591 1.7 christos else if (out_fp != 2 && in_fp == 2)
3592 1.8 christos {
3593 1.8 christos _bfd_error_handler
3594 1.8 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3595 1.8 christos (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
3596 1.8 christos last_fp, ibfd);
3597 1.8 christos ret = FALSE;
3598 1.8 christos }
3599 1.7 christos else if (out_fp == 2 && in_fp != 2)
3600 1.8 christos {
3601 1.8 christos _bfd_error_handler
3602 1.8 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3603 1.8 christos (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
3604 1.8 christos ibfd, last_fp);
3605 1.8 christos ret = FALSE;
3606 1.8 christos }
3607 1.7 christos else if (out_fp == 1 && in_fp == 3)
3608 1.8 christos {
3609 1.8 christos _bfd_error_handler
3610 1.8 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3611 1.8 christos (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
3612 1.8 christos "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), last_fp, ibfd);
3613 1.8 christos ret = FALSE;
3614 1.8 christos }
3615 1.7 christos else if (out_fp == 3 && in_fp == 1)
3616 1.7 christos {
3617 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
3618 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3619 1.7 christos (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
3620 1.7 christos "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), ibfd, last_fp);
3621 1.7 christos ret = FALSE;
3622 1.8 christos }
3623 1.7 christos
3624 1.8 christos in_fp = in_attr->i & 0xc;
3625 1.7 christos out_fp = out_attr->i & 0xc;
3626 1.7 christos if (in_fp == 0)
3627 1.8 christos ;
3628 1.8 christos else if (out_fp == 0)
3629 1.8 christos {
3630 1.8 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3631 1.8 christos out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
3632 1.8 christos last_ld = ibfd;
3633 1.8 christos }
3634 1.7 christos else if (out_fp != 2 * 4 && in_fp == 2 * 4)
3635 1.8 christos {
3636 1.8 christos _bfd_error_handler
3637 1.8 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3638 1.8 christos (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
3639 1.8 christos "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
3640 1.8 christos ret = FALSE;
3641 1.8 christos }
3642 1.7 christos else if (in_fp != 2 * 4 && out_fp == 2 * 4)
3643 1.8 christos {
3644 1.8 christos _bfd_error_handler
3645 1.8 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3646 1.8 christos (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
3647 1.8 christos "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
3648 1.8 christos ret = FALSE;
3649 1.8 christos }
3650 1.7 christos else if (out_fp == 1 * 4 && in_fp == 3 * 4)
3651 1.8 christos {
3652 1.8 christos _bfd_error_handler
3653 1.8 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3654 1.8 christos (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
3655 1.8 christos "%pB uses IEEE long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
3656 1.8 christos ret = FALSE;
3657 1.8 christos }
3658 1.8 christos else if (out_fp == 3 * 4 && in_fp == 1 * 4)
3659 1.8 christos {
3660 1.8 christos _bfd_error_handler
3661 1.8 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3662 1.8 christos (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
3663 1.8 christos "%pB uses IEEE long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
3664 1.1 christos ret = FALSE;
3665 1.8 christos }
3666 1.7 christos }
3667 1.7 christos
3668 1.7 christos if (!ret)
3669 1.7 christos {
3670 1.7 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3671 1.7 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3672 1.7 christos }
3673 1.7 christos return ret;
3674 1.7 christos }
3675 1.7 christos
3676 1.8 christos /* Merge object attributes from IBFD into OBFD. Warn if
3677 1.7 christos there are conflicting attributes. */
3678 1.8 christos static bfd_boolean
3679 1.8 christos ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3680 1.7 christos {
3681 1.7 christos bfd *obfd;
3682 1.7 christos obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
3683 1.7 christos obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
3684 1.1 christos bfd_boolean ret;
3685 1.1 christos
3686 1.1 christos if (!_bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (ibfd, info))
3687 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3688 1.1 christos
3689 1.8 christos obfd = info->output_bfd;
3690 1.1 christos in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3691 1.1 christos out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3692 1.7 christos
3693 1.7 christos /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector attributes and
3694 1.8 christos merge non-conflicting ones. */
3695 1.1 christos in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
3696 1.7 christos out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
3697 1.7 christos ret = TRUE;
3698 1.7 christos if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3699 1.1 christos {
3700 1.8 christos int in_vec = in_attr->i & 3;
3701 1.7 christos int out_vec = out_attr->i & 3;
3702 1.8 christos static bfd *last_vec;
3703 1.1 christos
3704 1.1 christos if (in_vec == 0)
3705 1.1 christos ;
3706 1.1 christos else if (out_vec == 0)
3707 1.1 christos {
3708 1.1 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3709 1.7 christos out_attr->i = in_vec;
3710 1.1 christos last_vec = ibfd;
3711 1.7 christos }
3712 1.7 christos /* For now, allow generic to transition to AltiVec or SPE
3713 1.8 christos without a warning. If GCC marked files with their stack
3714 1.7 christos alignment and used don't-care markings for files which are
3715 1.8 christos not affected by the vector ABI, we could warn about this
3716 1.7 christos case too. */
3717 1.7 christos else if (in_vec == 1)
3718 1.8 christos ;
3719 1.8 christos else if (out_vec == 1)
3720 1.8 christos {
3721 1.8 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3722 1.8 christos out_attr->i = in_vec;
3723 1.8 christos last_vec = ibfd;
3724 1.8 christos }
3725 1.8 christos else if (out_vec < in_vec)
3726 1.7 christos {
3727 1.8 christos _bfd_error_handler
3728 1.8 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3729 1.8 christos (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
3730 1.8 christos last_vec, ibfd);
3731 1.8 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3732 1.8 christos ret = FALSE;
3733 1.8 christos }
3734 1.8 christos else if (out_vec > in_vec)
3735 1.1 christos {
3736 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler
3737 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3738 1.1 christos (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
3739 1.1 christos ibfd, last_vec);
3740 1.1 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3741 1.1 christos ret = FALSE;
3742 1.1 christos }
3743 1.7 christos }
3744 1.7 christos
3745 1.8 christos /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return attributes
3746 1.7 christos and merge non-conflicting ones. */
3747 1.7 christos in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
3748 1.1 christos out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
3749 1.7 christos if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3750 1.7 christos {
3751 1.8 christos int in_struct = in_attr->i & 3;
3752 1.7 christos int out_struct = out_attr->i & 3;
3753 1.8 christos static bfd *last_struct;
3754 1.7 christos
3755 1.7 christos if (in_struct == 0 || in_struct == 3)
3756 1.8 christos ;
3757 1.8 christos else if (out_struct == 0)
3758 1.8 christos {
3759 1.8 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3760 1.8 christos out_attr->i = in_struct;
3761 1.8 christos last_struct = ibfd;
3762 1.8 christos }
3763 1.8 christos else if (out_struct < in_struct)
3764 1.7 christos {
3765 1.8 christos _bfd_error_handler
3766 1.8 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3767 1.8 christos (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
3768 1.8 christos "%pB uses memory"), last_struct, ibfd);
3769 1.8 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3770 1.8 christos ret = FALSE;
3771 1.8 christos }
3772 1.8 christos else if (out_struct > in_struct)
3773 1.8 christos {
3774 1.8 christos _bfd_error_handler
3775 1.8 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3776 1.8 christos (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
3777 1.8 christos "%pB uses memory"), ibfd, last_struct);
3778 1.1 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3779 1.1 christos ret = FALSE;
3780 1.1 christos }
3781 1.8 christos }
3782 1.1 christos if (!ret)
3783 1.1 christos {
3784 1.1 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3785 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3786 1.1 christos }
3787 1.1 christos
3788 1.7 christos /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones. */
3789 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, info);
3790 1.7 christos }
3791 1.1 christos
3792 1.1 christos /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
3793 1.1 christos object file when linking. */
3794 1.1 christos
3795 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
3796 1.1 christos ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3797 1.1 christos {
3798 1.1 christos bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
3799 1.7 christos flagword old_flags;
3800 1.1 christos flagword new_flags;
3801 1.1 christos bfd_boolean error;
3802 1.7 christos
3803 1.1 christos if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd) || !is_ppc_elf (obfd))
3804 1.1 christos return TRUE;
3805 1.1 christos
3806 1.1 christos /* Check if we have the same endianness. */
3807 1.1 christos if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, info))
3808 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3809 1.1 christos
3810 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (ibfd, info))
3811 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3812 1.1 christos
3813 1.1 christos new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
3814 1.1 christos old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
3815 1.1 christos if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
3816 1.1 christos {
3817 1.1 christos /* First call, no flags set. */
3818 1.1 christos elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
3819 1.1 christos elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = new_flags;
3820 1.1 christos }
3821 1.1 christos
3822 1.1 christos /* Compatible flags are ok. */
3823 1.1 christos else if (new_flags == old_flags)
3824 1.1 christos ;
3825 1.1 christos
3826 1.1 christos /* Incompatible flags. */
3827 1.1 christos else
3828 1.7 christos {
3829 1.8 christos /* Warn about -mrelocatable mismatch. Allow -mrelocatable-lib
3830 1.1 christos to be linked with either. */
3831 1.1 christos error = FALSE;
3832 1.1 christos if ((new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0
3833 1.1 christos && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0)
3834 1.1 christos {
3835 1.1 christos error = TRUE;
3836 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
3837 1.8 christos (_("%pB: compiled with -mrelocatable and linked with "
3838 1.1 christos "modules compiled normally"), ibfd);
3839 1.1 christos }
3840 1.1 christos else if ((new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0
3841 1.1 christos && (old_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0)
3842 1.1 christos {
3843 1.1 christos error = TRUE;
3844 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler
3845 1.1 christos (_("%pB: compiled normally and linked with "
3846 1.1 christos "modules compiled with -mrelocatable"), ibfd);
3847 1.1 christos }
3848 1.1 christos
3849 1.1 christos /* The output is -mrelocatable-lib iff both the input files are. */
3850 1.1 christos if (! (new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB))
3851 1.1 christos elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB;
3852 1.1 christos
3853 1.1 christos /* The output is -mrelocatable iff it can't be -mrelocatable-lib,
3854 1.1 christos but each input file is either -mrelocatable or -mrelocatable-lib. */
3855 1.1 christos if (! (elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)
3856 1.1 christos && (new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE))
3857 1.1 christos && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE)))
3858 1.1 christos elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE;
3859 1.1 christos
3860 1.1 christos /* Do not warn about eabi vs. V.4 mismatch, just or in the bit if
3861 1.1 christos any module uses it. */
3862 1.1 christos elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= (new_flags & EF_PPC_EMB);
3863 1.7 christos
3864 1.7 christos new_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
3865 1.8 christos old_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
3866 1.8 christos
3867 1.8 christos /* Warn about any other mismatches. */
3868 1.1 christos if (new_flags != old_flags)
3869 1.1 christos {
3870 1.1 christos error = TRUE;
3871 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler
3872 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3873 1.1 christos (_("%pB: uses different e_flags (%#x) fields "
3874 1.1 christos "than previous modules (%#x)"),
3875 1.1 christos ibfd, new_flags, old_flags);
3876 1.1 christos }
3877 1.1 christos
3878 1.1 christos if (error)
3879 1.1 christos {
3880 1.1 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3881 1.7 christos return FALSE;
3882 1.7 christos }
3883 1.7 christos }
3884 1.7 christos
3885 1.3 christos return TRUE;
3886 1.7 christos }
3887 1.7 christos
3888 1.1 christos static void
3889 1.8 christos ppc_elf_vle_split16 (bfd *input_bfd,
3890 1.1 christos asection *input_section,
3891 1.7 christos unsigned long offset,
3892 1.8 christos bfd_byte *loc,
3893 1.7 christos bfd_vma value,
3894 1.7 christos split16_format_type split16_format,
3895 1.7 christos bfd_boolean fixup)
3896 1.7 christos {
3897 1.7 christos unsigned int insn, opcode;
3898 1.7 christos
3899 1.7 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, loc);
3900 1.7 christos opcode = insn & E_OPCODE_MASK;
3901 1.7 christos if (opcode == E_OR2I_INSN
3902 1.7 christos || opcode == E_AND2I_DOT_INSN
3903 1.7 christos || opcode == E_OR2IS_INSN
3904 1.7 christos || opcode == E_LIS_INSN
3905 1.7 christos || opcode == E_AND2IS_DOT_INSN)
3906 1.8 christos {
3907 1.7 christos if (split16_format != split16a_type)
3908 1.7 christos {
3909 1.7 christos if (fixup)
3910 1.7 christos split16_format = split16a_type;
3911 1.7 christos else
3912 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
3913 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3914 1.7 christos (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16A style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
3915 1.7 christos input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
3916 1.7 christos }
3917 1.7 christos }
3918 1.7 christos else if (opcode == E_ADD2I_DOT_INSN
3919 1.7 christos || opcode == E_ADD2IS_INSN
3920 1.7 christos || opcode == E_CMP16I_INSN
3921 1.7 christos || opcode == E_MULL2I_INSN
3922 1.7 christos || opcode == E_CMPL16I_INSN
3923 1.7 christos || opcode == E_CMPH16I_INSN
3924 1.7 christos || opcode == E_CMPHL16I_INSN)
3925 1.8 christos {
3926 1.7 christos if (split16_format != split16d_type)
3927 1.7 christos {
3928 1.7 christos if (fixup)
3929 1.8 christos split16_format = split16d_type;
3930 1.8 christos else
3931 1.8 christos _bfd_error_handler
3932 1.8 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3933 1.8 christos (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16D style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
3934 1.8 christos input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
3935 1.8 christos }
3936 1.8 christos }
3937 1.8 christos if (split16_format == split16a_type)
3938 1.8 christos {
3939 1.8 christos insn &= ~((0xf800 << 5) | 0x7ff);
3940 1.8 christos insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
3941 1.8 christos if ((insn & E_LI_MASK) == E_LI_INSN)
3942 1.8 christos {
3943 1.8 christos /* Hack for e_li. Extend sign. */
3944 1.8 christos insn &= ~(0xf0000 >> 5);
3945 1.3 christos insn |= (-(value & 0x8000) & 0xf0000) >> 5;
3946 1.7 christos }
3947 1.1 christos }
3948 1.8 christos else
3949 1.8 christos {
3950 1.8 christos insn &= ~((0xf800 << 10) | 0x7ff);
3951 1.8 christos insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 10;
3952 1.8 christos }
3953 1.8 christos insn |= value & 0x7ff;
3954 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, loc);
3955 1.8 christos }
3956 1.8 christos
3957 1.8 christos static void
3958 1.8 christos ppc_elf_vle_split20 (bfd *output_bfd, bfd_byte *loc, bfd_vma value)
3959 1.8 christos {
3960 1.8 christos unsigned int insn;
3961 1.8 christos
3962 1.8 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
3963 1.8 christos /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31. */
3964 1.8 christos /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20. */
3965 1.1 christos insn |= (value & 0xf0000) >> 5;
3966 1.1 christos /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15. */
3967 1.1 christos insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
3968 1.1 christos /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31. */
3969 1.1 christos insn |= value & 0x7ff;
3970 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, insn, loc);
3971 1.1 christos }
3972 1.1 christos
3973 1.1 christos
3974 1.1 christos /* Choose which PLT scheme to use, and set .plt flags appropriately.
3976 1.1 christos Returns -1 on error, 0 for old PLT, 1 for new PLT. */
3977 1.1 christos int
3978 1.1 christos ppc_elf_select_plt_layout (bfd *output_bfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3979 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info)
3980 1.1 christos {
3981 1.3 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3982 1.1 christos flagword flags;
3983 1.6 christos
3984 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
3985 1.1 christos
3986 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3987 1.1 christos {
3988 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3989 1.1 christos
3990 1.1 christos if (htab->params->plt_style == PLT_OLD)
3991 1.8 christos htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3992 1.1 christos else if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3993 1.1 christos && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
3994 1.1 christos && (h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "_mcount",
3995 1.1 christos FALSE, FALSE, TRUE)) != NULL
3996 1.1 christos && (h->type == STT_FUNC
3997 1.1 christos || h->needs_plt)
3998 1.1 christos && h->ref_regular
3999 1.1 christos && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
4000 1.1 christos || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
4001 1.1 christos {
4002 1.3 christos /* Profiling of shared libs (and pies) is not supported with
4003 1.1 christos secure plt, because ppc32 does profiling before a
4004 1.1 christos function prologue and a secure plt pic call stubs needs
4005 1.1 christos r30 to be set up. */
4006 1.1 christos htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4007 1.1 christos }
4008 1.1 christos else
4009 1.1 christos {
4010 1.3 christos bfd *ibfd;
4011 1.1 christos enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type = htab->params->plt_style;
4012 1.1 christos
4013 1.1 christos /* Look through the reloc flags left by ppc_elf_check_relocs.
4014 1.1 christos Use the old style bss plt if a file makes plt calls
4015 1.1 christos without using the new relocs, and if ld isn't given
4016 1.1 christos --secure-plt and we never see REL16 relocs. */
4017 1.1 christos if (plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
4018 1.1 christos plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4019 1.1 christos for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4020 1.1 christos if (is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
4021 1.1 christos {
4022 1.1 christos if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_rel16)
4023 1.1 christos plt_type = PLT_NEW;
4024 1.1 christos else if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->makes_plt_call)
4025 1.3 christos {
4026 1.1 christos plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4027 1.1 christos htab->old_bfd = ibfd;
4028 1.8 christos break;
4029 1.1 christos }
4030 1.8 christos }
4031 1.1 christos htab->plt_type = plt_type;
4032 1.1 christos }
4033 1.1 christos }
4034 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD && htab->params->plt_style == PLT_NEW)
4035 1.1 christos {
4036 1.1 christos if (htab->old_bfd != NULL)
4037 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced due to %pB"), htab->old_bfd);
4038 1.1 christos else
4039 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced by profiling"));
4040 1.1 christos }
4041 1.7 christos
4042 1.7 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS);
4043 1.1 christos
4044 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
4045 1.1 christos {
4046 1.7 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
4047 1.7 christos | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
4048 1.1 christos
4049 1.1 christos /* The new PLT is a loaded section. */
4050 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.splt != NULL
4051 1.1 christos && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->elf.splt, flags))
4052 1.1 christos return -1;
4053 1.1 christos
4054 1.1 christos /* The new GOT is not executable. */
4055 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
4056 1.1 christos && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->elf.sgot, flags))
4057 1.1 christos return -1;
4058 1.1 christos }
4059 1.1 christos else
4060 1.1 christos {
4061 1.1 christos /* Stop an unused .glink section from affecting .text alignment. */
4062 1.1 christos if (htab->glink != NULL
4063 1.1 christos && !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->glink, 0))
4064 1.1 christos return -1;
4065 1.1 christos }
4066 1.1 christos return htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW;
4067 1.1 christos }
4068 1.1 christos
4069 1.1 christos /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
4071 1.1 christos relocation. */
4072 1.1 christos
4073 1.1 christos static asection *
4074 1.1 christos ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
4075 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info,
4076 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4077 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4078 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
4079 1.1 christos {
4080 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
4081 1.1 christos switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
4082 1.8 christos {
4083 1.8 christos case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
4084 1.8 christos case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
4085 1.8 christos return NULL;
4086 1.8 christos }
4087 1.8 christos
4088 1.8 christos return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
4089 1.1 christos }
4090 1.8 christos
4091 1.8 christos static bfd_boolean
4092 1.8 christos get_sym_h (struct elf_link_hash_entry **hp,
4093 1.8 christos Elf_Internal_Sym **symp,
4094 1.8 christos asection **symsecp,
4095 1.8 christos unsigned char **tls_maskp,
4096 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym **locsymsp,
4097 1.8 christos unsigned long r_symndx,
4098 1.8 christos bfd *ibfd)
4099 1.8 christos {
4100 1.8 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4101 1.1 christos
4102 1.8 christos if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4103 1.8 christos {
4104 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4105 1.8 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4106 1.8 christos
4107 1.1 christos h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4108 1.8 christos while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4109 1.8 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4110 1.8 christos h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4111 1.8 christos
4112 1.8 christos if (hp != NULL)
4113 1.8 christos *hp = h;
4114 1.8 christos
4115 1.8 christos if (symp != NULL)
4116 1.1 christos *symp = NULL;
4117 1.8 christos
4118 1.8 christos if (symsecp != NULL)
4119 1.8 christos {
4120 1.8 christos asection *symsec = NULL;
4121 1.1 christos if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4122 1.8 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4123 1.8 christos symsec = h->root.u.def.section;
4124 1.1 christos *symsecp = symsec;
4125 1.8 christos }
4126 1.1 christos
4127 1.8 christos if (tls_maskp != NULL)
4128 1.8 christos *tls_maskp = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
4129 1.8 christos }
4130 1.8 christos else
4131 1.8 christos {
4132 1.8 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4133 1.8 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *locsyms = *locsymsp;
4134 1.8 christos
4135 1.8 christos if (locsyms == NULL)
4136 1.8 christos {
4137 1.1 christos locsyms = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
4138 1.8 christos if (locsyms == NULL)
4139 1.8 christos locsyms = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (ibfd, symtab_hdr,
4140 1.8 christos symtab_hdr->sh_info,
4141 1.8 christos 0, NULL, NULL, NULL);
4142 1.8 christos if (locsyms == NULL)
4143 1.8 christos return FALSE;
4144 1.8 christos *locsymsp = locsyms;
4145 1.8 christos }
4146 1.1 christos sym = locsyms + r_symndx;
4147 1.8 christos
4148 1.8 christos if (hp != NULL)
4149 1.8 christos *hp = NULL;
4150 1.8 christos
4151 1.1 christos if (symp != NULL)
4152 1.8 christos *symp = sym;
4153 1.8 christos
4154 1.8 christos if (symsecp != NULL)
4155 1.1 christos *symsecp = bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, sym->st_shndx);
4156 1.8 christos
4157 1.8 christos if (tls_maskp != NULL)
4158 1.8 christos {
4159 1.8 christos bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
4160 1.8 christos unsigned char *tls_mask;
4161 1.1 christos
4162 1.8 christos tls_mask = NULL;
4163 1.1 christos local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
4164 1.8 christos if (local_got != NULL)
4165 1.8 christos {
4166 1.8 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
4167 1.8 christos (local_got + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4168 1.8 christos unsigned char *lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
4169 1.8 christos (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4170 1.8 christos tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
4171 1.8 christos }
4172 1.8 christos *tls_maskp = tls_mask;
4173 1.8 christos }
4174 1.8 christos }
4175 1.8 christos return TRUE;
4176 1.8 christos }
4177 1.8 christos
4178 1.8 christos /* Analyze inline PLT call relocations to see whether calls to locally
4180 1.8 christos defined functions can be converted to direct calls. */
4181 1.8 christos
4182 1.8 christos bfd_boolean
4183 1.8 christos ppc_elf_inline_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info)
4184 1.8 christos {
4185 1.8 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4186 1.8 christos bfd *ibfd;
4187 1.8 christos asection *sec;
4188 1.8 christos bfd_vma low_vma, high_vma, limit;
4189 1.8 christos
4190 1.8 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4191 1.8 christos if (htab == NULL)
4192 1.8 christos return FALSE;
4193 1.8 christos
4194 1.8 christos /* A bl insn can reach -0x2000000 to 0x1fffffc. The limit is
4195 1.8 christos reduced somewhat to cater for possible stubs that might be added
4196 1.8 christos between the call and its destination. */
4197 1.1 christos limit = 0x1e00000;
4198 1.8 christos low_vma = -1;
4199 1.8 christos high_vma = 0;
4200 1.8 christos for (sec = info->output_bfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4201 1.8 christos if ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE)) == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE))
4202 1.8 christos {
4203 1.8 christos if (low_vma > sec->vma)
4204 1.8 christos low_vma = sec->vma;
4205 1.8 christos if (high_vma < sec->vma + sec->size)
4206 1.8 christos high_vma = sec->vma + sec->size;
4207 1.8 christos }
4208 1.8 christos
4209 1.8 christos /* If a "bl" can reach anywhere in local code sections, then we can
4210 1.8 christos convert all inline PLT sequences to direct calls when the symbol
4211 1.8 christos is local. */
4212 1.8 christos if (high_vma - low_vma < limit)
4213 1.8 christos {
4214 1.8 christos htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt = 1;
4215 1.8 christos return TRUE;
4216 1.8 christos }
4217 1.8 christos
4218 1.8 christos /* Otherwise, go looking through relocs for cases where a direct
4219 1.8 christos call won't reach. Mark the symbol on any such reloc to disable
4220 1.8 christos the optimization and keep the PLT entry as it seems likely that
4221 1.8 christos this will be better than creating trampolines. Note that this
4222 1.8 christos will disable the optimization for all inline PLT calls to a
4223 1.8 christos particular symbol, not just those that won't reach. The
4224 1.8 christos difficulty in doing a more precise optimization is that the
4225 1.8 christos linker needs to make a decision depending on whether a
4226 1.8 christos particular R_PPC_PLTCALL insn can be turned into a direct
4227 1.1 christos call, for each of the R_PPC_PLTSEQ and R_PPC_PLT16* insns in
4228 1.8 christos the sequence, and there is nothing that ties those relocs
4229 1.8 christos together except their symbol. */
4230 1.1 christos
4231 1.8 christos for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4232 1.8 christos {
4233 1.8 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
4234 1.8 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
4235 1.8 christos
4236 1.1 christos if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
4237 1.8 christos continue;
4238 1.8 christos
4239 1.8 christos local_syms = NULL;
4240 1.8 christos symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4241 1.8 christos
4242 1.1 christos for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4243 1.8 christos if (sec->has_pltcall
4244 1.8 christos && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
4245 1.8 christos {
4246 1.8 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
4247 1.8 christos
4248 1.8 christos /* Read the relocations. */
4249 1.8 christos relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
4250 1.8 christos info->keep_memory);
4251 1.8 christos if (relstart == NULL)
4252 1.8 christos return FALSE;
4253 1.8 christos
4254 1.8 christos relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
4255 1.8 christos for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; )
4256 1.8 christos {
4257 1.8 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
4258 1.8 christos unsigned long r_symndx;
4259 1.8 christos asection *sym_sec;
4260 1.8 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4261 1.8 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4262 1.8 christos unsigned char *tls_maskp;
4263 1.8 christos
4264 1.8 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4265 1.8 christos if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTCALL)
4266 1.8 christos continue;
4267 1.8 christos
4268 1.1 christos r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4269 1.8 christos if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, &tls_maskp, &local_syms,
4270 1.8 christos r_symndx, ibfd))
4271 1.8 christos {
4272 1.8 christos if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4273 1.8 christos free (relstart);
4274 1.8 christos if (local_syms != NULL
4275 1.8 christos && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
4276 1.8 christos free (local_syms);
4277 1.8 christos return FALSE;
4278 1.8 christos }
4279 1.8 christos
4280 1.8 christos if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
4281 1.8 christos {
4282 1.8 christos bfd_vma from, to;
4283 1.8 christos if (h != NULL)
4284 1.8 christos to = h->root.u.def.value;
4285 1.8 christos else
4286 1.8 christos to = sym->st_value;
4287 1.8 christos to += (rel->r_addend
4288 1.8 christos + sym_sec->output_offset
4289 1.1 christos + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
4290 1.8 christos from = (rel->r_offset
4291 1.8 christos + sec->output_offset
4292 1.8 christos + sec->output_section->vma);
4293 1.8 christos if (to - from + limit < 2 * limit)
4294 1.8 christos *tls_maskp &= ~PLT_KEEP;
4295 1.8 christos }
4296 1.8 christos }
4297 1.1 christos if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4298 1.1 christos free (relstart);
4299 1.8 christos }
4300 1.1 christos
4301 1.1 christos if (local_syms != NULL
4302 1.8 christos && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
4303 1.1 christos {
4304 1.1 christos if (!info->keep_memory)
4305 1.1 christos free (local_syms);
4306 1.1 christos else
4307 1.3 christos symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
4308 1.1 christos }
4309 1.1 christos }
4310 1.1 christos
4311 1.1 christos return TRUE;
4312 1.1 christos }
4313 1.1 christos
4314 1.5 christos /* Set plt output section type, htab->tls_get_addr, and call the
4315 1.5 christos generic ELF tls_setup function. */
4316 1.5 christos
4317 1.3 christos asection *
4318 1.1 christos ppc_elf_tls_setup (bfd *obfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4319 1.1 christos {
4320 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4321 1.1 christos
4322 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4323 1.1 christos htab->tls_get_addr = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
4324 1.1 christos FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
4325 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
4326 1.1 christos htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = TRUE;
4327 1.1 christos
4328 1.1 christos if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
4329 1.1 christos {
4330 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *opt, *tga;
4331 1.1 christos opt = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr_opt",
4332 1.1 christos FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
4333 1.1 christos if (opt != NULL
4334 1.1 christos && (opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4335 1.1 christos || opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
4336 1.8 christos {
4337 1.1 christos /* If glibc supports an optimized __tls_get_addr call stub,
4338 1.1 christos signalled by the presence of __tls_get_addr_opt, and we'll
4339 1.1 christos be calling __tls_get_addr via a plt call stub, then
4340 1.1 christos make __tls_get_addr point to __tls_get_addr_opt. */
4341 1.1 christos tga = htab->tls_get_addr;
4342 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
4343 1.1 christos && tga != NULL
4344 1.1 christos && (tga->type == STT_FUNC
4345 1.1 christos || tga->needs_plt)
4346 1.1 christos && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, tga)
4347 1.7 christos || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, tga)))
4348 1.1 christos {
4349 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
4350 1.1 christos for (ent = tga->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4351 1.1 christos if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4352 1.1 christos break;
4353 1.1 christos if (ent != NULL)
4354 1.1 christos {
4355 1.1 christos tga->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
4356 1.1 christos tga->root.u.i.link = &opt->root;
4357 1.1 christos ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt, tga);
4358 1.1 christos opt->mark = 1;
4359 1.1 christos if (opt->dynindx != -1)
4360 1.1 christos {
4361 1.1 christos /* Use __tls_get_addr_opt in dynamic relocations. */
4362 1.3 christos opt->dynindx = -1;
4363 1.1 christos _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
4364 1.1 christos opt->dynstr_index);
4365 1.7 christos if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, opt))
4366 1.7 christos return FALSE;
4367 1.1 christos }
4368 1.7 christos htab->tls_get_addr = opt;
4369 1.7 christos }
4370 1.1 christos }
4371 1.1 christos }
4372 1.1 christos else
4373 1.1 christos htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = TRUE;
4374 1.1 christos }
4375 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
4376 1.1 christos && htab->elf.splt != NULL
4377 1.1 christos && htab->elf.splt->output_section != NULL)
4378 1.1 christos {
4379 1.1 christos elf_section_type (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHT_PROGBITS;
4380 1.1 christos elf_section_flags (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE;
4381 1.1 christos }
4382 1.1 christos
4383 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_tls_setup (obfd, info);
4384 1.1 christos }
4385 1.1 christos
4386 1.1 christos /* Return TRUE iff REL is a branch reloc with a global symbol matching
4387 1.1 christos HASH. */
4388 1.1 christos
4389 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
4390 1.1 christos branch_reloc_hash_match (const bfd *ibfd,
4391 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4392 1.1 christos const struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash)
4393 1.1 christos {
4394 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4395 1.1 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4396 1.1 christos unsigned int r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4397 1.1 christos
4398 1.1 christos if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
4399 1.1 christos {
4400 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4401 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4402 1.1 christos
4403 1.1 christos h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4404 1.1 christos while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4405 1.1 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4406 1.1 christos h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4407 1.1 christos if (h == hash)
4408 1.1 christos return TRUE;
4409 1.1 christos }
4410 1.1 christos return FALSE;
4411 1.1 christos }
4412 1.1 christos
4413 1.1 christos /* Run through all the TLS relocs looking for optimization
4414 1.6 christos opportunities. */
4415 1.1 christos
4416 1.1 christos bfd_boolean
4417 1.1 christos ppc_elf_tls_optimize (bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4418 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info)
4419 1.1 christos {
4420 1.1 christos bfd *ibfd;
4421 1.1 christos asection *sec;
4422 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4423 1.1 christos int pass;
4424 1.1 christos
4425 1.1 christos if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
4426 1.1 christos return TRUE;
4427 1.1 christos
4428 1.3 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4429 1.1 christos if (htab == NULL)
4430 1.1 christos return FALSE;
4431 1.1 christos
4432 1.1 christos /* Make two passes through the relocs. First time check that tls
4433 1.1 christos relocs involved in setting up a tls_get_addr call are indeed
4434 1.1 christos followed by such a call. If they are not, don't do any tls
4435 1.1 christos optimization. On the second pass twiddle tls_mask flags to
4436 1.1 christos notify relocate_section that optimization can be done, and
4437 1.1 christos adjust got and plt refcounts. */
4438 1.1 christos for (pass = 0; pass < 2; ++pass)
4439 1.1 christos for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4440 1.1 christos {
4441 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4442 1.1 christos asection *got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".got2");
4443 1.1 christos
4444 1.1 christos for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4445 1.1 christos if (sec->has_tls_reloc && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
4446 1.1 christos {
4447 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
4448 1.1 christos int expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
4449 1.1 christos
4450 1.1 christos /* Read the relocations. */
4451 1.8 christos relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
4452 1.8 christos info->keep_memory);
4453 1.1 christos if (relstart == NULL)
4454 1.1 christos return FALSE;
4455 1.1 christos
4456 1.1 christos relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
4457 1.1 christos for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
4458 1.1 christos {
4459 1.1 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
4460 1.1 christos unsigned long r_symndx;
4461 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
4462 1.1 christos unsigned char *tls_mask;
4463 1.1 christos unsigned char tls_set, tls_clear;
4464 1.1 christos bfd_boolean is_local;
4465 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma *got_count;
4466 1.1 christos
4467 1.1 christos r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4468 1.1 christos if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4469 1.1 christos {
4470 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4471 1.1 christos
4472 1.1 christos sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4473 1.1 christos h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4474 1.1 christos while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4475 1.1 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4476 1.1 christos h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4477 1.1 christos }
4478 1.1 christos
4479 1.1 christos is_local = FALSE;
4480 1.1 christos if (h == NULL
4481 1.1 christos || !h->def_dynamic)
4482 1.1 christos is_local = TRUE;
4483 1.1 christos
4484 1.1 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4485 1.1 christos /* If this section has old-style __tls_get_addr calls
4486 1.1 christos without marker relocs, then check that each
4487 1.1 christos __tls_get_addr call reloc is preceded by a reloc
4488 1.1 christos that conceivably belongs to the __tls_get_addr arg
4489 1.1 christos setup insn. If we don't find matching arg setup
4490 1.1 christos relocs, don't do any tls optimization. */
4491 1.1 christos if (pass == 0
4492 1.1 christos && sec->has_tls_get_addr_call
4493 1.1 christos && h != NULL
4494 1.1 christos && h == htab->tls_get_addr
4495 1.1 christos && !expecting_tls_get_addr
4496 1.1 christos && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
4497 1.1 christos {
4498 1.1 christos info->callbacks->minfo ("%H __tls_get_addr lost arg, "
4499 1.1 christos "TLS optimization disabled\n",
4500 1.1 christos ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
4501 1.7 christos if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4502 1.1 christos free (relstart);
4503 1.1 christos return TRUE;
4504 1.1 christos }
4505 1.1 christos
4506 1.1 christos expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
4507 1.1 christos switch (r_type)
4508 1.1 christos {
4509 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
4510 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
4511 1.1 christos expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
4512 1.1 christos /* Fall through. */
4513 1.1 christos
4514 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
4515 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
4516 1.1 christos /* These relocs should never be against a symbol
4517 1.1 christos defined in a shared lib. Leave them alone if
4518 1.1 christos that turns out to be the case. */
4519 1.7 christos if (!is_local)
4520 1.1 christos continue;
4521 1.1 christos
4522 1.1 christos /* LD -> LE */
4523 1.1 christos tls_set = 0;
4524 1.1 christos tls_clear = TLS_LD;
4525 1.1 christos break;
4526 1.1 christos
4527 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
4528 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
4529 1.1 christos expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
4530 1.1 christos /* Fall through. */
4531 1.1 christos
4532 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
4533 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
4534 1.1 christos if (is_local)
4535 1.1 christos /* GD -> LE */
4536 1.1 christos tls_set = 0;
4537 1.1 christos else
4538 1.1 christos /* GD -> IE */
4539 1.1 christos tls_set = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPRELGD;
4540 1.1 christos tls_clear = TLS_GD;
4541 1.1 christos break;
4542 1.1 christos
4543 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
4544 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
4545 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
4546 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
4547 1.1 christos if (is_local)
4548 1.8 christos {
4549 1.8 christos /* IE -> LE */
4550 1.8 christos tls_set = 0;
4551 1.8 christos tls_clear = TLS_TPREL;
4552 1.8 christos break;
4553 1.8 christos }
4554 1.8 christos else
4555 1.8 christos continue;
4556 1.8 christos
4557 1.8 christos case R_PPC_TLSGD:
4558 1.8 christos case R_PPC_TLSLD:
4559 1.8 christos if (rel + 1 < relend
4560 1.8 christos && is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
4561 1.8 christos {
4562 1.8 christos if (pass != 0
4563 1.8 christos && ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) != R_PPC_PLTSEQ)
4564 1.8 christos {
4565 1.8 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info);
4566 1.8 christos r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel[1].r_info);
4567 1.8 christos if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4568 1.8 christos {
4569 1.8 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4570 1.8 christos
4571 1.8 christos sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4572 1.8 christos h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4573 1.8 christos while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4574 1.8 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4575 1.8 christos h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4576 1.8 christos if (h != NULL)
4577 1.8 christos {
4578 1.8 christos struct plt_entry *ent = NULL;
4579 1.8 christos bfd_vma addend = 0;
4580 1.8 christos
4581 1.8 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4582 1.1 christos addend = rel->r_addend;
4583 1.1 christos ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist,
4584 1.1 christos got2, addend);
4585 1.1 christos if (ent != NULL
4586 1.1 christos && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4587 1.1 christos ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
4588 1.1 christos }
4589 1.1 christos }
4590 1.1 christos }
4591 1.1 christos continue;
4592 1.1 christos }
4593 1.1 christos expecting_tls_get_addr = 2;
4594 1.8 christos tls_set = 0;
4595 1.1 christos tls_clear = 0;
4596 1.1 christos break;
4597 1.1 christos
4598 1.1 christos default:
4599 1.1 christos continue;
4600 1.1 christos }
4601 1.1 christos
4602 1.1 christos if (pass == 0)
4603 1.1 christos {
4604 1.1 christos if (!expecting_tls_get_addr
4605 1.1 christos || !sec->has_tls_get_addr_call)
4606 1.1 christos continue;
4607 1.1 christos
4608 1.1 christos if (rel + 1 < relend
4609 1.1 christos && branch_reloc_hash_match (ibfd, rel + 1,
4610 1.1 christos htab->tls_get_addr))
4611 1.1 christos continue;
4612 1.1 christos
4613 1.1 christos /* Uh oh, we didn't find the expected call. We
4614 1.1 christos could just mark this symbol to exclude it
4615 1.1 christos from tls optimization but it's safer to skip
4616 1.1 christos the entire optimization. */
4617 1.1 christos info->callbacks->minfo (_("%H arg lost __tls_get_addr, "
4618 1.1 christos "TLS optimization disabled\n"),
4619 1.1 christos ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
4620 1.1 christos if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4621 1.1 christos free (relstart);
4622 1.1 christos return TRUE;
4623 1.8 christos }
4624 1.1 christos
4625 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
4626 1.1 christos {
4627 1.1 christos tls_mask = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
4628 1.1 christos got_count = &h->got.refcount;
4629 1.1 christos }
4630 1.8 christos else
4631 1.8 christos {
4632 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma *lgot_refs;
4633 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt;
4634 1.1 christos unsigned char *lgot_masks;
4635 1.1 christos
4636 1.8 christos lgot_refs = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
4637 1.8 christos if (lgot_refs == NULL)
4638 1.8 christos abort ();
4639 1.8 christos local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
4640 1.8 christos (lgot_refs + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4641 1.8 christos lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
4642 1.8 christos (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4643 1.8 christos tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
4644 1.8 christos got_count = &lgot_refs[r_symndx];
4645 1.8 christos }
4646 1.8 christos
4647 1.8 christos /* If we don't have old-style __tls_get_addr calls
4648 1.8 christos without TLSGD/TLSLD marker relocs, and we haven't
4649 1.8 christos found a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a
4650 1.8 christos marker for this symbol, then we either have a
4651 1.8 christos broken object file or an -mlongcall style
4652 1.8 christos indirect call to __tls_get_addr without a marker.
4653 1.8 christos Disable optimization in this case. */
4654 1.8 christos if ((tls_clear & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) != 0
4655 1.8 christos && !sec->has_tls_get_addr_call
4656 1.8 christos && ((*tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
4657 1.8 christos != (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK)))
4658 1.8 christos continue;
4659 1.8 christos
4660 1.8 christos if (expecting_tls_get_addr)
4661 1.8 christos {
4662 1.8 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
4663 1.8 christos bfd_vma addend = 0;
4664 1.8 christos
4665 1.8 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)
4666 1.8 christos && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTREL24
4667 1.1 christos || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTCALL))
4668 1.1 christos addend = rel[1].r_addend;
4669 1.1 christos ent = find_plt_ent (&htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist,
4670 1.1 christos got2, addend);
4671 1.1 christos if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4672 1.1 christos ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
4673 1.1 christos
4674 1.1 christos if (expecting_tls_get_addr == 2)
4675 1.1 christos continue;
4676 1.1 christos }
4677 1.1 christos
4678 1.1 christos if (tls_set == 0)
4679 1.1 christos {
4680 1.1 christos /* We managed to get rid of a got entry. */
4681 1.1 christos if (*got_count > 0)
4682 1.8 christos *got_count -= 1;
4683 1.1 christos }
4684 1.1 christos
4685 1.1 christos *tls_mask |= tls_set;
4686 1.8 christos *tls_mask &= ~tls_clear;
4687 1.1 christos }
4688 1.8 christos
4689 1.1 christos if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4690 1.1 christos free (relstart);
4691 1.1 christos }
4692 1.1 christos }
4693 1.1 christos htab->do_tls_opt = 1;
4694 1.1 christos return TRUE;
4695 1.1 christos }
4696 1.1 christos
4697 1.8 christos /* Find dynamic relocs for H that apply to read-only sections. */
4699 1.8 christos
4700 1.8 christos static asection *
4701 1.8 christos readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4702 1.8 christos {
4703 1.8 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
4704 1.8 christos
4705 1.8 christos for (p = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
4706 1.8 christos {
4707 1.8 christos asection *s = p->sec->output_section;
4708 1.8 christos
4709 1.8 christos if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4710 1.8 christos return p->sec;
4711 1.8 christos }
4712 1.8 christos return NULL;
4713 1.8 christos }
4714 1.1 christos
4715 1.8 christos /* Return true if we have dynamic relocs against H or any of its weak
4716 1.8 christos aliases, that apply to read-only sections. Cannot be used after
4717 1.8 christos size_dynamic_sections. */
4718 1.8 christos
4719 1.8 christos static bfd_boolean
4720 1.8 christos alias_readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4721 1.8 christos {
4722 1.8 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
4723 1.8 christos do
4724 1.8 christos {
4725 1.8 christos if (readonly_dynrelocs (&eh->elf))
4726 1.8 christos return TRUE;
4727 1.8 christos eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (eh->elf.u.alias);
4728 1.8 christos } while (eh != NULL && &eh->elf != h);
4729 1.8 christos
4730 1.8 christos return FALSE;
4731 1.1 christos }
4732 1.1 christos
4733 1.1 christos /* Return whether H has pc-relative dynamic relocs. */
4734 1.1 christos
4735 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
4736 1.1 christos pc_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4737 1.1 christos {
4738 1.1 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
4739 1.1 christos
4740 1.1 christos for (p = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
4741 1.1 christos if (p->pc_count != 0)
4742 1.1 christos return TRUE;
4743 1.1 christos return FALSE;
4744 1.1 christos }
4745 1.1 christos
4746 1.1 christos /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
4747 1.1 christos regular object. The current definition is in some section of the
4748 1.1 christos dynamic object, but we're not including those sections. We have to
4749 1.1 christos change the definition to something the rest of the link can
4750 1.1 christos understand. */
4751 1.1 christos
4752 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
4753 1.1 christos ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
4754 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4755 1.1 christos {
4756 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4757 1.8 christos asection *s;
4758 1.1 christos
4759 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
4760 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol called for %s\n",
4761 1.1 christos h->root.root.string);
4762 1.1 christos #endif
4763 1.1 christos
4764 1.1 christos /* Make sure we know what is going on here. */
4765 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4766 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL
4767 1.8 christos && (h->needs_plt
4768 1.8 christos || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4769 1.8 christos || h->is_weakalias
4770 1.8 christos || (h->def_dynamic
4771 1.8 christos && h->ref_regular
4772 1.8 christos && !h->def_regular)));
4773 1.8 christos
4774 1.1 christos /* Deal with function syms. */
4775 1.1 christos if (h->type == STT_FUNC
4776 1.1 christos || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4777 1.1 christos || h->needs_plt)
4778 1.1 christos {
4779 1.1 christos bfd_boolean local = (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
4780 1.1 christos || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h));
4781 1.1 christos /* Discard dyn_relocs when non-pic if we've decided that a
4782 1.8 christos function symbol is local. */
4783 1.8 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info) && local)
4784 1.8 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4785 1.8 christos
4786 1.1 christos /* Clear procedure linkage table information for any symbol that
4787 1.1 christos won't need a .plt entry. */
4788 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
4789 1.1 christos for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4790 1.1 christos if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4791 1.1 christos break;
4792 1.1 christos if (ent == NULL
4793 1.1 christos || (h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC
4794 1.1 christos && local
4795 1.1 christos && (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
4796 1.1 christos || (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
4797 1.1 christos & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)))
4798 1.1 christos {
4799 1.3 christos /* A PLT entry is not required/allowed when:
4800 1.1 christos
4801 1.1 christos 1. We are not using ld.so; because then the PLT entry
4802 1.1 christos can't be set up, so we can't use one. In this case,
4803 1.3 christos ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol won't even be called.
4804 1.3 christos
4805 1.3 christos 2. GC has rendered the entry unused.
4806 1.7 christos
4807 1.7 christos 3. We know for certain that a call to this symbol
4808 1.7 christos will go to this object, or will remain undefined. */
4809 1.7 christos h->plt.plist = NULL;
4810 1.7 christos h->needs_plt = 0;
4811 1.7 christos h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
4812 1.7 christos }
4813 1.8 christos else
4814 1.8 christos {
4815 1.8 christos /* Taking a function's address in a read/write section
4816 1.3 christos doesn't require us to define the function symbol in the
4817 1.3 christos executable on a plt call stub. A dynamic reloc can
4818 1.3 christos be used instead, giving better runtime performance.
4819 1.3 christos (Calls via that function pointer don't need to bounce
4820 1.3 christos through the plt call stub.) Similarly, use a dynamic
4821 1.8 christos reloc for a weak reference when possible, allowing the
4822 1.8 christos resolution of the symbol to be set at load time rather
4823 1.8 christos than link time. */
4824 1.8 christos if ((h->pointer_equality_needed
4825 1.8 christos || (h->non_got_ref
4826 1.8 christos && !h->ref_regular_nonweak
4827 1.8 christos && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
4828 1.8 christos && !htab->is_vxworks
4829 1.8 christos && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
4830 1.1 christos && !readonly_dynrelocs (h))
4831 1.5 christos {
4832 1.8 christos h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
4833 1.1 christos /* If we haven't seen a branch reloc and the symbol
4834 1.1 christos isn't an ifunc then we don't need a plt entry. */
4835 1.1 christos if (!h->needs_plt && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
4836 1.1 christos h->plt.plist = NULL;
4837 1.1 christos }
4838 1.1 christos else if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
4839 1.1 christos /* We are going to be defining the function symbol on the
4840 1.1 christos plt stub, so no dyn_relocs needed when non-pic. */
4841 1.8 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4842 1.1 christos }
4843 1.8 christos h->protected_def = 0;
4844 1.8 christos /* Function symbols can't have copy relocs. */
4845 1.8 christos return TRUE;
4846 1.8 christos }
4847 1.8 christos else
4848 1.8 christos h->plt.plist = NULL;
4849 1.8 christos
4850 1.8 christos /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
4851 1.1 christos processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
4852 1.1 christos real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
4853 1.1 christos if (h->is_weakalias)
4854 1.1 christos {
4855 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *def = weakdef (h);
4856 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (def->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined);
4857 1.1 christos h->root.u.def.section = def->root.u.def.section;
4858 1.1 christos h->root.u.def.value = def->root.u.def.value;
4859 1.1 christos if (def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynbss
4860 1.1 christos || def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro
4861 1.6 christos || def->root.u.def.section == htab->dynsbss)
4862 1.5 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4863 1.5 christos return TRUE;
4864 1.5 christos }
4865 1.5 christos
4866 1.1 christos /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
4867 1.1 christos is not a function. */
4868 1.1 christos
4869 1.1 christos /* If we are creating a shared library, we must presume that the
4870 1.5 christos only references to the symbol are via the global offset table.
4871 1.5 christos For such cases we need not do anything here; the relocations will
4872 1.5 christos be handled correctly by relocate_section. */
4873 1.5 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4874 1.5 christos {
4875 1.5 christos h->protected_def = 0;
4876 1.5 christos return TRUE;
4877 1.5 christos }
4878 1.5 christos
4879 1.5 christos /* If there are no references to this symbol that do not use the
4880 1.5 christos GOT, we don't need to generate a copy reloc. */
4881 1.5 christos if (!h->non_got_ref)
4882 1.5 christos {
4883 1.5 christos h->protected_def = 0;
4884 1.5 christos return TRUE;
4885 1.5 christos }
4886 1.5 christos
4887 1.5 christos /* Protected variables do not work with .dynbss. The copy in
4888 1.5 christos .dynbss won't be used by the shared library with the protected
4889 1.5 christos definition for the variable. Editing to PIC, or text relocations
4890 1.5 christos are preferable to an incorrect program. */
4891 1.5 christos if (h->protected_def)
4892 1.8 christos {
4893 1.1 christos if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4894 1.8 christos && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
4895 1.1 christos && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
4896 1.1 christos && htab->params->pic_fixup == 0
4897 1.1 christos && info->disable_target_specific_optimizations <= 1)
4898 1.1 christos htab->params->pic_fixup = 1;
4899 1.1 christos return TRUE;
4900 1.1 christos }
4901 1.1 christos
4902 1.1 christos /* If -z nocopyreloc was given, we won't generate them either. */
4903 1.1 christos if (info->nocopyreloc)
4904 1.8 christos return TRUE;
4905 1.8 christos
4906 1.1 christos /* If we don't find any dynamic relocs in read-only sections, then
4907 1.1 christos we'll be keeping the dynamic relocs and avoiding the copy reloc.
4908 1.1 christos We can't do this if there are any small data relocations. This
4909 1.1 christos doesn't work on VxWorks, where we can not have dynamic
4910 1.1 christos relocations (other than copy and jump slot relocations) in an
4911 1.1 christos executable. */
4912 1.1 christos if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4913 1.1 christos && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
4914 1.1 christos && !htab->is_vxworks
4915 1.1 christos && !h->def_regular
4916 1.1 christos && !alias_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
4917 1.1 christos return TRUE;
4918 1.1 christos
4919 1.1 christos /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
4920 1.1 christos become part of the .bss section of the executable. There will be
4921 1.7 christos an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section. The dynamic
4922 1.7 christos object will contain position independent code, so all references
4923 1.1 christos from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
4924 1.7 christos offset table. The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
4925 1.1 christos determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
4926 1.1 christos both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
4927 1.1 christos same memory location for the variable.
4928 1.1 christos
4929 1.1 christos Of course, if the symbol is referenced using SDAREL relocs, we
4930 1.1 christos must instead allocate it in .sbss. */
4931 1.8 christos if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
4932 1.8 christos s = htab->dynsbss;
4933 1.8 christos else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4934 1.1 christos s = htab->elf.sdynrelro;
4935 1.1 christos else
4936 1.7 christos s = htab->elf.sdynbss;
4937 1.7 christos BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
4938 1.1 christos
4939 1.7 christos if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0 && h->size != 0)
4940 1.1 christos {
4941 1.1 christos asection *srel;
4942 1.1 christos
4943 1.1 christos /* We must generate a R_PPC_COPY reloc to tell the dynamic
4944 1.1 christos linker to copy the initial value out of the dynamic object
4945 1.8 christos and into the runtime process image. */
4946 1.8 christos if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
4947 1.3 christos srel = htab->relsbss;
4948 1.1 christos else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4949 1.1 christos srel = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
4950 1.1 christos else
4951 1.1 christos srel = htab->elf.srelbss;
4952 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (srel != NULL);
4953 1.1 christos srel->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
4954 1.1 christos h->needs_copy = 1;
4955 1.1 christos }
4956 1.1 christos
4957 1.1 christos /* We no longer want dyn_relocs. */
4958 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4959 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (info, h, s);
4960 1.1 christos }
4961 1.1 christos
4962 1.1 christos /* Generate a symbol to mark plt call stubs. For non-PIC code the sym is
4964 1.1 christos xxxxxxxx.plt_call32.<callee> where xxxxxxxx is a hex number, usually 0,
4965 1.1 christos specifying the addend on the plt relocation. For -fpic code, the sym
4966 1.1 christos is xxxxxxxx.plt_pic32.<callee>, and for -fPIC
4967 1.6 christos xxxxxxxx.got2.plt_pic32.<callee>. */
4968 1.1 christos
4969 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
4970 1.1 christos add_stub_sym (struct plt_entry *ent,
4971 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4972 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info)
4973 1.1 christos {
4974 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
4975 1.1 christos size_t len1, len2, len3;
4976 1.1 christos char *name;
4977 1.1 christos const char *stub;
4978 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4979 1.1 christos
4980 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4981 1.1 christos stub = ".plt_pic32.";
4982 1.1 christos else
4983 1.1 christos stub = ".plt_call32.";
4984 1.1 christos
4985 1.1 christos len1 = strlen (h->root.root.string);
4986 1.1 christos len2 = strlen (stub);
4987 1.1 christos len3 = 0;
4988 1.1 christos if (ent->sec)
4989 1.1 christos len3 = strlen (ent->sec->name);
4990 1.1 christos name = bfd_malloc (len1 + len2 + len3 + 9);
4991 1.1 christos if (name == NULL)
4992 1.1 christos return FALSE;
4993 1.1 christos sprintf (name, "%08x", (unsigned) ent->addend & 0xffffffff);
4994 1.1 christos if (ent->sec)
4995 1.1 christos memcpy (name + 8, ent->sec->name, len3);
4996 1.1 christos memcpy (name + 8 + len3, stub, len2);
4997 1.1 christos memcpy (name + 8 + len3 + len2, h->root.root.string, len1 + 1);
4998 1.5 christos sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, name, TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
4999 1.1 christos if (sh == NULL)
5000 1.1 christos return FALSE;
5001 1.1 christos if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5002 1.1 christos {
5003 1.1 christos sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5004 1.1 christos sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5005 1.1 christos sh->root.u.def.value = ent->glink_offset;
5006 1.1 christos sh->ref_regular = 1;
5007 1.1 christos sh->def_regular = 1;
5008 1.1 christos sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5009 1.1 christos sh->forced_local = 1;
5010 1.1 christos sh->non_elf = 0;
5011 1.1 christos sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5012 1.1 christos }
5013 1.1 christos return TRUE;
5014 1.7 christos }
5015 1.7 christos
5016 1.1 christos /* Allocate NEED contiguous space in .got, and return the offset.
5017 1.1 christos Handles allocation of the got header when crossing 32k. */
5018 1.1 christos
5019 1.1 christos static bfd_vma
5020 1.1 christos allocate_got (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab, unsigned int need)
5021 1.1 christos {
5022 1.1 christos bfd_vma where;
5023 1.1 christos unsigned int max_before_header;
5024 1.1 christos
5025 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
5026 1.1 christos {
5027 1.7 christos where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5028 1.7 christos htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
5029 1.1 christos }
5030 1.7 christos else
5031 1.7 christos {
5032 1.1 christos max_before_header = htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW ? 32768 : 32764;
5033 1.7 christos if (need <= htab->got_gap)
5034 1.7 christos {
5035 1.1 christos where = max_before_header - htab->got_gap;
5036 1.1 christos htab->got_gap -= need;
5037 1.1 christos }
5038 1.1 christos else
5039 1.1 christos {
5040 1.8 christos if (htab->elf.sgot->size + need > max_before_header
5041 1.8 christos && htab->elf.sgot->size <= max_before_header)
5042 1.8 christos {
5043 1.8 christos htab->got_gap = max_before_header - htab->elf.sgot->size;
5044 1.8 christos htab->elf.sgot->size = max_before_header + htab->got_header_size;
5045 1.8 christos }
5046 1.8 christos where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5047 1.8 christos htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
5048 1.8 christos }
5049 1.8 christos }
5050 1.8 christos return where;
5051 1.8 christos }
5052 1.8 christos
5053 1.8 christos /* Calculate size of GOT entries for symbol given its TLS_MASK.
5054 1.8 christos TLS_LD is excluded because those go in a special GOT slot. */
5055 1.8 christos
5056 1.8 christos static inline unsigned int
5057 1.8 christos got_entries_needed (int tls_mask)
5058 1.8 christos {
5059 1.8 christos unsigned int need;
5060 1.8 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) == 0)
5061 1.8 christos need = 4;
5062 1.8 christos else
5063 1.8 christos {
5064 1.8 christos need = 0;
5065 1.8 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
5066 1.8 christos need += 8;
5067 1.8 christos if ((tls_mask & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_TPRELGD)) != 0)
5068 1.8 christos need += 4;
5069 1.8 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
5070 1.8 christos need += 4;
5071 1.8 christos }
5072 1.8 christos return need;
5073 1.8 christos }
5074 1.8 christos
5075 1.8 christos /* Calculate size of relocs needed for symbol given its TLS_MASK and
5076 1.8 christos NEEDed GOT entries. KNOWN says a TPREL offset can be calculated at
5077 1.8 christos link time. */
5078 1.8 christos
5079 1.8 christos static inline unsigned int
5080 1.8 christos got_relocs_needed (int tls_mask, unsigned int need, bfd_boolean known)
5081 1.7 christos {
5082 1.7 christos /* All the entries we allocated need relocs.
5083 1.8 christos Except IE in executable with a local symbol. We could also omit
5084 1.8 christos the DTPREL reloc on the second word of a GD entry under the same
5085 1.7 christos condition as that for IE, but ld.so needs to differentiate
5086 1.7 christos LD and GD entries. */
5087 1.7 christos if (known && (tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
5088 1.7 christos && (tls_mask & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_TPRELGD)) != 0)
5089 1.8 christos need -= 4;
5090 1.8 christos return need * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
5091 1.8 christos }
5092 1.7 christos
5093 1.7 christos /* If H is undefined, make it dynamic if that makes sense. */
5094 1.7 christos
5095 1.7 christos static bfd_boolean
5096 1.7 christos ensure_undef_dynamic (struct bfd_link_info *info,
5097 1.7 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5098 1.7 christos {
5099 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
5100 1.1 christos
5101 1.1 christos if (htab->dynamic_sections_created
5102 1.1 christos && ((info->dynamic_undefined_weak != 0
5103 1.1 christos && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
5104 1.1 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
5105 1.1 christos && h->dynindx == -1
5106 1.1 christos && !h->forced_local
5107 1.1 christos && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT)
5108 1.7 christos return bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h);
5109 1.1 christos return TRUE;
5110 1.1 christos }
5111 1.1 christos
5112 1.1 christos /* Allocate space in associated reloc sections for dynamic relocs. */
5113 1.1 christos
5114 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
5115 1.5 christos allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
5116 1.5 christos {
5117 1.5 christos struct bfd_link_info *info = inf;
5118 1.5 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
5119 1.5 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5120 1.5 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
5121 1.5 christos bfd_boolean dyn;
5122 1.1 christos
5123 1.1 christos if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
5124 1.1 christos return TRUE;
5125 1.8 christos
5126 1.8 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5127 1.7 christos eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
5128 1.1 christos if (eh->elf.got.refcount > 0
5129 1.1 christos || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
5130 1.8 christos && !eh->elf.def_regular
5131 1.1 christos && eh->elf.protected_def
5132 1.8 christos && eh->has_addr16_ha
5133 1.8 christos && eh->has_addr16_lo
5134 1.8 christos && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
5135 1.8 christos {
5136 1.8 christos unsigned int need;
5137 1.8 christos
5138 1.1 christos /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5139 1.1 christos if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, &eh->elf))
5140 1.8 christos return FALSE;
5141 1.1 christos
5142 1.1 christos need = 0;
5143 1.1 christos if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5144 1.1 christos {
5145 1.1 christos if (!eh->elf.def_dynamic)
5146 1.6 christos /* We'll just use htab->tlsld_got.offset. This should
5147 1.7 christos always be the case. It's a little odd if we have
5148 1.7 christos a local dynamic reloc against a non-local symbol. */
5149 1.7 christos htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
5150 1.8 christos else
5151 1.1 christos need += 8;
5152 1.8 christos }
5153 1.8 christos need += got_entries_needed (eh->tls_mask);
5154 1.8 christos if (need == 0)
5155 1.8 christos eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5156 1.1 christos else
5157 1.8 christos {
5158 1.8 christos eh->elf.got.offset = allocate_got (htab, need);
5159 1.8 christos if ((bfd_link_pic (info)
5160 1.8 christos || (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5161 1.8 christos && eh->elf.dynindx != -1
5162 1.1 christos && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf)))
5163 1.7 christos && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, &eh->elf))
5164 1.8 christos {
5165 1.1 christos asection *rsec;
5166 1.1 christos bfd_boolean tprel_known = (bfd_link_executable (info)
5167 1.1 christos && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info,
5168 1.1 christos &eh->elf));
5169 1.1 christos
5170 1.1 christos need = got_relocs_needed (eh->tls_mask, need, tprel_known);
5171 1.8 christos if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)
5172 1.8 christos && eh->elf.def_dynamic)
5173 1.7 christos need -= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5174 1.7 christos rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
5175 1.7 christos if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5176 1.7 christos rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
5177 1.8 christos rsec->size += need;
5178 1.8 christos }
5179 1.8 christos }
5180 1.8 christos }
5181 1.8 christos else
5182 1.8 christos eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5183 1.8 christos
5184 1.8 christos /* If no dynamic sections we can't have dynamic relocs, except for
5185 1.8 christos IFUNCs which are handled even in static executables. */
5186 1.8 christos if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5187 1.7 christos && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5188 1.7 christos eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5189 1.1 christos
5190 1.1 christos /* Discard relocs on undefined symbols that must be local. */
5191 1.1 christos else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
5192 1.1 christos && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT)
5193 1.1 christos eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5194 1.1 christos
5195 1.7 christos /* Also discard relocs on undefined weak syms with non-default
5196 1.1 christos visibility, or when dynamic_undefined_weak says so. */
5197 1.1 christos else if (UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
5198 1.1 christos eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5199 1.1 christos
5200 1.1 christos if (eh->dyn_relocs == NULL)
5201 1.1 christos ;
5202 1.1 christos
5203 1.1 christos /* In the shared -Bsymbolic case, discard space allocated for
5204 1.1 christos dynamic pc-relative relocs against symbols which turn out to be
5205 1.1 christos defined in regular objects. For the normal shared case, discard
5206 1.1 christos space for relocs that have become local due to symbol visibility
5207 1.1 christos changes. */
5208 1.1 christos else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5209 1.1 christos {
5210 1.1 christos /* Relocs that use pc_count are those that appear on a call insn,
5211 1.1 christos or certain REL relocs (see must_be_dyn_reloc) that can be
5212 1.1 christos generated via assembly. We want calls to protected symbols to
5213 1.1 christos resolve directly to the function rather than going via the plt.
5214 1.1 christos If people want function pointer comparisons to work as expected
5215 1.1 christos then they should avoid writing weird assembly. */
5216 1.1 christos if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h))
5217 1.1 christos {
5218 1.1 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
5219 1.1 christos
5220 1.1 christos for (pp = &eh->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
5221 1.1 christos {
5222 1.1 christos p->count -= p->pc_count;
5223 1.1 christos p->pc_count = 0;
5224 1.1 christos if (p->count == 0)
5225 1.1 christos *pp = p->next;
5226 1.1 christos else
5227 1.1 christos pp = &p->next;
5228 1.1 christos }
5229 1.1 christos }
5230 1.1 christos
5231 1.8 christos if (htab->is_vxworks)
5232 1.1 christos {
5233 1.8 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
5234 1.8 christos
5235 1.7 christos for (pp = &eh->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
5236 1.1 christos {
5237 1.1 christos if (strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name, ".tls_vars") == 0)
5238 1.1 christos *pp = p->next;
5239 1.1 christos else
5240 1.7 christos pp = &p->next;
5241 1.1 christos }
5242 1.1 christos }
5243 1.8 christos
5244 1.5 christos if (eh->dyn_relocs != NULL)
5245 1.8 christos {
5246 1.5 christos /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5247 1.5 christos if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5248 1.5 christos return FALSE;
5249 1.5 christos }
5250 1.1 christos }
5251 1.8 christos else if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS)
5252 1.8 christos {
5253 1.7 christos /* For the non-pic case, discard space for relocs against
5254 1.1 christos symbols which turn out to need copy relocs or are not
5255 1.7 christos dynamic. */
5256 1.7 christos if (h->dynamic_adjusted
5257 1.1 christos && !h->def_regular
5258 1.7 christos && !ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (h)
5259 1.7 christos && !(h->protected_def
5260 1.1 christos && eh->has_addr16_ha
5261 1.1 christos && eh->has_addr16_lo
5262 1.7 christos && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
5263 1.1 christos {
5264 1.1 christos /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5265 1.1 christos if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5266 1.1 christos return FALSE;
5267 1.7 christos
5268 1.1 christos if (h->dynindx == -1)
5269 1.1 christos eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5270 1.1 christos }
5271 1.8 christos else
5272 1.8 christos eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5273 1.8 christos }
5274 1.8 christos
5275 1.8 christos /* Allocate space. */
5276 1.8 christos for (p = eh->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
5277 1.7 christos {
5278 1.8 christos asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
5279 1.8 christos if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5280 1.8 christos sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
5281 1.8 christos sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5282 1.8 christos }
5283 1.8 christos
5284 1.8 christos /* Handle PLT relocs. Done last, after dynindx has settled.
5285 1.8 christos We might need a PLT entry when the symbol
5286 1.8 christos a) is dynamic, or
5287 1.7 christos b) is an ifunc, or
5288 1.7 christos c) has plt16 relocs and has been processed by adjust_dynamic_symbol, or
5289 1.7 christos d) has plt16 relocs and we are linking statically. */
5290 1.8 christos dyn = htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created && h->dynindx != -1;
5291 1.7 christos if (dyn
5292 1.7 christos || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
5293 1.7 christos || (h->needs_plt && h->dynamic_adjusted)
5294 1.7 christos || (h->needs_plt
5295 1.7 christos && h->def_regular
5296 1.7 christos && !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5297 1.7 christos && !htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
5298 1.8 christos && (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
5299 1.8 christos & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) == PLT_KEEP))
5300 1.8 christos {
5301 1.8 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
5302 1.8 christos bfd_boolean doneone = FALSE;
5303 1.8 christos bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5304 1.7 christos
5305 1.7 christos for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
5306 1.7 christos if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
5307 1.7 christos {
5308 1.7 christos asection *s = htab->elf.splt;
5309 1.7 christos
5310 1.7 christos if (!dyn)
5311 1.7 christos {
5312 1.7 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5313 1.7 christos s = htab->elf.iplt;
5314 1.8 christos else
5315 1.8 christos s = htab->pltlocal;
5316 1.8 christos }
5317 1.7 christos
5318 1.8 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn)
5319 1.8 christos {
5320 1.8 christos if (!doneone)
5321 1.8 christos {
5322 1.8 christos plt_offset = s->size;
5323 1.8 christos s->size += 4;
5324 1.8 christos }
5325 1.8 christos ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5326 1.8 christos
5327 1.8 christos if (s == htab->pltlocal)
5328 1.8 christos ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5329 1.8 christos else
5330 1.8 christos {
5331 1.8 christos s = htab->glink;
5332 1.8 christos if (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info))
5333 1.8 christos {
5334 1.8 christos glink_offset = s->size;
5335 1.8 christos s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
5336 1.8 christos }
5337 1.7 christos if (!doneone
5338 1.7 christos && !bfd_link_pic (info)
5339 1.7 christos && h->def_dynamic
5340 1.7 christos && !h->def_regular)
5341 1.7 christos {
5342 1.7 christos h->root.u.def.section = s;
5343 1.7 christos h->root.u.def.value = glink_offset;
5344 1.7 christos }
5345 1.7 christos ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5346 1.7 christos
5347 1.7 christos if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms
5348 1.7 christos && !add_stub_sym (ent, h, info))
5349 1.7 christos return FALSE;
5350 1.7 christos }
5351 1.7 christos }
5352 1.7 christos else
5353 1.7 christos {
5354 1.7 christos if (!doneone)
5355 1.7 christos {
5356 1.7 christos /* If this is the first .plt entry, make room
5357 1.7 christos for the special first entry. */
5358 1.7 christos if (s->size == 0)
5359 1.7 christos s->size += htab->plt_initial_entry_size;
5360 1.7 christos
5361 1.7 christos /* The PowerPC PLT is actually composed of two
5362 1.7 christos parts, the first part is 2 words (for a load
5363 1.7 christos and a jump), and then there is a remaining
5364 1.7 christos word available at the end. */
5365 1.7 christos plt_offset = (htab->plt_initial_entry_size
5366 1.7 christos + (htab->plt_slot_size
5367 1.7 christos * ((s->size
5368 1.7 christos - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5369 1.7 christos / htab->plt_entry_size)));
5370 1.7 christos
5371 1.7 christos /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular
5372 1.7 christos file, and we are not generating a shared
5373 1.7 christos library, then set the symbol to this location
5374 1.7 christos in the .plt. This is to avoid text
5375 1.7 christos relocations, and is required to make
5376 1.7 christos function pointers compare as equal between
5377 1.7 christos the normal executable and the shared library. */
5378 1.7 christos if (! bfd_link_pic (info)
5379 1.7 christos && h->def_dynamic
5380 1.7 christos && !h->def_regular)
5381 1.7 christos {
5382 1.7 christos h->root.u.def.section = s;
5383 1.7 christos h->root.u.def.value = plt_offset;
5384 1.7 christos }
5385 1.7 christos
5386 1.7 christos /* Make room for this entry. */
5387 1.7 christos s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
5388 1.7 christos /* After the 8192nd entry, room for two entries
5389 1.7 christos is allocated. */
5390 1.8 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
5391 1.8 christos && (s->size - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5392 1.8 christos / htab->plt_entry_size
5393 1.8 christos > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES)
5394 1.8 christos s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
5395 1.8 christos }
5396 1.8 christos ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5397 1.8 christos }
5398 1.8 christos
5399 1.8 christos /* We also need to make an entry in the .rela.plt section. */
5400 1.8 christos if (!doneone)
5401 1.8 christos {
5402 1.7 christos if (!dyn)
5403 1.7 christos {
5404 1.7 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5405 1.7 christos {
5406 1.7 christos s = htab->elf.irelplt;
5407 1.7 christos s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5408 1.7 christos }
5409 1.7 christos else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5410 1.7 christos {
5411 1.7 christos s = htab->relpltlocal;
5412 1.7 christos s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5413 1.7 christos }
5414 1.7 christos }
5415 1.7 christos else
5416 1.7 christos {
5417 1.7 christos htab->elf.srelplt->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5418 1.7 christos
5419 1.7 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
5420 1.7 christos {
5421 1.7 christos /* Allocate space for the unloaded relocations. */
5422 1.7 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
5423 1.7 christos && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5424 1.7 christos {
5425 1.7 christos if (ent->plt.offset
5426 1.7 christos == (bfd_vma) htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5427 1.7 christos {
5428 1.7 christos htab->srelplt2->size
5429 1.7 christos += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
5430 1.7 christos * VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS);
5431 1.7 christos }
5432 1.7 christos
5433 1.7 christos htab->srelplt2->size
5434 1.7 christos += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
5435 1.7 christos * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS);
5436 1.7 christos }
5437 1.7 christos
5438 1.7 christos /* Every PLT entry has an associated GOT entry in
5439 1.7 christos .got.plt. */
5440 1.7 christos htab->elf.sgotplt->size += 4;
5441 1.7 christos }
5442 1.7 christos }
5443 1.7 christos doneone = TRUE;
5444 1.7 christos }
5445 1.7 christos }
5446 1.7 christos else
5447 1.7 christos ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5448 1.1 christos
5449 1.1 christos if (!doneone)
5450 1.1 christos {
5451 1.1 christos h->plt.plist = NULL;
5452 1.1 christos h->needs_plt = 0;
5453 1.1 christos }
5454 1.1 christos }
5455 1.8 christos else
5456 1.1 christos {
5457 1.8 christos h->plt.plist = NULL;
5458 1.8 christos h->needs_plt = 0;
5459 1.1 christos }
5460 1.1 christos
5461 1.1 christos return TRUE;
5462 1.8 christos }
5463 1.8 christos
5464 1.1 christos /* Set DF_TEXTREL if we find any dynamic relocs that apply to
5465 1.8 christos read-only sections. */
5466 1.8 christos
5467 1.8 christos static bfd_boolean
5468 1.8 christos maybe_set_textrel (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *info_p)
5469 1.8 christos {
5470 1.8 christos asection *sec;
5471 1.1 christos
5472 1.1 christos if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
5473 1.1 christos return TRUE;
5474 1.1 christos
5475 1.1 christos sec = readonly_dynrelocs (h);
5476 1.1 christos if (sec != NULL)
5477 1.1 christos {
5478 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) info_p;
5479 1.1 christos
5480 1.1 christos info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5481 1.1 christos info->callbacks->minfo
5482 1.1 christos (_("%pB: dynamic relocation against `%pT' in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
5483 1.1 christos sec->owner, h->root.root.string, sec);
5484 1.1 christos
5485 1.1 christos /* Not an error, just cut short the traversal. */
5486 1.1 christos return FALSE;
5487 1.1 christos }
5488 1.1 christos return TRUE;
5489 1.1 christos }
5490 1.1 christos
5491 1.1 christos static const unsigned char glink_eh_frame_cie[] =
5492 1.1 christos {
5493 1.1 christos 0, 0, 0, 16, /* length. */
5494 1.1 christos 0, 0, 0, 0, /* id. */
5495 1.3 christos 1, /* CIE version. */
5496 1.1 christos 'z', 'R', 0, /* Augmentation string. */
5497 1.1 christos 4, /* Code alignment. */
5498 1.1 christos 0x7c, /* Data alignment. */
5499 1.1 christos 65, /* RA reg. */
5500 1.1 christos 1, /* Augmentation size. */
5501 1.1 christos DW_EH_PE_pcrel | DW_EH_PE_sdata4, /* FDE encoding. */
5502 1.1 christos DW_CFA_def_cfa, 1, 0 /* def_cfa: r1 offset 0. */
5503 1.1 christos };
5504 1.1 christos
5505 1.1 christos /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections. */
5506 1.1 christos
5507 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
5508 1.1 christos ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
5509 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info)
5510 1.1 christos {
5511 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5512 1.1 christos asection *s;
5513 1.6 christos bfd_boolean relocs;
5514 1.1 christos bfd *ibfd;
5515 1.1 christos
5516 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
5517 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections called\n");
5518 1.1 christos #endif
5519 1.1 christos
5520 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5521 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL);
5522 1.1 christos
5523 1.1 christos if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
5524 1.1 christos {
5525 1.1 christos /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter. */
5526 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_executable (info) && !info->nointerp)
5527 1.1 christos {
5528 1.1 christos s = bfd_get_linker_section (htab->elf.dynobj, ".interp");
5529 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
5530 1.1 christos s->size = sizeof ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
5531 1.1 christos s->contents = (unsigned char *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
5532 1.1 christos }
5533 1.1 christos }
5534 1.1 christos
5535 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
5536 1.1 christos htab->got_header_size = 16;
5537 1.1 christos else if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
5538 1.1 christos htab->got_header_size = 12;
5539 1.1 christos
5540 1.1 christos /* Set up .got offsets for local syms, and space for local dynamic
5541 1.1 christos relocs. */
5542 1.1 christos for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
5543 1.1 christos {
5544 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
5545 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma *end_local_got;
5546 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt;
5547 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **end_local_plt;
5548 1.1 christos char *lgot_masks;
5549 1.1 christos bfd_size_type locsymcount;
5550 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
5551 1.1 christos
5552 1.1 christos if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
5553 1.1 christos continue;
5554 1.1 christos
5555 1.1 christos for (s = ibfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5556 1.1 christos {
5557 1.1 christos struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
5558 1.1 christos
5559 1.1 christos for (p = ((struct ppc_dyn_relocs *)
5560 1.1 christos elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel);
5561 1.1 christos p != NULL;
5562 1.1 christos p = p->next)
5563 1.1 christos {
5564 1.1 christos if (!bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec)
5565 1.1 christos && bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec->output_section))
5566 1.1 christos {
5567 1.1 christos /* Input section has been discarded, either because
5568 1.1 christos it is a copy of a linkonce section or due to
5569 1.1 christos linker script /DISCARD/, so we'll be discarding
5570 1.7 christos the relocs too. */
5571 1.1 christos }
5572 1.1 christos else if (htab->is_vxworks
5573 1.1 christos && strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name,
5574 1.1 christos ".tls_vars") == 0)
5575 1.8 christos {
5576 1.8 christos /* Relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections are
5577 1.8 christos handled specially by the loader. */
5578 1.8 christos }
5579 1.8 christos else if (p->count != 0)
5580 1.1 christos {
5581 1.1 christos asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
5582 1.1 christos if (p->ifunc)
5583 1.1 christos sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
5584 1.1 christos sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5585 1.1 christos if ((p->sec->output_section->flags
5586 1.1 christos & (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
5587 1.1 christos == (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
5588 1.1 christos {
5589 1.1 christos info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5590 1.1 christos info->callbacks->minfo (_("%pB: dynamic relocation in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
5591 1.1 christos p->sec->owner, p->sec);
5592 1.1 christos }
5593 1.1 christos }
5594 1.1 christos }
5595 1.1 christos }
5596 1.1 christos
5597 1.1 christos local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
5598 1.8 christos if (!local_got)
5599 1.8 christos continue;
5600 1.8 christos
5601 1.8 christos symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
5602 1.1 christos locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
5603 1.1 christos end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
5604 1.1 christos local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
5605 1.1 christos end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
5606 1.1 christos lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
5607 1.6 christos
5608 1.1 christos for (; local_got < end_local_got; ++local_got, ++lgot_masks)
5609 1.8 christos if (*local_got > 0)
5610 1.8 christos {
5611 1.8 christos unsigned int need;
5612 1.8 christos if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5613 1.8 christos htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
5614 1.8 christos need = got_entries_needed (*lgot_masks);
5615 1.7 christos if (need == 0)
5616 1.8 christos *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
5617 1.1 christos else
5618 1.1 christos {
5619 1.1 christos *local_got = allocate_got (htab, need);
5620 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5621 1.1 christos {
5622 1.1 christos asection *srel;
5623 1.1 christos bfd_boolean tprel_known = bfd_link_executable (info);
5624 1.1 christos
5625 1.1 christos need = got_relocs_needed (*lgot_masks, need, tprel_known);
5626 1.1 christos srel = htab->elf.srelgot;
5627 1.8 christos if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5628 1.8 christos srel = htab->elf.irelplt;
5629 1.1 christos srel->size += need;
5630 1.1 christos }
5631 1.1 christos }
5632 1.8 christos }
5633 1.1 christos else
5634 1.1 christos *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
5635 1.1 christos
5636 1.1 christos if (htab->is_vxworks)
5637 1.8 christos continue;
5638 1.8 christos
5639 1.8 christos /* Allocate space for calls to local STT_GNU_IFUNC syms in .iplt. */
5640 1.8 christos lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
5641 1.8 christos for (; local_plt < end_local_plt; ++local_plt, ++lgot_masks)
5642 1.8 christos {
5643 1.8 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
5644 1.8 christos bfd_boolean doneone = FALSE;
5645 1.8 christos bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5646 1.8 christos
5647 1.1 christos for (ent = *local_plt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
5648 1.1 christos if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
5649 1.1 christos {
5650 1.1 christos if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5651 1.1 christos s = htab->elf.iplt;
5652 1.1 christos else if (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
5653 1.1 christos || (*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)
5654 1.1 christos {
5655 1.8 christos ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5656 1.1 christos continue;
5657 1.8 christos }
5658 1.1 christos else
5659 1.8 christos s = htab->pltlocal;
5660 1.1 christos
5661 1.1 christos if (!doneone)
5662 1.1 christos {
5663 1.1 christos plt_offset = s->size;
5664 1.1 christos s->size += 4;
5665 1.8 christos }
5666 1.8 christos ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5667 1.8 christos
5668 1.8 christos if (s != htab->pltlocal && (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info)))
5669 1.8 christos {
5670 1.8 christos s = htab->glink;
5671 1.8 christos glink_offset = s->size;
5672 1.8 christos s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, NULL);
5673 1.8 christos }
5674 1.8 christos ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5675 1.1 christos
5676 1.1 christos if (!doneone)
5677 1.1 christos {
5678 1.1 christos if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5679 1.1 christos {
5680 1.1 christos s = htab->elf.irelplt;
5681 1.1 christos s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5682 1.1 christos }
5683 1.1 christos else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5684 1.1 christos {
5685 1.1 christos s = htab->relpltlocal;
5686 1.1 christos s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5687 1.1 christos }
5688 1.1 christos doneone = TRUE;
5689 1.6 christos }
5690 1.7 christos }
5691 1.1 christos else
5692 1.1 christos ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5693 1.1 christos }
5694 1.1 christos }
5695 1.7 christos
5696 1.1 christos /* Allocate space for global sym dynamic relocs. */
5697 1.1 christos elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), allocate_dynrelocs, info);
5698 1.1 christos
5699 1.1 christos if (htab->tlsld_got.refcount > 0)
5700 1.1 christos {
5701 1.1 christos htab->tlsld_got.offset = allocate_got (htab, 8);
5702 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5703 1.7 christos htab->elf.srelgot->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5704 1.1 christos }
5705 1.7 christos else
5706 1.1 christos htab->tlsld_got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5707 1.1 christos
5708 1.7 christos if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL && htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS)
5709 1.1 christos {
5710 1.1 christos unsigned int g_o_t = 32768;
5711 1.1 christos
5712 1.1 christos /* If we haven't allocated the header, do so now. When we get here,
5713 1.6 christos for old plt/got the got size will be 0 to 32764 (not allocated),
5714 1.1 christos or 32780 to 65536 (header allocated). For new plt/got, the
5715 1.1 christos corresponding ranges are 0 to 32768 and 32780 to 65536. */
5716 1.3 christos if (htab->elf.sgot->size <= 32768)
5717 1.3 christos {
5718 1.3 christos g_o_t = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5719 1.3 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
5720 1.3 christos g_o_t += 4;
5721 1.3 christos htab->elf.sgot->size += htab->got_header_size;
5722 1.3 christos }
5723 1.3 christos
5724 1.3 christos htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value = g_o_t;
5725 1.3 christos }
5726 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5727 1.3 christos {
5728 1.3 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
5729 1.1 christos
5730 1.1 christos sda->root.u.def.section = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section;
5731 1.1 christos sda->root.u.def.value = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
5732 1.1 christos }
5733 1.1 christos if (info->emitrelocations)
5734 1.1 christos {
5735 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
5736 1.8 christos
5737 1.8 christos if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
5738 1.8 christos sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5739 1.1 christos sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
5740 1.3 christos if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
5741 1.3 christos sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5742 1.1 christos }
5743 1.1 christos
5744 1.3 christos if (htab->glink != NULL
5745 1.1 christos && htab->glink->size != 0
5746 1.1 christos && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5747 1.1 christos {
5748 1.1 christos htab->glink_pltresolve = htab->glink->size;
5749 1.1 christos /* Space for the branch table. */
5750 1.1 christos htab->glink->size
5751 1.1 christos += htab->elf.srelplt->size / (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4) - 4;
5752 1.1 christos /* Pad out to align the start of PLTresolve. */
5753 1.1 christos htab->glink->size += -htab->glink->size & (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
5754 1.1 christos ? 63 : 15);
5755 1.1 christos htab->glink->size += GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
5756 1.1 christos
5757 1.1 christos if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
5758 1.1 christos {
5759 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
5760 1.1 christos sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink",
5761 1.5 christos TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
5762 1.1 christos if (sh == NULL)
5763 1.1 christos return FALSE;
5764 1.1 christos if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5765 1.1 christos {
5766 1.1 christos sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5767 1.1 christos sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5768 1.1 christos sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink_pltresolve;
5769 1.1 christos sh->ref_regular = 1;
5770 1.1 christos sh->def_regular = 1;
5771 1.1 christos sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5772 1.1 christos sh->forced_local = 1;
5773 1.1 christos sh->non_elf = 0;
5774 1.1 christos sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5775 1.1 christos }
5776 1.1 christos sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink_PLTresolve",
5777 1.5 christos TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
5778 1.1 christos if (sh == NULL)
5779 1.1 christos return FALSE;
5780 1.1 christos if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5781 1.1 christos {
5782 1.1 christos sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5783 1.1 christos sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5784 1.1 christos sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
5785 1.1 christos sh->ref_regular = 1;
5786 1.1 christos sh->def_regular = 1;
5787 1.1 christos sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5788 1.1 christos sh->forced_local = 1;
5789 1.1 christos sh->non_elf = 0;
5790 1.6 christos sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5791 1.1 christos }
5792 1.1 christos }
5793 1.1 christos }
5794 1.1 christos
5795 1.1 christos if (htab->glink != NULL
5796 1.1 christos && htab->glink->size != 0
5797 1.1 christos && htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
5798 1.1 christos && !bfd_is_abs_section (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section)
5799 1.1 christos && _bfd_elf_eh_frame_present (info))
5800 1.1 christos {
5801 1.1 christos s = htab->glink_eh_frame;
5802 1.1 christos s->size = sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + 20;
5803 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5804 1.1 christos {
5805 1.1 christos s->size += 4;
5806 1.1 christos if (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8 >= 256)
5807 1.1 christos s->size += 4;
5808 1.7 christos }
5809 1.7 christos }
5810 1.1 christos
5811 1.1 christos /* We've now determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections.
5812 1.1 christos Allocate memory for them. */
5813 1.1 christos relocs = FALSE;
5814 1.1 christos for (s = htab->elf.dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5815 1.1 christos {
5816 1.1 christos bfd_boolean strip_section = TRUE;
5817 1.1 christos
5818 1.1 christos if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
5819 1.7 christos continue;
5820 1.8 christos
5821 1.1 christos if (s == htab->elf.splt
5822 1.1 christos || s == htab->elf.sgot)
5823 1.7 christos {
5824 1.1 christos /* We'd like to strip these sections if they aren't needed, but if
5825 1.7 christos we've exported dynamic symbols from them we must leave them.
5826 1.7 christos It's too late to tell BFD to get rid of the symbols. */
5827 1.3 christos if (htab->elf.hplt != NULL)
5828 1.3 christos strip_section = FALSE;
5829 1.3 christos /* Strip this section if we don't need it; see the
5830 1.3 christos comment below. */
5831 1.3 christos }
5832 1.1 christos else if (s == htab->elf.iplt
5833 1.1 christos || s == htab->pltlocal
5834 1.3 christos || s == htab->glink
5835 1.1 christos || s == htab->glink_eh_frame
5836 1.1 christos || s == htab->elf.sgotplt
5837 1.1 christos || s == htab->sbss
5838 1.1 christos || s == htab->elf.sdynbss
5839 1.1 christos || s == htab->elf.sdynrelro
5840 1.1 christos || s == htab->dynsbss)
5841 1.1 christos {
5842 1.1 christos /* Strip these too. */
5843 1.1 christos }
5844 1.1 christos else if (s == htab->sdata[0].section
5845 1.1 christos || s == htab->sdata[1].section)
5846 1.1 christos {
5847 1.1 christos strip_section = (s->flags & SEC_KEEP) == 0;
5848 1.1 christos }
5849 1.1 christos else if (CONST_STRNEQ (bfd_get_section_name (htab->elf.dynobj, s),
5850 1.1 christos ".rela"))
5851 1.1 christos {
5852 1.1 christos if (s->size != 0)
5853 1.1 christos {
5854 1.1 christos /* Remember whether there are any relocation sections. */
5855 1.1 christos relocs = TRUE;
5856 1.1 christos
5857 1.1 christos /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
5858 1.1 christos to copy relocs into the output file. */
5859 1.1 christos s->reloc_count = 0;
5860 1.1 christos }
5861 1.1 christos }
5862 1.1 christos else
5863 1.1 christos {
5864 1.1 christos /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space. */
5865 1.1 christos continue;
5866 1.1 christos }
5867 1.1 christos
5868 1.1 christos if (s->size == 0 && strip_section)
5869 1.1 christos {
5870 1.1 christos /* If we don't need this section, strip it from the
5871 1.1 christos output file. This is mostly to handle .rela.bss and
5872 1.1 christos .rela.plt. We must create both sections in
5873 1.1 christos create_dynamic_sections, because they must be created
5874 1.1 christos before the linker maps input sections to output
5875 1.1 christos sections. The linker does that before
5876 1.1 christos adjust_dynamic_symbol is called, and it is that
5877 1.1 christos function which decides whether anything needs to go
5878 1.1 christos into these sections. */
5879 1.1 christos s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
5880 1.1 christos continue;
5881 1.1 christos }
5882 1.1 christos
5883 1.1 christos if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
5884 1.1 christos continue;
5885 1.1 christos
5886 1.1 christos /* Allocate memory for the section contents. */
5887 1.1 christos s->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->elf.dynobj, s->size);
5888 1.1 christos if (s->contents == NULL)
5889 1.6 christos return FALSE;
5890 1.1 christos }
5891 1.1 christos
5892 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5893 1.1 christos {
5894 1.1 christos /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section. We fill in the
5895 1.7 christos values later, in ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
5896 1.1 christos must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
5897 1.1 christos the .dynamic section. The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
5898 1.1 christos dynamic linker and used by the debugger. */
5899 1.1 christos #define add_dynamic_entry(TAG, VAL) \
5900 1.1 christos _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, TAG, VAL)
5901 1.1 christos
5902 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_executable (info))
5903 1.1 christos {
5904 1.3 christos if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_DEBUG, 0))
5905 1.3 christos return FALSE;
5906 1.3 christos }
5907 1.1 christos
5908 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.splt != NULL && htab->elf.splt->size != 0)
5909 1.1 christos {
5910 1.3 christos if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTGOT, 0)
5911 1.1 christos || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTRELSZ, 0)
5912 1.1 christos || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTREL, DT_RELA)
5913 1.1 christos || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_JMPREL, 0))
5914 1.1 christos return FALSE;
5915 1.1 christos }
5916 1.1 christos
5917 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
5918 1.1 christos && htab->glink != NULL
5919 1.1 christos && htab->glink->size != 0)
5920 1.1 christos {
5921 1.1 christos if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_GOT, 0))
5922 1.1 christos return FALSE;
5923 1.1 christos if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt
5924 1.1 christos && htab->tls_get_addr != NULL
5925 1.1 christos && htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist != NULL
5926 1.1 christos && !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_OPT, PPC_OPT_TLS))
5927 1.1 christos return FALSE;
5928 1.1 christos }
5929 1.1 christos
5930 1.1 christos if (relocs)
5931 1.1 christos {
5932 1.1 christos if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELA, 0)
5933 1.1 christos || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELASZ, 0)
5934 1.1 christos || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELAENT, sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)))
5935 1.1 christos return FALSE;
5936 1.1 christos }
5937 1.1 christos
5938 1.1 christos /* If any dynamic relocs apply to a read-only section, then we
5939 1.1 christos need a DT_TEXTREL entry. */
5940 1.1 christos if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) == 0)
5941 1.1 christos elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), maybe_set_textrel,
5942 1.1 christos info);
5943 1.1 christos
5944 1.1 christos if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) != 0)
5945 1.1 christos {
5946 1.1 christos if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_TEXTREL, 0))
5947 1.1 christos return FALSE;
5948 1.1 christos }
5949 1.1 christos if (htab->is_vxworks
5950 1.1 christos && !elf_vxworks_add_dynamic_entries (output_bfd, info))
5951 1.1 christos return FALSE;
5952 1.1 christos }
5953 1.1 christos #undef add_dynamic_entry
5954 1.1 christos
5955 1.1 christos if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
5956 1.1 christos && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
5957 1.1 christos {
5958 1.1 christos unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
5959 1.1 christos bfd_vma val;
5960 1.1 christos
5961 1.1 christos memcpy (p, glink_eh_frame_cie, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie));
5962 1.1 christos /* CIE length (rewrite in case little-endian). */
5963 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) - 4, p);
5964 1.1 christos p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
5965 1.1 christos /* FDE length. */
5966 1.1 christos val = htab->glink_eh_frame->size - 4 - sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
5967 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
5968 1.6 christos p += 4;
5969 1.1 christos /* CIE pointer. */
5970 1.1 christos val = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
5971 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
5972 1.1 christos p += 4;
5973 1.1 christos /* Offset to .glink. Set later. */
5974 1.1 christos p += 4;
5975 1.1 christos /* .glink size. */
5976 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->glink->size, p);
5977 1.1 christos p += 4;
5978 1.1 christos /* Augmentation. */
5979 1.1 christos p += 1;
5980 1.1 christos
5981 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)
5982 1.1 christos && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5983 1.1 christos {
5984 1.1 christos bfd_vma adv = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8) >> 2;
5985 1.1 christos if (adv < 64)
5986 1.1 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + adv;
5987 1.1 christos else if (adv < 256)
5988 1.1 christos {
5989 1.1 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc1;
5990 1.1 christos *p++ = adv;
5991 1.1 christos }
5992 1.1 christos else if (adv < 65536)
5993 1.1 christos {
5994 1.1 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc2;
5995 1.1 christos bfd_put_16 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
5996 1.1 christos p += 2;
5997 1.1 christos }
5998 1.1 christos else
5999 1.1 christos {
6000 1.1 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc4;
6001 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
6002 1.1 christos p += 4;
6003 1.1 christos }
6004 1.1 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_register;
6005 1.3 christos *p++ = 65;
6006 1.3 christos p++;
6007 1.3 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 4;
6008 1.3 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
6009 1.3 christos *p++ = 65;
6010 1.3 christos }
6011 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT ((bfd_vma) ((p + 3 - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents) & -4)
6012 1.3 christos == htab->glink_eh_frame->size);
6013 1.3 christos }
6014 1.3 christos
6015 1.3 christos return TRUE;
6016 1.3 christos }
6017 1.3 christos
6018 1.3 christos /* Arrange to have _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_ stripped from the output
6019 1.3 christos if it looks like nothing is using them. */
6020 1.3 christos
6021 1.3 christos static void
6022 1.3 christos maybe_strip_sdasym (bfd *output_bfd, elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
6023 1.3 christos {
6024 1.3 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = lsect->sym;
6025 1.3 christos
6026 1.3 christos if (sda != NULL && !sda->ref_regular && sda->dynindx == -1)
6027 1.3 christos {
6028 1.3 christos asection *s;
6029 1.3 christos
6030 1.3 christos s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->name);
6031 1.3 christos if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
6032 1.3 christos {
6033 1.3 christos s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->bss_name);
6034 1.3 christos if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
6035 1.3 christos {
6036 1.3 christos sda->def_regular = 0;
6037 1.3 christos /* This is somewhat magic. See elf_link_output_extsym. */
6038 1.3 christos sda->ref_dynamic = 1;
6039 1.3 christos sda->forced_local = 0;
6040 1.3 christos }
6041 1.3 christos }
6042 1.3 christos }
6043 1.3 christos }
6044 1.3 christos
6045 1.1 christos void
6046 1.1 christos ppc_elf_maybe_strip_sdata_syms (struct bfd_link_info *info)
6047 1.1 christos {
6048 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
6049 1.1 christos
6050 1.1 christos if (htab != NULL)
6051 1.1 christos {
6052 1.1 christos maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[0]);
6053 1.1 christos maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[1]);
6054 1.1 christos }
6055 1.1 christos }
6056 1.1 christos
6057 1.1 christos
6058 1.1 christos /* Return TRUE if symbol should be hashed in the `.gnu.hash' section. */
6059 1.1 christos
6060 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
6061 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6062 1.1 christos {
6063 1.1 christos if (h->plt.plist != NULL
6064 1.1 christos && !h->def_regular
6065 1.1 christos && (!h->pointer_equality_needed
6066 1.1 christos || !h->ref_regular_nonweak))
6067 1.1 christos return FALSE;
6068 1.1 christos
6069 1.3 christos return _bfd_elf_hash_symbol (h);
6070 1.1 christos }
6071 1.1 christos
6072 1.1 christos #define ARRAY_SIZE(a) (sizeof (a) / sizeof ((a)[0]))
6074 1.1 christos
6075 1.1 christos /* Relaxation trampolines. r12 is available for clobbering (r11, is
6076 1.1 christos used for some functions that are allowed to break the ABI). */
6077 1.1 christos static const int shared_stub_entry[] =
6078 1.1 christos {
6079 1.1 christos 0x7c0802a6, /* mflr 0 */
6080 1.1 christos 0x429f0005, /* bcl 20, 31, .Lxxx */
6081 1.1 christos 0x7d8802a6, /* mflr 12 */
6082 1.1 christos 0x3d8c0000, /* addis 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@ha */
6083 1.3 christos 0x398c0000, /* addi 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@l */
6084 1.3 christos 0x7c0803a6, /* mtlr 0 */
6085 1.3 christos 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
6086 1.5 christos 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
6087 1.3 christos };
6088 1.3 christos
6089 1.3 christos static const int stub_entry[] =
6090 1.3 christos {
6091 1.3 christos 0x3d800000, /* lis 12,xxx@ha */
6092 1.3 christos 0x398c0000, /* addi 12,12,xxx@l */
6093 1.3 christos 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
6094 1.1 christos 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
6095 1.1 christos };
6096 1.1 christos
6097 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_relax_info
6098 1.1 christos {
6099 1.1 christos unsigned int workaround_size;
6100 1.5 christos unsigned int picfixup_size;
6101 1.1 christos };
6102 1.5 christos
6103 1.1 christos /* This function implements long branch trampolines, and the ppc476
6104 1.1 christos icache bug workaround. Any section needing trampolines or patch
6105 1.1 christos space for the workaround has its size extended so that we can
6106 1.1 christos add trampolines at the end of the section. */
6107 1.1 christos
6108 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
6109 1.1 christos ppc_elf_relax_section (bfd *abfd,
6110 1.1 christos asection *isec,
6111 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
6112 1.1 christos bfd_boolean *again)
6113 1.1 christos {
6114 1.3 christos struct one_branch_fixup
6115 1.5 christos {
6116 1.3 christos struct one_branch_fixup *next;
6117 1.1 christos asection *tsec;
6118 1.3 christos /* Final link, can use the symbol offset. For a
6119 1.1 christos relocatable link we use the symbol's index. */
6120 1.5 christos bfd_vma toff;
6121 1.1 christos bfd_vma trampoff;
6122 1.1 christos };
6123 1.1 christos
6124 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6125 1.1 christos bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
6126 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
6127 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs = NULL;
6128 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend = NULL;
6129 1.3 christos struct one_branch_fixup *branch_fixups = NULL;
6130 1.3 christos struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
6131 1.1 christos unsigned changes = 0;
6132 1.1 christos bfd_boolean workaround_change;
6133 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6134 1.1 christos bfd_size_type trampbase, trampoff, newsize, picfixup_size;
6135 1.1 christos asection *got2;
6136 1.6 christos bfd_boolean maybe_pasted;
6137 1.3 christos
6138 1.3 christos *again = FALSE;
6139 1.3 christos
6140 1.3 christos /* No need to do anything with non-alloc or non-code sections. */
6141 1.3 christos if ((isec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
6142 1.3 christos || (isec->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0
6143 1.3 christos || (isec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
6144 1.3 christos || isec->size < 4)
6145 1.3 christos return TRUE;
6146 1.3 christos
6147 1.3 christos /* We cannot represent the required PIC relocs in the output, so don't
6148 1.3 christos do anything. The linker doesn't support mixing -shared and -r
6149 1.3 christos anyway. */
6150 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6151 1.3 christos return TRUE;
6152 1.5 christos
6153 1.5 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (link_info);
6154 1.3 christos if (htab == NULL)
6155 1.3 christos return TRUE;
6156 1.3 christos
6157 1.3 christos isec->size = (isec->size + 3) & -4;
6158 1.3 christos if (isec->rawsize == 0)
6159 1.3 christos isec->rawsize = isec->size;
6160 1.3 christos trampbase = isec->size;
6161 1.3 christos
6162 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT (isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_NONE
6163 1.3 christos || isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET);
6164 1.3 christos isec->sec_info_type = SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET;
6165 1.1 christos
6166 1.1 christos if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
6167 1.1 christos || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6168 1.1 christos {
6169 1.3 christos if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
6170 1.3 christos {
6171 1.1 christos elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info
6172 1.1 christos = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_relax_info));
6173 1.1 christos if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
6174 1.5 christos return FALSE;
6175 1.5 christos }
6176 1.5 christos relax_info = elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info;
6177 1.1 christos trampbase -= relax_info->workaround_size;
6178 1.3 christos }
6179 1.3 christos
6180 1.1 christos maybe_pasted = (strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
6181 1.3 christos || strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0);
6182 1.3 christos /* Space for a branch around any trampolines. */
6183 1.3 christos trampoff = trampbase;
6184 1.3 christos if (maybe_pasted && trampbase == isec->rawsize)
6185 1.3 christos trampoff += 4;
6186 1.1 christos
6187 1.3 christos symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
6188 1.1 christos picfixup_size = 0;
6189 1.3 christos if (htab->params->branch_trampolines
6190 1.3 christos || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6191 1.3 christos {
6192 1.3 christos /* Get a copy of the native relocations. */
6193 1.3 christos if (isec->reloc_count != 0)
6194 1.3 christos {
6195 1.5 christos internal_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, isec, NULL, NULL,
6196 1.3 christos link_info->keep_memory);
6197 1.5 christos if (internal_relocs == NULL)
6198 1.3 christos goto error_return;
6199 1.3 christos }
6200 1.3 christos
6201 1.8 christos got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
6202 1.3 christos
6203 1.3 christos irelend = internal_relocs + isec->reloc_count;
6204 1.3 christos for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
6205 1.3 christos {
6206 1.3 christos unsigned long r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
6207 1.3 christos bfd_vma toff, roff;
6208 1.3 christos asection *tsec;
6209 1.3 christos struct one_branch_fixup *f;
6210 1.8 christos size_t insn_offset = 0;
6211 1.3 christos bfd_vma max_branch_offset = 0, val;
6212 1.3 christos bfd_byte *hit_addr;
6213 1.1 christos unsigned long t0;
6214 1.3 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6215 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
6216 1.3 christos struct plt_entry **plist;
6217 1.3 christos unsigned char sym_type;
6218 1.3 christos
6219 1.1 christos switch (r_type)
6220 1.5 christos {
6221 1.5 christos case R_PPC_REL24:
6222 1.5 christos case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
6223 1.5 christos case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
6224 1.5 christos case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
6225 1.3 christos max_branch_offset = 1 << 25;
6226 1.3 christos break;
6227 1.1 christos
6228 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14:
6229 1.3 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
6230 1.8 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
6231 1.8 christos max_branch_offset = 1 << 15;
6232 1.8 christos break;
6233 1.8 christos
6234 1.8 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
6235 1.3 christos if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6236 1.8 christos break;
6237 1.8 christos continue;
6238 1.3 christos
6239 1.3 christos default:
6240 1.3 christos continue;
6241 1.8 christos }
6242 1.1 christos
6243 1.3 christos /* Get the value of the symbol referred to by the reloc. */
6244 1.3 christos if (!get_sym_h (&h, &isym, &tsec, NULL, &isymbuf,
6245 1.1 christos ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info), abfd))
6246 1.3 christos goto error_return;
6247 1.1 christos
6248 1.8 christos if (isym != NULL)
6249 1.8 christos {
6250 1.3 christos if (tsec != NULL)
6251 1.3 christos ;
6252 1.1 christos else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
6253 1.8 christos tsec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
6254 1.8 christos else
6255 1.8 christos continue;
6256 1.3 christos
6257 1.6 christos toff = isym->st_value;
6258 1.1 christos sym_type = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info);
6259 1.1 christos }
6260 1.3 christos else
6261 1.3 christos {
6262 1.3 christos if (tsec != NULL)
6263 1.3 christos toff = h->root.u.def.value;
6264 1.3 christos else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
6265 1.6 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6266 1.3 christos {
6267 1.3 christos unsigned long indx;
6268 1.1 christos
6269 1.3 christos indx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info) - symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6270 1.3 christos tsec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
6271 1.3 christos toff = bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) ? indx : 0;
6272 1.3 christos }
6273 1.3 christos else
6274 1.3 christos continue;
6275 1.3 christos
6276 1.3 christos /* If this branch is to __tls_get_addr then we may later
6277 1.3 christos optimise away the call. We won't be needing a long-
6278 1.3 christos branch stub in that case. */
6279 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_executable (link_info)
6280 1.3 christos && h == htab->tls_get_addr
6281 1.3 christos && irel != internal_relocs)
6282 1.3 christos {
6283 1.3 christos unsigned long t_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel[-1].r_info);
6284 1.3 christos unsigned long t_rtype = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel[-1].r_info);
6285 1.3 christos unsigned int tls_mask = 0;
6286 1.3 christos
6287 1.3 christos /* The previous reloc should be one of R_PPC_TLSGD or
6288 1.3 christos R_PPC_TLSLD, or for older object files, a reloc
6289 1.3 christos on the __tls_get_addr arg setup insn. Get tls
6290 1.3 christos mask bits from the symbol on that reloc. */
6291 1.3 christos if (t_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
6292 1.3 christos {
6293 1.3 christos bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
6294 1.1 christos
6295 1.3 christos if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
6296 1.3 christos {
6297 1.3 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6298 1.1 christos (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6299 1.3 christos char *lgot_masks = (char *)
6300 1.3 christos (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6301 1.3 christos tls_mask = lgot_masks[t_symndx];
6302 1.1 christos }
6303 1.3 christos }
6304 1.3 christos else
6305 1.3 christos {
6306 1.3 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *th
6307 1.3 christos = elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[t_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
6308 1.3 christos
6309 1.3 christos while (th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6310 1.3 christos || th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6311 1.3 christos th = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) th->root.u.i.link;
6312 1.3 christos
6313 1.3 christos tls_mask
6314 1.3 christos = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) th)->tls_mask;
6315 1.3 christos }
6316 1.1 christos
6317 1.3 christos /* The mask bits tell us if the call will be
6318 1.3 christos optimised away. */
6319 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
6320 1.5 christos && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSGD
6321 1.5 christos || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16
6322 1.5 christos || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO))
6323 1.5 christos continue;
6324 1.5 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
6325 1.5 christos && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSLD
6326 1.5 christos || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16
6327 1.5 christos || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO))
6328 1.5 christos continue;
6329 1.5 christos }
6330 1.5 christos
6331 1.3 christos sym_type = h->type;
6332 1.3 christos }
6333 1.3 christos
6334 1.3 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
6335 1.3 christos {
6336 1.3 christos if (h != NULL
6337 1.3 christos && !h->def_regular
6338 1.3 christos && h->protected_def
6339 1.3 christos && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
6340 1.3 christos && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo)
6341 1.3 christos picfixup_size += 12;
6342 1.3 christos continue;
6343 1.3 christos }
6344 1.3 christos
6345 1.3 christos /* The condition here under which we call find_plt_ent must
6346 1.3 christos match that in relocate_section. If we call find_plt_ent here
6347 1.3 christos but not in relocate_section, or vice versa, then the branch
6348 1.3 christos destination used here may be incorrect. */
6349 1.3 christos plist = NULL;
6350 1.3 christos if (h != NULL)
6351 1.3 christos {
6352 1.3 christos /* We know is_branch_reloc (r_type) is true. */
6353 1.3 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6354 1.3 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6355 1.1 christos plist = &h->plt.plist;
6356 1.6 christos }
6357 1.3 christos else if (sym_type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6358 1.3 christos && elf_local_got_offsets (abfd) != NULL)
6359 1.3 christos {
6360 1.3 christos bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
6361 1.3 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6362 1.3 christos (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6363 1.3 christos plist = local_plt + ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info);
6364 1.3 christos }
6365 1.3 christos if (plist != NULL)
6366 1.3 christos {
6367 1.3 christos bfd_vma addend = 0;
6368 1.3 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
6369 1.3 christos
6370 1.3 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24 && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6371 1.7 christos addend = irel->r_addend;
6372 1.3 christos ent = find_plt_ent (plist, got2, addend);
6373 1.3 christos if (ent != NULL)
6374 1.3 christos {
6375 1.3 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
6376 1.1 christos || h == NULL
6377 1.3 christos || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
6378 1.3 christos || h->dynindx == -1)
6379 1.3 christos {
6380 1.3 christos tsec = htab->glink;
6381 1.1 christos toff = ent->glink_offset;
6382 1.1 christos }
6383 1.8 christos else
6384 1.8 christos {
6385 1.8 christos tsec = htab->elf.splt;
6386 1.8 christos toff = ent->plt.offset;
6387 1.8 christos }
6388 1.8 christos }
6389 1.8 christos }
6390 1.8 christos
6391 1.8 christos /* If the branch and target are in the same section, you have
6392 1.8 christos no hope of adding stubs. We'll error out later should the
6393 1.8 christos branch overflow. */
6394 1.3 christos if (tsec == isec)
6395 1.3 christos continue;
6396 1.3 christos
6397 1.3 christos /* toff is used for the symbol index when the symbol is
6398 1.3 christos undefined and we're doing a relocatable link, so we can't
6399 1.3 christos support addends. It would be possible to do so by
6400 1.3 christos putting the addend in one_branch_fixup but addends on
6401 1.3 christos branches are rare so it hardly seems worth supporting. */
6402 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6403 1.3 christos && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr
6404 1.3 christos && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24
6405 1.3 christos && irel->r_addend != 0)
6406 1.3 christos continue;
6407 1.3 christos
6408 1.3 christos /* There probably isn't any reason to handle symbols in
6409 1.3 christos SEC_MERGE sections; SEC_MERGE doesn't seem a likely
6410 1.3 christos attribute for a code section, and we are only looking at
6411 1.3 christos branches. However, implement it correctly here as a
6412 1.3 christos reference for other target relax_section functions. */
6413 1.3 christos if (0 && tsec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
6414 1.3 christos {
6415 1.3 christos /* At this stage in linking, no SEC_MERGE symbol has been
6416 1.3 christos adjusted, so all references to such symbols need to be
6417 1.8 christos passed through _bfd_merged_section_offset. (Later, in
6418 1.8 christos relocate_section, all SEC_MERGE symbols *except* for
6419 1.3 christos section symbols have been adjusted.)
6420 1.3 christos
6421 1.3 christos gas may reduce relocations against symbols in SEC_MERGE
6422 1.3 christos sections to a relocation against the section symbol when
6423 1.3 christos the original addend was zero. When the reloc is against
6424 1.3 christos a section symbol we should include the addend in the
6425 1.1 christos offset passed to _bfd_merged_section_offset, since the
6426 1.8 christos location of interest is the original symbol. On the
6427 1.8 christos other hand, an access to "sym+addend" where "sym" is not
6428 1.3 christos a section symbol should not include the addend; Such an
6429 1.3 christos access is presumed to be an offset from "sym"; The
6430 1.3 christos location of interest is just "sym". */
6431 1.3 christos if (sym_type == STT_SECTION
6432 1.3 christos && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6433 1.1 christos toff += irel->r_addend;
6434 1.3 christos
6435 1.6 christos toff
6436 1.3 christos = _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, &tsec,
6437 1.3 christos elf_section_data (tsec)->sec_info,
6438 1.3 christos toff);
6439 1.3 christos
6440 1.1 christos if (sym_type != STT_SECTION
6441 1.1 christos && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6442 1.3 christos toff += irel->r_addend;
6443 1.3 christos }
6444 1.8 christos /* PLTREL24 addends are special. */
6445 1.8 christos else if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6446 1.8 christos toff += irel->r_addend;
6447 1.8 christos
6448 1.8 christos /* Attempted -shared link of non-pic code loses. */
6449 1.8 christos if ((!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6450 1.8 christos && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr)
6451 1.8 christos || tsec->output_section == NULL
6452 1.8 christos || (tsec->owner != NULL
6453 1.8 christos && (tsec->owner->flags & BFD_PLUGIN) != 0))
6454 1.3 christos continue;
6455 1.3 christos
6456 1.6 christos roff = irel->r_offset;
6457 1.3 christos
6458 1.3 christos /* Avoid creating a lot of unnecessary fixups when
6459 1.3 christos relocatable if the output section size is such that a
6460 1.3 christos fixup can be created at final link.
6461 1.3 christos The max_branch_offset adjustment allows for some number
6462 1.3 christos of other fixups being needed at final link. */
6463 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6464 1.3 christos && (isec->output_section->rawsize - (isec->output_offset + roff)
6465 1.3 christos < max_branch_offset - (max_branch_offset >> 4)))
6466 1.3 christos continue;
6467 1.3 christos
6468 1.1 christos /* If the branch is in range, no need to do anything. */
6469 1.3 christos if (tsec != bfd_und_section_ptr
6470 1.3 christos && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6471 1.5 christos /* A relocatable link may have sections moved during
6472 1.3 christos final link, so do not presume they remain in range. */
6473 1.3 christos || tsec->output_section == isec->output_section))
6474 1.3 christos {
6475 1.3 christos bfd_vma symaddr, reladdr;
6476 1.1 christos
6477 1.3 christos symaddr = tsec->output_section->vma + tsec->output_offset + toff;
6478 1.3 christos reladdr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset + roff;
6479 1.1 christos if (symaddr - reladdr + max_branch_offset
6480 1.3 christos < 2 * max_branch_offset)
6481 1.3 christos continue;
6482 1.3 christos }
6483 1.3 christos
6484 1.3 christos /* Look for an existing fixup to this address. */
6485 1.1 christos for (f = branch_fixups; f ; f = f->next)
6486 1.6 christos if (f->tsec == tsec && f->toff == toff)
6487 1.3 christos break;
6488 1.3 christos
6489 1.3 christos if (f == NULL)
6490 1.3 christos {
6491 1.3 christos size_t size;
6492 1.3 christos unsigned long stub_rtype;
6493 1.3 christos
6494 1.3 christos val = trampoff - roff;
6495 1.3 christos if (val >= max_branch_offset)
6496 1.3 christos /* Oh dear, we can't reach a trampoline. Don't try to add
6497 1.7 christos one. We'll report an error later. */
6498 1.3 christos continue;
6499 1.3 christos
6500 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6501 1.3 christos {
6502 1.3 christos size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry);
6503 1.3 christos insn_offset = 12;
6504 1.1 christos }
6505 1.3 christos else
6506 1.3 christos {
6507 1.3 christos size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
6508 1.3 christos insn_offset = 0;
6509 1.3 christos }
6510 1.3 christos stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX;
6511 1.3 christos if (tsec == htab->elf.splt
6512 1.3 christos || tsec == htab->glink)
6513 1.3 christos {
6514 1.3 christos stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLT;
6515 1.3 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6516 1.5 christos stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24;
6517 1.3 christos }
6518 1.3 christos
6519 1.3 christos /* Hijack the old relocation. Since we need two
6520 1.5 christos relocations for this use a "composite" reloc. */
6521 1.1 christos irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info),
6522 1.3 christos stub_rtype);
6523 1.3 christos irel->r_offset = trampoff + insn_offset;
6524 1.3 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
6525 1.1 christos && stub_rtype != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
6526 1.1 christos irel->r_addend = 0;
6527 1.3 christos
6528 1.3 christos /* Record the fixup so we don't do it again this section. */
6529 1.3 christos f = bfd_malloc (sizeof (*f));
6530 1.3 christos f->next = branch_fixups;
6531 1.3 christos f->tsec = tsec;
6532 1.3 christos f->toff = toff;
6533 1.3 christos f->trampoff = trampoff;
6534 1.3 christos branch_fixups = f;
6535 1.3 christos
6536 1.3 christos trampoff += size;
6537 1.3 christos changes++;
6538 1.3 christos }
6539 1.3 christos else
6540 1.3 christos {
6541 1.1 christos val = f->trampoff - roff;
6542 1.3 christos if (val >= max_branch_offset)
6543 1.1 christos continue;
6544 1.1 christos
6545 1.1 christos /* Nop out the reloc, since we're finalizing things here. */
6546 1.3 christos irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
6547 1.3 christos }
6548 1.3 christos
6549 1.3 christos /* Get the section contents. */
6550 1.3 christos if (contents == NULL)
6551 1.3 christos {
6552 1.3 christos /* Get cached copy if it exists. */
6553 1.3 christos if (elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
6554 1.3 christos contents = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents;
6555 1.3 christos /* Go get them off disk. */
6556 1.3 christos else if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, isec, &contents))
6557 1.3 christos goto error_return;
6558 1.1 christos }
6559 1.3 christos
6560 1.3 christos /* Fix up the existing branch to hit the trampoline. */
6561 1.3 christos hit_addr = contents + roff;
6562 1.3 christos switch (r_type)
6563 1.3 christos {
6564 1.3 christos case R_PPC_REL24:
6565 1.3 christos case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
6566 1.3 christos case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
6567 1.3 christos t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
6568 1.1 christos t0 &= ~0x3fffffc;
6569 1.1 christos t0 |= val & 0x3fffffc;
6570 1.5 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
6571 1.1 christos break;
6572 1.5 christos
6573 1.5 christos case R_PPC_REL14:
6574 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
6575 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
6576 1.3 christos t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
6577 1.1 christos t0 &= ~0xfffc;
6578 1.3 christos t0 |= val & 0xfffc;
6579 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
6580 1.3 christos break;
6581 1.6 christos }
6582 1.3 christos }
6583 1.3 christos
6584 1.3 christos while (branch_fixups != NULL)
6585 1.3 christos {
6586 1.3 christos struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
6587 1.3 christos branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
6588 1.3 christos free (f);
6589 1.3 christos }
6590 1.3 christos }
6591 1.3 christos
6592 1.3 christos workaround_change = FALSE;
6593 1.3 christos newsize = trampoff;
6594 1.3 christos if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
6595 1.3 christos && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6596 1.3 christos || isec->output_section->alignment_power >= htab->params->pagesize_p2))
6597 1.3 christos {
6598 1.3 christos bfd_vma addr, end_addr;
6599 1.3 christos unsigned int crossings;
6600 1.3 christos bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
6601 1.3 christos
6602 1.3 christos addr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset;
6603 1.3 christos end_addr = addr + trampoff;
6604 1.3 christos addr &= -pagesize;
6605 1.3 christos crossings = ((end_addr & -pagesize) - addr) >> htab->params->pagesize_p2;
6606 1.1 christos if (crossings != 0)
6607 1.3 christos {
6608 1.3 christos /* Keep space aligned, to ensure the patch code itself does
6609 1.1 christos not cross a page. Don't decrease size calculated on a
6610 1.5 christos previous pass as otherwise we might never settle on a layout. */
6611 1.5 christos newsize = 15 - ((end_addr - 1) & 15);
6612 1.5 christos newsize += crossings * 16;
6613 1.5 christos if (relax_info->workaround_size < newsize)
6614 1.5 christos {
6615 1.5 christos relax_info->workaround_size = newsize;
6616 1.5 christos workaround_change = TRUE;
6617 1.5 christos }
6618 1.5 christos /* Ensure relocate_section is called. */
6619 1.3 christos isec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
6620 1.1 christos }
6621 1.1 christos newsize = trampoff + relax_info->workaround_size;
6622 1.1 christos }
6623 1.1 christos
6624 1.1 christos if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6625 1.1 christos {
6626 1.1 christos picfixup_size -= relax_info->picfixup_size;
6627 1.1 christos if (picfixup_size != 0)
6628 1.1 christos relax_info->picfixup_size += picfixup_size;
6629 1.1 christos newsize += relax_info->picfixup_size;
6630 1.1 christos }
6631 1.1 christos
6632 1.1 christos if (changes != 0 || picfixup_size != 0 || workaround_change)
6633 1.1 christos isec->size = newsize;
6634 1.1 christos
6635 1.1 christos if (isymbuf != NULL
6636 1.1 christos && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) isymbuf)
6637 1.1 christos {
6638 1.1 christos if (! link_info->keep_memory)
6639 1.1 christos free (isymbuf);
6640 1.1 christos else
6641 1.1 christos {
6642 1.1 christos /* Cache the symbols for elf_link_input_bfd. */
6643 1.1 christos symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) isymbuf;
6644 1.1 christos }
6645 1.5 christos }
6646 1.1 christos
6647 1.1 christos if (contents != NULL
6648 1.1 christos && elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6649 1.1 christos {
6650 1.1 christos if (!changes && !link_info->keep_memory)
6651 1.1 christos free (contents);
6652 1.1 christos else
6653 1.1 christos {
6654 1.1 christos /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd. */
6655 1.1 christos elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
6656 1.1 christos }
6657 1.1 christos }
6658 1.1 christos
6659 1.1 christos changes += picfixup_size;
6660 1.1 christos if (changes != 0)
6661 1.1 christos {
6662 1.1 christos /* Append sufficient NOP relocs so we can write out relocation
6663 1.1 christos information for the trampolines. */
6664 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
6665 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *new_relocs = bfd_malloc ((changes + isec->reloc_count)
6666 1.1 christos * sizeof (*new_relocs));
6667 1.1 christos unsigned ix;
6668 1.1 christos
6669 1.1 christos if (!new_relocs)
6670 1.1 christos goto error_return;
6671 1.1 christos memcpy (new_relocs, internal_relocs,
6672 1.3 christos isec->reloc_count * sizeof (*new_relocs));
6673 1.3 christos for (ix = changes; ix--;)
6674 1.1 christos {
6675 1.1 christos irel = new_relocs + ix + isec->reloc_count;
6676 1.3 christos
6677 1.1 christos irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
6678 1.1 christos }
6679 1.1 christos if (internal_relocs != elf_section_data (isec)->relocs)
6680 1.5 christos free (internal_relocs);
6681 1.3 christos elf_section_data (isec)->relocs = new_relocs;
6682 1.5 christos isec->reloc_count += changes;
6683 1.5 christos rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (isec);
6684 1.3 christos rel_hdr->sh_size += changes * rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
6685 1.3 christos }
6686 1.1 christos else if (internal_relocs != NULL
6687 1.1 christos && elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6688 1.1 christos free (internal_relocs);
6689 1.1 christos
6690 1.1 christos *again = changes != 0 || workaround_change;
6691 1.1 christos return TRUE;
6692 1.1 christos
6693 1.1 christos error_return:
6694 1.1 christos while (branch_fixups != NULL)
6695 1.1 christos {
6696 1.1 christos struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
6697 1.1 christos branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
6698 1.1 christos free (f);
6699 1.1 christos }
6700 1.1 christos if (isymbuf != NULL && (unsigned char *) isymbuf != symtab_hdr->contents)
6701 1.1 christos free (isymbuf);
6702 1.1 christos if (contents != NULL
6703 1.1 christos && elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6704 1.1 christos free (contents);
6705 1.1 christos if (internal_relocs != NULL
6706 1.1 christos && elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6707 1.1 christos free (internal_relocs);
6708 1.1 christos return FALSE;
6709 1.1 christos }
6710 1.1 christos
6711 1.1 christos /* What to do when ld finds relocations against symbols defined in
6713 1.1 christos discarded sections. */
6714 1.1 christos
6715 1.1 christos static unsigned int
6716 1.1 christos ppc_elf_action_discarded (asection *sec)
6717 1.1 christos {
6718 1.1 christos if (strcmp (".fixup", sec->name) == 0)
6719 1.1 christos return 0;
6720 1.1 christos
6721 1.1 christos if (strcmp (".got2", sec->name) == 0)
6722 1.1 christos return 0;
6723 1.1 christos
6724 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_default_action_discarded (sec);
6725 1.1 christos }
6726 1.1 christos
6727 1.1 christos /* Fill in the address for a pointer generated in a linker section. */
6729 1.1 christos
6730 1.1 christos static bfd_vma
6731 1.1 christos elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (bfd *input_bfd,
6732 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
6733 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
6734 1.1 christos bfd_vma relocation,
6735 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
6736 1.1 christos {
6737 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
6738 1.1 christos
6739 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
6740 1.1 christos
6741 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
6742 1.1 christos {
6743 1.1 christos /* Handle global symbol. */
6744 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
6745 1.1 christos
6746 1.1 christos eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6747 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (eh->elf.def_regular);
6748 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr = eh->linker_section_pointer;
6749 1.1 christos }
6750 1.1 christos else
6751 1.1 christos {
6752 1.1 christos /* Handle local symbol. */
6753 1.1 christos unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
6754 1.1 christos
6755 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (input_bfd));
6756 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd) != NULL);
6757 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd)[r_symndx];
6758 1.1 christos }
6759 1.1 christos
6760 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr = elf_find_pointer_linker_section (linker_section_ptr,
6761 1.1 christos rel->r_addend,
6762 1.1 christos lsect);
6763 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (linker_section_ptr != NULL);
6764 1.1 christos
6765 1.1 christos /* Offset will always be a multiple of four, so use the bottom bit
6766 1.1 christos as a "written" flag. */
6767 1.1 christos if ((linker_section_ptr->offset & 1) == 0)
6768 1.1 christos {
6769 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (lsect->section->owner,
6770 1.1 christos relocation + linker_section_ptr->addend,
6771 1.1 christos lsect->section->contents + linker_section_ptr->offset);
6772 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr->offset += 1;
6773 1.1 christos }
6774 1.1 christos
6775 1.1 christos relocation = (lsect->section->output_section->vma
6776 1.1 christos + lsect->section->output_offset
6777 1.1 christos + linker_section_ptr->offset - 1
6778 1.8 christos - SYM_VAL (lsect->sym));
6779 1.8 christos
6780 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
6781 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr,
6782 1.1 christos "Finish pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld (0x%lx)\n",
6783 1.1 christos lsect->name, (long) relocation, (long) relocation);
6784 1.1 christos #endif
6785 1.8 christos
6786 1.8 christos return relocation;
6787 1.8 christos }
6788 1.8 christos
6789 1.8 christos #define PPC_LO(v) ((v) & 0xffff)
6790 1.8 christos #define PPC_HI(v) (((v) >> 16) & 0xffff)
6791 1.8 christos #define PPC_HA(v) PPC_HI ((v) + 0x8000)
6792 1.8 christos
6793 1.8 christos static void
6794 1.8 christos write_glink_stub (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, struct plt_entry *ent,
6795 1.8 christos asection *plt_sec, unsigned char *p,
6796 1.8 christos struct bfd_link_info *info)
6797 1.8 christos {
6798 1.8 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
6799 1.8 christos bfd *output_bfd = info->output_bfd;
6800 1.8 christos bfd_vma plt;
6801 1.8 christos unsigned char *end = p + GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
6802 1.8 christos
6803 1.8 christos if (h != NULL
6804 1.8 christos && h == htab->tls_get_addr
6805 1.8 christos && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
6806 1.8 christos {
6807 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_3, p);
6808 1.1 christos p += 4;
6809 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_3 + 4, p);
6810 1.1 christos p += 4;
6811 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_0_3, p);
6812 1.1 christos p += 4;
6813 1.6 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, CMPWI_11_0, p);
6814 1.1 christos p += 4;
6815 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_3_12_2, p);
6816 1.1 christos p += 4;
6817 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BEQLR, p);
6818 1.1 christos p += 4;
6819 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_3_0, p);
6820 1.1 christos p += 4;
6821 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
6822 1.1 christos p += 4;
6823 1.1 christos }
6824 1.1 christos
6825 1.1 christos plt = ((ent->plt.offset & ~1)
6826 1.1 christos + plt_sec->output_section->vma
6827 1.8 christos + plt_sec->output_offset);
6828 1.1 christos
6829 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
6830 1.1 christos {
6831 1.1 christos bfd_vma got = 0;
6832 1.1 christos
6833 1.1 christos if (ent->addend >= 32768)
6834 1.1 christos got = (ent->addend
6835 1.1 christos + ent->sec->output_section->vma
6836 1.1 christos + ent->sec->output_offset);
6837 1.1 christos else if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
6838 1.1 christos got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
6839 1.1 christos
6840 1.8 christos plt -= got;
6841 1.8 christos
6842 1.8 christos if (plt + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
6843 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_30 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6844 1.8 christos else
6845 1.8 christos {
6846 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_30 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
6847 1.8 christos p += 4;
6848 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6849 1.1 christos }
6850 1.1 christos }
6851 1.1 christos else
6852 1.1 christos {
6853 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_11 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
6854 1.1 christos p += 4;
6855 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6856 1.1 christos }
6857 1.1 christos p += 4;
6858 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_11, p);
6859 1.1 christos p += 4;
6860 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
6861 1.1 christos p += 4;
6862 1.1 christos while (p < end)
6863 1.1 christos {
6864 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
6865 1.1 christos p += 4;
6866 1.1 christos }
6867 1.1 christos }
6868 1.1 christos
6869 1.1 christos /* Return true if symbol is defined statically. */
6870 1.1 christos
6871 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
6872 1.1 christos is_static_defined (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6873 1.1 christos {
6874 1.1 christos return ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6875 1.1 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6876 1.1 christos && h->root.u.def.section != NULL
6877 1.1 christos && h->root.u.def.section->output_section != NULL);
6878 1.1 christos }
6879 1.1 christos
6880 1.1 christos /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tls operand, return
6881 1.1 christos the transformed insn for TLS optimisation, otherwise return 0. If
6882 1.1 christos REG is non-zero only match an insn with RB or RA equal to REG. */
6883 1.1 christos
6884 1.1 christos unsigned int
6885 1.1 christos _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
6886 1.1 christos {
6887 1.1 christos unsigned int rtra;
6888 1.1 christos
6889 1.1 christos if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) != 31 << 26)
6890 1.1 christos return 0;
6891 1.1 christos
6892 1.1 christos if (reg == 0 || ((insn >> 11) & 0x1f) == reg)
6893 1.1 christos rtra = insn & ((1 << 26) - (1 << 16));
6894 1.1 christos else if (((insn >> 16) & 0x1f) == reg)
6895 1.1 christos rtra = (insn & (0x1f << 21)) | ((insn & (0x1f << 11)) << 5);
6896 1.1 christos else
6897 1.1 christos return 0;
6898 1.1 christos
6899 1.1 christos if ((insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == 266 << 1)
6900 1.1 christos /* add -> addi. */
6901 1.1 christos insn = 14 << 26;
6902 1.1 christos else if ((insn & (0x1f << 1)) == 23 << 1
6903 1.1 christos && ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 14 << 6
6904 1.1 christos || ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) >= 16 << 6
6905 1.1 christos && (insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 24 << 6)))
6906 1.1 christos /* load and store indexed -> dform. */
6907 1.1 christos insn = (32 | ((insn >> 6) & 0x1f)) << 26;
6908 1.1 christos else if ((insn & (((0x1a << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 21 << 1)
6909 1.1 christos /* ldx, ldux, stdx, stdux -> ld, ldu, std, stdu. */
6910 1.1 christos insn = ((58 | ((insn >> 6) & 4)) << 26) | ((insn >> 6) & 1);
6911 1.1 christos else if ((insn & (((0x1f << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 341 << 1)
6912 1.1 christos /* lwax -> lwa. */
6913 1.1 christos insn = (58 << 26) | 2;
6914 1.1 christos else
6915 1.1 christos return 0;
6916 1.1 christos insn |= rtra;
6917 1.1 christos return insn;
6918 1.1 christos }
6919 1.1 christos
6920 1.1 christos /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tprel operand, return
6921 1.1 christos the transformed insn for an undefined weak symbol, ie. with the
6922 1.1 christos thread pointer REG operand removed. Otherwise return 0. */
6923 1.1 christos
6924 1.1 christos unsigned int
6925 1.1 christos _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
6926 1.1 christos {
6927 1.1 christos if ((insn & (0x1f << 16)) == reg << 16
6928 1.1 christos && ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
6929 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 15u << 26 /* addis */
6930 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
6931 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
6932 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
6933 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
6934 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
6935 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
6936 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
6937 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
6938 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
6939 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
6940 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
6941 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
6942 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
6943 1.1 christos || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
6944 1.1 christos && (insn & 3) != 1)
6945 1.1 christos || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
6946 1.1 christos && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3))))
6947 1.1 christos {
6948 1.1 christos insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
6949 1.1 christos }
6950 1.1 christos else if ((insn & (0x1f << 21)) == reg << 21
6951 1.1 christos && ((insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori, oris */
6952 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori,xoris */
6953 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi,andis */))
6954 1.1 christos {
6955 1.1 christos insn &= ~(0x1f << 21);
6956 1.1 christos insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 16)) << 5;
6957 1.1 christos if ((insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 26 << 26 /* xori,xoris */)
6958 1.1 christos insn -= 2 >> 26; /* convert to ori,oris */
6959 1.1 christos }
6960 1.1 christos else
6961 1.6 christos insn = 0;
6962 1.6 christos return insn;
6963 1.6 christos }
6964 1.1 christos
6965 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
6966 1.1 christos is_insn_ds_form (unsigned int insn)
6967 1.1 christos {
6968 1.1 christos return ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* ld,ldu,lwa */
6969 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std,stdu,stq */
6970 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 57u << 26 /* lfdp */
6971 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 61u << 26 /* stfdp */);
6972 1.1 christos }
6973 1.1 christos
6974 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
6975 1.1 christos is_insn_dq_form (unsigned int insn)
6976 1.1 christos {
6977 1.1 christos return ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 56u << 26 /* lq */
6978 1.1 christos || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (61u << 26) /* lxv, stxv */
6979 1.1 christos && (insn & 3) == 1));
6980 1.1 christos }
6981 1.1 christos
6982 1.1 christos /* The RELOCATE_SECTION function is called by the ELF backend linker
6983 1.1 christos to handle the relocations for a section.
6984 1.1 christos
6985 1.1 christos The relocs are always passed as Rela structures; if the section
6986 1.1 christos actually uses Rel structures, the r_addend field will always be
6987 1.1 christos zero.
6988 1.1 christos
6989 1.1 christos This function is responsible for adjust the section contents as
6990 1.1 christos necessary, and (if using Rela relocs and generating a
6991 1.1 christos relocatable output file) adjusting the reloc addend as
6992 1.1 christos necessary.
6993 1.1 christos
6994 1.1 christos This function does not have to worry about setting the reloc
6995 1.1 christos address or the reloc symbol index.
6996 1.1 christos
6997 1.1 christos LOCAL_SYMS is a pointer to the swapped in local symbols.
6998 1.1 christos
6999 1.1 christos LOCAL_SECTIONS is an array giving the section in the input file
7000 1.1 christos corresponding to the st_shndx field of each local symbol.
7001 1.1 christos
7002 1.1 christos The global hash table entry for the global symbols can be found
7003 1.1 christos via elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd).
7004 1.1 christos
7005 1.1 christos When generating relocatable output, this function must handle
7006 1.1 christos STB_LOCAL/STT_SECTION symbols specially. The output symbol is
7007 1.1 christos going to be the section symbol corresponding to the output
7008 1.1 christos section, which means that the addend must be adjusted
7009 1.6 christos accordingly. */
7010 1.1 christos
7011 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
7012 1.1 christos ppc_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd,
7013 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info,
7014 1.1 christos bfd *input_bfd,
7015 1.7 christos asection *input_section,
7016 1.1 christos bfd_byte *contents,
7017 1.5 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
7018 1.5 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
7019 1.1 christos asection **local_sections)
7020 1.1 christos {
7021 1.8 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7022 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
7023 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
7024 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
7025 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *wrel;
7026 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
7027 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
7028 1.8 christos asection *got2;
7029 1.8 christos bfd_vma *local_got_offsets;
7030 1.8 christos bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
7031 1.8 christos bfd_vma d_offset = (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd) ? 2 : 0);
7032 1.8 christos bfd_boolean is_vxworks_tls;
7033 1.8 christos unsigned int picfixup_size = 0;
7034 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
7035 1.1 christos
7036 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
7037 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_relocate_section called for %pB section %pA, "
7038 1.1 christos "%ld relocations%s",
7039 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section,
7040 1.1 christos (long) input_section->reloc_count,
7041 1.1 christos (bfd_link_relocatable (info)) ? " (relocatable)" : "");
7042 1.1 christos #endif
7043 1.1 christos
7044 1.1 christos if (!is_ppc_elf (input_bfd))
7045 1.1 christos {
7046 1.6 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
7047 1.1 christos return FALSE;
7048 1.1 christos }
7049 1.5 christos
7050 1.5 christos got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (input_bfd, ".got2");
7051 1.6 christos
7052 1.1 christos /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
7053 1.6 christos if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
7054 1.1 christos ppc_elf_howto_init ();
7055 1.1 christos
7056 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
7057 1.1 christos local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (input_bfd);
7058 1.1 christos symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd);
7059 1.1 christos sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd);
7060 1.1 christos /* We have to handle relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections
7061 1.1 christos specially, because the dynamic loader is 'weird'. */
7062 1.1 christos is_vxworks_tls = (htab->is_vxworks && bfd_link_pic (info)
7063 1.1 christos && !strcmp (input_section->output_section->name,
7064 1.1 christos ".tls_vars"));
7065 1.1 christos if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET)
7066 1.8 christos relax_info = elf_section_data (input_section)->sec_info;
7067 1.1 christos rel = wrel = relocs;
7068 1.1 christos relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count;
7069 1.8 christos for (; rel < relend; wrel++, rel++)
7070 1.3 christos {
7071 1.1 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
7072 1.6 christos bfd_vma addend;
7073 1.1 christos bfd_reloc_status_type r;
7074 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7075 1.1 christos asection *sec;
7076 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7077 1.1 christos const char *sym_name;
7078 1.1 christos reloc_howto_type *howto;
7079 1.1 christos unsigned long r_symndx;
7080 1.1 christos bfd_vma relocation;
7081 1.1 christos bfd_vma branch_bit, from;
7082 1.1 christos bfd_boolean unresolved_reloc, save_unresolved_reloc;
7083 1.1 christos bfd_boolean warned;
7084 1.1 christos unsigned int tls_type, tls_mask, tls_gd;
7085 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **ifunc, **plt_list;
7086 1.1 christos struct reloc_howto_struct alt_howto;
7087 1.1 christos
7088 1.1 christos again:
7089 1.1 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
7090 1.1 christos sym = NULL;
7091 1.1 christos sec = NULL;
7092 1.1 christos h = NULL;
7093 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7094 1.1 christos warned = FALSE;
7095 1.1 christos r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7096 1.1 christos
7097 1.1 christos if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7098 1.1 christos {
7099 1.1 christos sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
7100 1.1 christos sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
7101 1.1 christos sym_name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr, sym, sec);
7102 1.1 christos
7103 1.1 christos relocation = _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
7104 1.1 christos }
7105 1.1 christos else
7106 1.1 christos {
7107 1.1 christos bfd_boolean ignored;
7108 1.1 christos
7109 1.6 christos RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL (info, input_bfd, input_section, rel,
7110 1.6 christos r_symndx, symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
7111 1.8 christos h, sec, relocation,
7112 1.6 christos unresolved_reloc, warned, ignored);
7113 1.6 christos
7114 1.6 christos sym_name = h->root.root.string;
7115 1.6 christos }
7116 1.6 christos
7117 1.8 christos if (sec != NULL && discarded_section (sec))
7118 1.6 christos {
7119 1.6 christos /* For relocs against symbols from removed linkonce sections,
7120 1.6 christos or sections discarded by a linker script, we just want the
7121 1.6 christos section contents zeroed. Avoid any special processing. */
7122 1.6 christos howto = NULL;
7123 1.6 christos if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
7124 1.6 christos howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
7125 1.1 christos
7126 1.1 christos _bfd_clear_contents (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
7127 1.6 christos contents, rel->r_offset);
7128 1.1 christos wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset;
7129 1.1 christos wrel->r_info = 0;
7130 1.1 christos wrel->r_addend = 0;
7131 1.1 christos
7132 1.1 christos /* For ld -r, remove relocations in debug sections against
7133 1.1 christos symbols defined in discarded sections. Not done for
7134 1.1 christos non-debug to preserve relocs in .eh_frame which the
7135 1.1 christos eh_frame editing code expects to be present. */
7136 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (info)
7137 1.3 christos && (input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING))
7138 1.3 christos wrel--;
7139 1.3 christos
7140 1.6 christos continue;
7141 1.1 christos }
7142 1.1 christos
7143 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
7144 1.1 christos {
7145 1.1 christos if (got2 != NULL
7146 1.1 christos && r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
7147 1.1 christos && rel->r_addend != 0)
7148 1.1 christos {
7149 1.1 christos /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special. If non-zero, the
7150 1.1 christos addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2. */
7151 1.1 christos rel->r_addend += got2->output_offset;
7152 1.1 christos }
7153 1.1 christos if (r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLT
7154 1.1 christos && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24
7155 1.1 christos && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX)
7156 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
7157 1.1 christos }
7158 1.1 christos
7159 1.1 christos /* TLS optimizations. Replace instruction sequences and relocs
7160 1.1 christos based on information we collected in tls_optimize. We edit
7161 1.1 christos RELOCS so that --emit-relocs will output something sensible
7162 1.1 christos for the final instruction stream. */
7163 1.1 christos tls_mask = 0;
7164 1.1 christos tls_gd = 0;
7165 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
7166 1.1 christos tls_mask = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->tls_mask;
7167 1.1 christos else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
7168 1.1 christos {
7169 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt;
7170 1.1 christos char *lgot_masks;
7171 1.1 christos local_plt
7172 1.1 christos = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7173 1.1 christos lgot_masks = (char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7174 1.1 christos tls_mask = lgot_masks[r_symndx];
7175 1.1 christos }
7176 1.1 christos
7177 1.1 christos /* Ensure reloc mapping code below stays sane. */
7178 1.1 christos if ((R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)
7179 1.1 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO & 3)
7180 1.1 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI & 3)
7181 1.1 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA & 3)
7182 1.1 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16 & 3)
7183 1.7 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO & 3)
7184 1.6 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI & 3)
7185 1.1 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA & 3))
7186 1.1 christos abort ();
7187 1.7 christos switch (r_type)
7188 1.6 christos {
7189 1.1 christos default:
7190 1.1 christos break;
7191 1.1 christos
7192 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
7193 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
7194 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7195 1.1 christos && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
7196 1.1 christos {
7197 1.1 christos bfd_vma insn;
7198 1.1 christos
7199 1.1 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7200 1.7 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7201 1.1 christos insn &= 31 << 21;
7202 1.1 christos insn |= 0x3c020000; /* addis 0,2,0 */
7203 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
7204 1.7 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7205 1.1 christos r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
7206 1.1 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7207 1.1 christos }
7208 1.1 christos break;
7209 1.1 christos
7210 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TLS:
7211 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7212 1.1 christos && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
7213 1.1 christos {
7214 1.1 christos bfd_vma insn;
7215 1.1 christos
7216 1.1 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7217 1.1 christos insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (insn, 2);
7218 1.1 christos if (insn == 0)
7219 1.1 christos abort ();
7220 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
7221 1.1 christos r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
7222 1.1 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7223 1.1 christos
7224 1.1 christos /* Was PPC_TLS which sits on insn boundary, now
7225 1.1 christos PPC_TPREL16_LO which is at low-order half-word. */
7226 1.1 christos rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7227 1.1 christos }
7228 1.1 christos break;
7229 1.1 christos
7230 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7231 1.5 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7232 1.7 christos tls_gd = TLS_TPRELGD;
7233 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
7234 1.1 christos goto tls_gdld_hi;
7235 1.1 christos break;
7236 1.1 christos
7237 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7238 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7239 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
7240 1.1 christos {
7241 1.1 christos tls_gdld_hi:
7242 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
7243 1.1 christos r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
7244 1.1 christos + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
7245 1.1 christos else
7246 1.1 christos {
7247 1.1 christos rel->r_offset -= d_offset;
7248 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
7249 1.1 christos r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
7250 1.1 christos }
7251 1.1 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7252 1.1 christos }
7253 1.1 christos break;
7254 1.1 christos
7255 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
7256 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7257 1.1 christos tls_gd = TLS_TPRELGD;
7258 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
7259 1.1 christos goto tls_ldgd_opt;
7260 1.1 christos break;
7261 1.1 christos
7262 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
7263 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7264 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
7265 1.5 christos {
7266 1.5 christos unsigned int insn1, insn2;
7267 1.5 christos bfd_vma offset;
7268 1.5 christos
7269 1.7 christos tls_ldgd_opt:
7270 1.5 christos offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
7271 1.1 christos /* If not using the newer R_PPC_TLSGD/LD to mark
7272 1.1 christos __tls_get_addr calls, we must trust that the call
7273 1.1 christos stays with its arg setup insns, ie. that the next
7274 1.5 christos reloc is the __tls_get_addr call associated with
7275 1.1 christos the current reloc. Edit both insns. */
7276 1.1 christos if (input_section->has_tls_get_addr_call
7277 1.1 christos && rel + 1 < relend
7278 1.1 christos && branch_reloc_hash_match (input_bfd, rel + 1,
7279 1.1 christos htab->tls_get_addr))
7280 1.7 christos offset = rel[1].r_offset;
7281 1.1 christos /* We read the low GOT_TLS insn because we need to keep
7282 1.1 christos the destination reg. It may be something other than
7283 1.1 christos the usual r3, and moved to r3 before the call by
7284 1.1 christos intervening code. */
7285 1.1 christos insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7286 1.1 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7287 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
7288 1.1 christos {
7289 1.5 christos /* IE */
7290 1.5 christos insn1 &= (0x1f << 21) | (0x1f << 16);
7291 1.1 christos insn1 |= 32 << 26; /* lwz */
7292 1.1 christos if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
7293 1.1 christos {
7294 1.1 christos rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7295 1.1 christos insn2 = 0x7c631214; /* add 3,3,2 */
7296 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7297 1.1 christos }
7298 1.1 christos r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
7299 1.1 christos + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
7300 1.1 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7301 1.1 christos }
7302 1.1 christos else
7303 1.1 christos {
7304 1.1 christos /* LE */
7305 1.1 christos insn1 &= 0x1f << 21;
7306 1.1 christos insn1 |= 0x3c020000; /* addis r,2,0 */
7307 1.1 christos if (tls_gd == 0)
7308 1.1 christos {
7309 1.1 christos /* Was an LD reloc. */
7310 1.1 christos for (r_symndx = 0;
7311 1.1 christos r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7312 1.1 christos r_symndx++)
7313 1.1 christos if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
7314 1.1 christos break;
7315 1.7 christos if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7316 1.1 christos r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
7317 1.1 christos rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7318 1.7 christos if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
7319 1.1 christos rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
7320 1.1 christos + sec->output_offset
7321 1.1 christos + sec->output_section->vma);
7322 1.1 christos }
7323 1.1 christos r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
7324 1.6 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7325 1.1 christos if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
7326 1.1 christos {
7327 1.1 christos rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
7328 1.1 christos rel[1].r_offset = offset + d_offset;
7329 1.1 christos rel[1].r_addend = rel->r_addend;
7330 1.8 christos insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7331 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7332 1.1 christos }
7333 1.1 christos }
7334 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn1,
7335 1.1 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7336 1.8 christos if (tls_gd == 0)
7337 1.8 christos {
7338 1.8 christos /* We changed the symbol on an LD reloc. Start over
7339 1.8 christos in order to get h, sym, sec etc. right. */
7340 1.8 christos goto again;
7341 1.8 christos }
7342 1.8 christos }
7343 1.1 christos break;
7344 1.1 christos
7345 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TLSGD:
7346 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
7347 1.1 christos && rel + 1 < relend)
7348 1.1 christos {
7349 1.1 christos unsigned int insn2;
7350 1.1 christos bfd_vma offset = rel->r_offset;
7351 1.1 christos
7352 1.1 christos if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7353 1.1 christos {
7354 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + offset);
7355 1.1 christos rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7356 1.1 christos break;
7357 1.7 christos }
7358 1.1 christos
7359 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TPRELGD) != 0)
7360 1.1 christos {
7361 1.1 christos /* IE */
7362 1.1 christos r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
7363 1.1 christos insn2 = 0x7c631214; /* add 3,3,2 */
7364 1.1 christos }
7365 1.8 christos else
7366 1.8 christos {
7367 1.1 christos /* LE */
7368 1.1 christos r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
7369 1.1 christos rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7370 1.8 christos insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7371 1.8 christos }
7372 1.8 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7373 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7374 1.8 christos /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
7375 1.8 christos BFD_ASSERT (offset == rel[1].r_offset);
7376 1.8 christos rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7377 1.1 christos }
7378 1.1 christos break;
7379 1.1 christos
7380 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TLSLD:
7381 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
7382 1.1 christos && rel + 1 < relend)
7383 1.1 christos {
7384 1.1 christos unsigned int insn2;
7385 1.1 christos
7386 1.1 christos if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7387 1.1 christos {
7388 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
7389 1.1 christos rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7390 1.1 christos break;
7391 1.1 christos }
7392 1.1 christos
7393 1.7 christos for (r_symndx = 0;
7394 1.1 christos r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7395 1.1 christos r_symndx++)
7396 1.1 christos if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
7397 1.1 christos break;
7398 1.6 christos if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7399 1.1 christos r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
7400 1.1 christos rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7401 1.1 christos if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
7402 1.1 christos rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
7403 1.1 christos + sec->output_offset
7404 1.1 christos + sec->output_section->vma);
7405 1.1 christos
7406 1.1 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
7407 1.1 christos rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7408 1.1 christos insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7409 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2,
7410 1.1 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7411 1.1 christos /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
7412 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (rel->r_offset - d_offset == rel[1].r_offset);
7413 1.1 christos rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7414 1.7 christos goto again;
7415 1.1 christos }
7416 1.1 christos break;
7417 1.1 christos }
7418 1.1 christos
7419 1.1 christos /* Handle other relocations that tweak non-addend part of insn. */
7420 1.8 christos branch_bit = 0;
7421 1.1 christos switch (r_type)
7422 1.7 christos {
7423 1.1 christos default:
7424 1.1 christos break;
7425 1.1 christos
7426 1.1 christos /* Branch taken prediction relocations. */
7427 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
7428 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
7429 1.1 christos branch_bit = BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7430 1.1 christos /* Fall through. */
7431 1.1 christos
7432 1.1 christos /* Branch not taken prediction relocations. */
7433 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
7434 1.7 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
7435 1.1 christos {
7436 1.8 christos unsigned int insn;
7437 1.8 christos
7438 1.8 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7439 1.8 christos insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7440 1.8 christos insn |= branch_bit;
7441 1.8 christos
7442 1.8 christos from = (rel->r_offset
7443 1.8 christos + input_section->output_offset
7444 1.8 christos + input_section->output_section->vma);
7445 1.8 christos
7446 1.8 christos /* Invert 'y' bit if not the default. */
7447 1.8 christos if ((bfd_signed_vma) (relocation + rel->r_addend - from) < 0)
7448 1.8 christos insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7449 1.8 christos
7450 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
7451 1.8 christos }
7452 1.8 christos break;
7453 1.8 christos
7454 1.8 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
7455 1.8 christos {
7456 1.8 christos unsigned int insn;
7457 1.8 christos
7458 1.8 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7459 1.8 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7460 1.8 christos if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 15u << 26
7461 1.8 christos && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) != 0)
7462 1.1 christos {
7463 1.1 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
7464 1.5 christos {
7465 1.5 christos /* Convert addis to lis. */
7466 1.5 christos insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
7467 1.5 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
7468 1.5 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7469 1.5 christos }
7470 1.5 christos }
7471 1.5 christos else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
7472 1.5 christos info->callbacks->einfo
7473 1.5 christos (_("%P: %H: error: %s with unexpected instruction %x\n"),
7474 1.5 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7475 1.5 christos "R_PPC_PLT16_HA", insn);
7476 1.5 christos }
7477 1.5 christos break;
7478 1.7 christos }
7479 1.5 christos
7480 1.5 christos if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
7481 1.5 christos && h != NULL
7482 1.5 christos && !h->def_regular
7483 1.5 christos && h->protected_def
7484 1.5 christos && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
7485 1.5 christos && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
7486 1.5 christos && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
7487 1.5 christos {
7488 1.5 christos /* Convert lis;addi or lis;load/store accessing a protected
7489 1.5 christos variable defined in a shared library to PIC. */
7490 1.5 christos unsigned int insn;
7491 1.5 christos
7492 1.5 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
7493 1.5 christos {
7494 1.7 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7495 1.5 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7496 1.5 christos if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (15u << 26)
7497 1.7 christos && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) == 0 /* lis */)
7498 1.5 christos {
7499 1.7 christos bfd_byte *p;
7500 1.7 christos bfd_vma off;
7501 1.5 christos bfd_vma got_addr;
7502 1.6 christos
7503 1.6 christos p = (contents + input_section->size
7504 1.6 christos - relax_info->workaround_size
7505 1.5 christos - relax_info->picfixup_size
7506 1.7 christos + picfixup_size);
7507 1.7 christos off = (p - contents) - (rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7508 1.5 christos if (off > 0x1fffffc || (off & 3) != 0)
7509 1.5 christos info->callbacks->einfo
7510 1.5 christos (_("%H: fixup branch overflow\n"),
7511 1.5 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
7512 1.5 christos
7513 1.5 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | off,
7514 1.7 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7515 1.5 christos got_addr = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7516 1.7 christos + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7517 1.5 christos + (h->got.offset & ~1));
7518 1.5 christos wrel->r_offset = (p - contents) + d_offset;
7519 1.5 christos wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
7520 1.5 christos wrel->r_addend = got_addr;
7521 1.5 christos insn &= ~0xffff;
7522 1.6 christos insn |= ((unsigned int) (got_addr + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
7523 1.6 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
7524 1.5 christos
7525 1.6 christos /* Convert lis to lwz, loading address from GOT. */
7526 1.5 christos insn &= ~0xffff;
7527 1.5 christos insn ^= (32u ^ 15u) << 26;
7528 1.5 christos insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 21)) >> 5;
7529 1.5 christos insn |= got_addr & 0xffff;
7530 1.5 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p + 4);
7531 1.5 christos
7532 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | ((-4 - off) & 0x3ffffff), p + 8);
7533 1.7 christos picfixup_size += 12;
7534 1.8 christos
7535 1.8 christos /* Use one of the spare relocs, so --emit-relocs
7536 1.8 christos output is reasonable. */
7537 1.5 christos memmove (rel + 1, rel, (relend - rel - 1) * sizeof (*rel));
7538 1.5 christos wrel++, rel++;
7539 1.5 christos rel->r_offset = wrel[-1].r_offset + 4;
7540 1.5 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
7541 1.7 christos rel->r_addend = wrel[-1].r_addend;
7542 1.5 christos
7543 1.5 christos /* Continue on as if we had a got reloc, to output
7544 1.5 christos dynamic reloc. */
7545 1.5 christos r_type = R_PPC_GOT16_LO;
7546 1.5 christos }
7547 1.5 christos else
7548 1.5 christos _bfd_error_handler
7549 1.5 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
7550 1.5 christos (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
7551 1.5 christos "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
7552 1.5 christos input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
7553 1.5 christos "R_PPC_ADDR16_HA", insn);
7554 1.5 christos }
7555 1.5 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
7556 1.5 christos {
7557 1.5 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7558 1.5 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7559 1.5 christos if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
7560 1.5 christos || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
7561 1.5 christos || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
7562 1.5 christos || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
7563 1.5 christos || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
7564 1.5 christos || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
7565 1.5 christos || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
7566 1.5 christos || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
7567 1.5 christos || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
7568 1.8 christos || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
7569 1.7 christos || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
7570 1.8 christos || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
7571 1.8 christos || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
7572 1.8 christos || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
7573 1.5 christos || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
7574 1.5 christos && (insn & 3) != 1)
7575 1.5 christos || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
7576 1.5 christos && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3)))
7577 1.1 christos {
7578 1.1 christos /* Arrange to apply the reloc addend, if any. */
7579 1.1 christos relocation = 0;
7580 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7581 1.1 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, r_type);
7582 1.1 christos }
7583 1.1 christos else
7584 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler
7585 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
7586 1.1 christos (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
7587 1.1 christos "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
7588 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
7589 1.1 christos "R_PPC_ADDR16_LO", insn);
7590 1.1 christos }
7591 1.1 christos }
7592 1.1 christos
7593 1.1 christos ifunc = NULL;
7594 1.1 christos if (!htab->is_vxworks)
7595 1.1 christos {
7596 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
7597 1.1 christos
7598 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
7599 1.6 christos {
7600 1.8 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
7601 1.8 christos ifunc = &h->plt.plist;
7602 1.8 christos }
7603 1.8 christos else if (local_got_offsets != NULL
7604 1.1 christos && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
7605 1.1 christos {
7606 1.8 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt;
7607 1.8 christos
7608 1.8 christos local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
7609 1.8 christos + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7610 1.8 christos ifunc = local_plt + r_symndx;
7611 1.1 christos }
7612 1.1 christos
7613 1.1 christos ent = NULL;
7614 1.1 christos if (ifunc != NULL
7615 1.1 christos && (!bfd_link_pic (info)
7616 1.7 christos || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
7617 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
7618 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
7619 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
7620 1.7 christos {
7621 1.7 christos addend = 0;
7622 1.7 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)
7623 1.7 christos && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
7624 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
7625 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
7626 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
7627 1.7 christos addend = rel->r_addend;
7628 1.7 christos ent = find_plt_ent (ifunc, got2, addend);
7629 1.7 christos }
7630 1.7 christos if (ent != NULL)
7631 1.7 christos {
7632 1.7 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)
7633 1.7 christos && ent->sec != got2
7634 1.7 christos && htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW
7635 1.7 christos && (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7636 1.7 christos || h == NULL
7637 1.1 christos || h->dynindx == -1))
7638 1.1 christos {
7639 1.1 christos /* Uh oh, we are going to create a pic glink stub
7640 1.1 christos for an ifunc (here for h == NULL and later in
7641 1.3 christos finish_dynamic_symbol for h != NULL), and
7642 1.3 christos apparently are using code compiled with
7643 1.1 christos -mbss-plt. The difficulty is that -mbss-plt code
7644 1.1 christos gives no indication via a magic PLTREL24 addend
7645 1.1 christos whether r30 is equal to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or
7646 1.1 christos is pointing into a .got2 section (and how far
7647 1.7 christos into .got2). */
7648 1.7 christos info->callbacks->einfo
7649 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
7650 1.1 christos (_("%X%H: unsupported bss-plt -fPIC ifunc %s\n"),
7651 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, sym_name);
7652 1.1 christos }
7653 1.1 christos
7654 1.8 christos unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7655 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
7656 1.1 christos || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7657 1.1 christos || h == NULL
7658 1.8 christos || h->dynindx == -1)
7659 1.8 christos relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
7660 1.8 christos + htab->glink->output_offset
7661 1.8 christos + (ent->glink_offset & ~1));
7662 1.8 christos else
7663 1.8 christos relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
7664 1.8 christos + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
7665 1.8 christos + ent->plt.offset);
7666 1.8 christos }
7667 1.8 christos }
7668 1.8 christos
7669 1.8 christos addend = rel->r_addend;
7670 1.8 christos save_unresolved_reloc = unresolved_reloc;
7671 1.8 christos howto = NULL;
7672 1.8 christos if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
7673 1.8 christos howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
7674 1.8 christos
7675 1.8 christos switch (r_type)
7676 1.8 christos {
7677 1.8 christos default:
7678 1.8 christos break;
7679 1.8 christos
7680 1.8 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
7681 1.8 christos if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
7682 1.8 christos {
7683 1.8 christos bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
7684 1.8 christos unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
7685 1.8 christos if ((insn & ((0x3f << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
7686 1.8 christos != ((15u << 26) | (2 << 16)) /* addis rt,2,imm */)
7687 1.8 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
7688 1.8 christos info->callbacks->minfo
7689 1.8 christos (_("%H: warning: %s unexpected insn %#x.\n"),
7690 1.8 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, howto->name, insn);
7691 1.8 christos else
7692 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
7693 1.1 christos }
7694 1.1 christos break;
7695 1.1 christos
7696 1.8 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
7697 1.8 christos if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
7698 1.8 christos {
7699 1.1 christos bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
7700 1.1 christos unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
7701 1.1 christos insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
7702 1.6 christos insn |= 2 << 16;
7703 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
7704 1.1 christos }
7705 1.1 christos break;
7706 1.1 christos }
7707 1.1 christos
7708 1.1 christos tls_type = 0;
7709 1.1 christos switch (r_type)
7710 1.1 christos {
7711 1.6 christos default:
7712 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
7713 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
7714 1.1 christos input_bfd, howto->name);
7715 1.1 christos
7716 1.1 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7717 1.1 christos ret = FALSE;
7718 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
7719 1.1 christos
7720 1.1 christos case R_PPC_NONE:
7721 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TLS:
7722 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TLSGD:
7723 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TLSLD:
7724 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
7725 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
7726 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
7727 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
7728 1.1 christos
7729 1.1 christos /* GOT16 relocations. Like an ADDR16 using the symbol's
7730 1.1 christos address in the GOT as relocation value instead of the
7731 1.1 christos symbol's value itself. Also, create a GOT entry for the
7732 1.1 christos symbol and put the symbol value there. */
7733 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
7734 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7735 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7736 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7737 1.1 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7738 1.1 christos goto dogot;
7739 1.1 christos
7740 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
7741 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7742 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7743 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7744 1.1 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7745 1.1 christos goto dogot;
7746 1.1 christos
7747 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
7748 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
7749 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
7750 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
7751 1.1 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7752 1.1 christos goto dogot;
7753 1.1 christos
7754 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
7755 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
7756 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
7757 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
7758 1.7 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
7759 1.1 christos goto dogot;
7760 1.1 christos
7761 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16:
7762 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
7763 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
7764 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
7765 1.1 christos tls_mask = 0;
7766 1.1 christos dogot:
7767 1.1 christos {
7768 1.7 christos /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the global
7769 1.7 christos offset table. */
7770 1.7 christos bfd_vma off;
7771 1.8 christos bfd_vma *offp;
7772 1.1 christos unsigned long indx;
7773 1.1 christos
7774 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
7775 1.1 christos abort ();
7776 1.1 christos
7777 1.1 christos indx = 0;
7778 1.1 christos if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)
7779 1.1 christos && (h == NULL
7780 1.1 christos || !h->def_dynamic))
7781 1.1 christos offp = &htab->tlsld_got.offset;
7782 1.1 christos else if (h != NULL)
7783 1.1 christos {
7784 1.1 christos if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7785 1.1 christos || h->dynindx == -1
7786 1.1 christos || SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)
7787 1.1 christos || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
7788 1.1 christos /* This is actually a static link, or it is a
7789 1.1 christos -Bsymbolic link and the symbol is defined
7790 1.1 christos locally, or the symbol was forced to be local
7791 1.1 christos because of a version file. */
7792 1.1 christos ;
7793 1.1 christos else
7794 1.1 christos {
7795 1.1 christos indx = h->dynindx;
7796 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7797 1.1 christos }
7798 1.1 christos offp = &h->got.offset;
7799 1.8 christos }
7800 1.8 christos else
7801 1.8 christos {
7802 1.8 christos if (local_got_offsets == NULL)
7803 1.1 christos abort ();
7804 1.1 christos offp = &local_got_offsets[r_symndx];
7805 1.1 christos }
7806 1.1 christos
7807 1.1 christos /* The offset must always be a multiple of 4. We use the
7808 1.1 christos least significant bit to record whether we have already
7809 1.1 christos processed this entry. */
7810 1.1 christos off = *offp;
7811 1.1 christos if ((off & 1) != 0)
7812 1.1 christos off &= ~1;
7813 1.1 christos else
7814 1.1 christos {
7815 1.1 christos unsigned int tls_m = ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7816 1.1 christos ? tls_mask & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL
7817 1.1 christos | TLS_TPREL | TLS_TPRELGD)
7818 1.1 christos : 0);
7819 1.1 christos
7820 1.1 christos if (offp == &htab->tlsld_got.offset)
7821 1.1 christos tls_m = TLS_LD;
7822 1.1 christos else if (h == NULL
7823 1.1 christos || !h->def_dynamic)
7824 1.1 christos tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
7825 1.1 christos
7826 1.1 christos /* We might have multiple got entries for this sym.
7827 1.1 christos Initialize them all. */
7828 1.1 christos do
7829 1.1 christos {
7830 1.1 christos int tls_ty = 0;
7831 1.1 christos
7832 1.1 christos if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0)
7833 1.1 christos {
7834 1.1 christos tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7835 1.1 christos tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
7836 1.1 christos }
7837 1.1 christos else if ((tls_m & TLS_GD) != 0)
7838 1.7 christos {
7839 1.7 christos tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7840 1.7 christos tls_m &= ~TLS_GD;
7841 1.8 christos }
7842 1.8 christos else if ((tls_m & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
7843 1.8 christos {
7844 1.8 christos tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
7845 1.8 christos tls_m &= ~TLS_DTPREL;
7846 1.1 christos }
7847 1.7 christos else if ((tls_m & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_TPRELGD)) != 0)
7848 1.1 christos {
7849 1.1 christos tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7850 1.1 christos tls_m = 0;
7851 1.7 christos }
7852 1.7 christos
7853 1.7 christos /* Generate relocs for the dynamic linker. */
7854 1.7 christos if (indx != 0
7855 1.7 christos || (bfd_link_pic (info)
7856 1.7 christos && (h == NULL
7857 1.7 christos || !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)
7858 1.7 christos || offp == &htab->tlsld_got.offset)
7859 1.7 christos && !(tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL)
7860 1.1 christos && bfd_link_executable (info)
7861 1.1 christos && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))))
7862 1.1 christos {
7863 1.1 christos asection *rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
7864 1.1 christos bfd_byte * loc;
7865 1.1 christos
7866 1.1 christos if (ifunc != NULL)
7867 1.1 christos {
7868 1.1 christos rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
7869 1.1 christos if (indx == 0)
7870 1.1 christos htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
7871 1.1 christos else if (is_static_defined (h))
7872 1.1 christos htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
7873 1.1 christos }
7874 1.1 christos outrel.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7875 1.1 christos + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7876 1.1 christos + off);
7877 1.1 christos outrel.r_addend = 0;
7878 1.1 christos if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7879 1.1 christos {
7880 1.1 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPMOD32);
7881 1.1 christos if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
7882 1.1 christos {
7883 1.1 christos loc = rsec->contents;
7884 1.1 christos loc += (rsec->reloc_count++
7885 1.1 christos * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
7886 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd,
7887 1.1 christos &outrel, loc);
7888 1.1 christos outrel.r_offset += 4;
7889 1.1 christos outrel.r_info
7890 1.1 christos = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
7891 1.5 christos }
7892 1.5 christos }
7893 1.5 christos else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
7894 1.5 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
7895 1.5 christos else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL))
7896 1.5 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_TPREL32);
7897 1.1 christos else if (indx != 0)
7898 1.1 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_GLOB_DAT);
7899 1.1 christos else if (ifunc != NULL)
7900 1.1 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
7901 1.1 christos else
7902 1.1 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
7903 1.1 christos if (indx == 0 && tls_ty != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
7904 1.1 christos {
7905 1.1 christos outrel.r_addend += relocation;
7906 1.1 christos if (tls_ty & (TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL | TLS_TPREL))
7907 1.1 christos {
7908 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
7909 1.1 christos outrel.r_addend = 0;
7910 1.7 christos else
7911 1.1 christos outrel.r_addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma;
7912 1.5 christos }
7913 1.5 christos }
7914 1.5 christos loc = rsec->contents;
7915 1.5 christos loc += (rsec->reloc_count++
7916 1.7 christos * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
7917 1.7 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
7918 1.7 christos }
7919 1.7 christos
7920 1.8 christos /* Init the .got section contents if we're not
7921 1.5 christos emitting a reloc. */
7922 1.5 christos else
7923 1.1 christos {
7924 1.7 christos bfd_vma value = relocation;
7925 1.1 christos
7926 1.7 christos if (tls_ty != 0)
7927 1.7 christos {
7928 1.8 christos if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
7929 1.1 christos value = 0;
7930 1.1 christos else
7931 1.7 christos {
7932 1.7 christos if (tls_ty & TLS_LD)
7933 1.1 christos value = 0;
7934 1.1 christos else
7935 1.1 christos value -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7936 1.1 christos if (tls_ty & TLS_TPREL)
7937 1.1 christos value += DTP_OFFSET - TP_OFFSET;
7938 1.1 christos }
7939 1.1 christos
7940 1.1 christos if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7941 1.1 christos {
7942 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
7943 1.1 christos htab->elf.sgot->contents + off + 4);
7944 1.1 christos value = 1;
7945 1.1 christos }
7946 1.1 christos }
7947 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
7948 1.1 christos htab->elf.sgot->contents + off);
7949 1.1 christos }
7950 1.1 christos
7951 1.1 christos off += 4;
7952 1.1 christos if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7953 1.1 christos off += 4;
7954 1.1 christos }
7955 1.1 christos while (tls_m != 0);
7956 1.1 christos
7957 1.1 christos off = *offp;
7958 1.1 christos *offp = off | 1;
7959 1.1 christos }
7960 1.1 christos
7961 1.1 christos if (off >= (bfd_vma) -2)
7962 1.1 christos abort ();
7963 1.1 christos
7964 1.1 christos if ((tls_type & TLS_TLS) != 0)
7965 1.1 christos {
7966 1.1 christos if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
7967 1.1 christos {
7968 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_LD) != 0
7969 1.5 christos && !(h == NULL
7970 1.5 christos || !h->def_dynamic))
7971 1.6 christos off += 8;
7972 1.5 christos if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
7973 1.7 christos {
7974 1.7 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
7975 1.1 christos off += 8;
7976 1.1 christos if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
7977 1.1 christos {
7978 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
7979 1.1 christos off += 4;
7980 1.1 christos }
7981 1.1 christos }
7982 1.1 christos }
7983 1.1 christos }
7984 1.7 christos
7985 1.7 christos /* If here for a picfixup, we're done. */
7986 1.1 christos if (r_type != ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
7987 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
7988 1.1 christos
7989 1.1 christos relocation = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7990 1.3 christos + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7991 1.1 christos + off
7992 1.3 christos - SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot));
7993 1.1 christos
7994 1.1 christos /* Addends on got relocations don't make much sense.
7995 1.1 christos x+off@got is actually x@got+off, and since the got is
7996 1.1 christos generated by a hash table traversal, the value in the
7997 1.1 christos got at entry m+n bears little relation to the entry m. */
7998 1.6 christos if (addend != 0)
7999 1.6 christos info->callbacks->einfo
8000 1.6 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
8001 1.6 christos (_("%H: non-zero addend on %s reloc against `%s'\n"),
8002 1.6 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8003 1.6 christos howto->name,
8004 1.6 christos sym_name);
8005 1.1 christos }
8006 1.7 christos break;
8007 1.7 christos
8008 1.7 christos /* Relocations that need no special processing. */
8009 1.7 christos case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
8010 1.7 christos /* It makes no sense to point a local relocation
8011 1.7 christos at a symbol not in this object. */
8012 1.7 christos if (unresolved_reloc)
8013 1.7 christos {
8014 1.7 christos (*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol) (info,
8015 1.7 christos h->root.root.string,
8016 1.7 christos input_bfd,
8017 1.7 christos input_section,
8018 1.7 christos rel->r_offset,
8019 1.7 christos TRUE);
8020 1.7 christos goto copy_reloc;
8021 1.1 christos }
8022 1.1 christos if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && bfd_link_pic (info))
8023 1.1 christos {
8024 1.1 christos /* @local on an ifunc does not really make sense since
8025 1.1 christos the ifunc resolver can take you anywhere. More
8026 1.1 christos seriously, calls to ifuncs must go through a plt call
8027 1.5 christos stub, and for pic the plt call stubs uses r30 to
8028 1.5 christos access the PLT. The problem is that a call that is
8029 1.1 christos local won't have the +32k reloc addend trick marking
8030 1.1 christos -fPIC code, so the linker won't know whether r30 is
8031 1.1 christos _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or pointing into a .got2 section. */
8032 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
8033 1.1 christos info->callbacks->einfo (_("%X%H: @local call to ifunc %s\n"),
8034 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8035 1.1 christos h->root.root.string);
8036 1.1 christos }
8037 1.1 christos break;
8038 1.1 christos
8039 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
8040 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
8041 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
8042 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
8043 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8044 1.1 christos addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
8045 1.1 christos break;
8046 1.7 christos
8047 1.1 christos /* Relocations that may need to be propagated if this is a shared
8048 1.1 christos object. */
8049 1.7 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16:
8050 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
8051 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
8052 1.5 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8053 1.5 christos if (h != NULL
8054 1.1 christos && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
8055 1.8 christos && h->dynindx == -1)
8056 1.8 christos {
8057 1.1 christos /* Make this relocation against an undefined weak symbol
8058 1.1 christos resolve to zero. This is really just a tweak, since
8059 1.1 christos code using weak externs ought to check that they are
8060 1.5 christos defined before using them. */
8061 1.5 christos bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset;
8062 1.1 christos unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8063 1.1 christos insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (insn, 2);
8064 1.1 christos if (insn != 0)
8065 1.5 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
8066 1.5 christos break;
8067 1.1 christos }
8068 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8069 1.1 christos addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
8070 1.1 christos /* The TPREL16 relocs shouldn't really be used in shared
8071 1.1 christos libs or with non-local symbols as that will result in
8072 1.1 christos DT_TEXTREL being set, but support them anyway. */
8073 1.1 christos goto dodyn;
8074 1.1 christos
8075 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL32:
8076 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8077 1.1 christos addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
8078 1.6 christos goto dodyn;
8079 1.1 christos
8080 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
8081 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8082 1.1 christos addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
8083 1.1 christos goto dodyn;
8084 1.1 christos
8085 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
8086 1.1 christos relocation = 1;
8087 1.1 christos addend = 0;
8088 1.1 christos goto dodyn;
8089 1.1 christos
8090 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16:
8091 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
8092 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
8093 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
8094 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
8095 1.1 christos break;
8096 1.1 christos
8097 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL32:
8098 1.1 christos if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
8099 1.1 christos break;
8100 1.1 christos /* fall through */
8101 1.1 christos
8102 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR32:
8103 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16:
8104 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
8105 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
8106 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
8107 1.1 christos case R_PPC_UADDR32:
8108 1.1 christos case R_PPC_UADDR16:
8109 1.1 christos goto dodyn;
8110 1.1 christos
8111 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
8112 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
8113 1.6 christos case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
8114 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL24:
8115 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14:
8116 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
8117 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
8118 1.1 christos /* If these relocations are not to a named symbol, they can be
8119 1.1 christos handled right here, no need to bother the dynamic linker. */
8120 1.1 christos if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
8121 1.1 christos || h == htab->elf.hgot)
8122 1.8 christos break;
8123 1.8 christos /* fall through */
8124 1.8 christos
8125 1.8 christos case R_PPC_ADDR24:
8126 1.8 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14:
8127 1.8 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
8128 1.8 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
8129 1.1 christos if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
8130 1.1 christos break;
8131 1.1 christos /* fall through */
8132 1.1 christos
8133 1.7 christos dodyn:
8134 1.7 christos if ((input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
8135 1.1 christos || is_vxworks_tls)
8136 1.1 christos break;
8137 1.1 christos
8138 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)
8139 1.1 christos ? ((h == NULL
8140 1.1 christos || ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs != NULL)
8141 1.1 christos && ((h != NULL && pc_dynrelocs (h))
8142 1.1 christos || must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)))
8143 1.1 christos : (h != NULL
8144 1.1 christos && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs != NULL))
8145 1.1 christos {
8146 1.1 christos int skip;
8147 1.1 christos bfd_byte *loc;
8148 1.1 christos asection *sreloc;
8149 1.1 christos long indx = 0;
8150 1.1 christos
8151 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
8152 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_relocate_section needs to "
8153 1.1 christos "create relocation for %s\n",
8154 1.1 christos (h && h->root.root.string
8155 1.1 christos ? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
8156 1.1 christos #endif
8157 1.8 christos
8158 1.1 christos /* When generating a shared object, these relocations
8159 1.7 christos are copied into the output file to be resolved at run
8160 1.7 christos time. */
8161 1.1 christos skip = 0;
8162 1.7 christos outrel.r_offset = _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info,
8163 1.1 christos input_section,
8164 1.1 christos rel->r_offset);
8165 1.1 christos if (outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -1
8166 1.1 christos || outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -2)
8167 1.1 christos skip = (int) outrel.r_offset;
8168 1.1 christos outrel.r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
8169 1.1 christos + input_section->output_offset);
8170 1.1 christos
8171 1.1 christos if (skip)
8172 1.1 christos memset (&outrel, 0, sizeof outrel);
8173 1.1 christos else if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
8174 1.1 christos {
8175 1.1 christos indx = h->dynindx;
8176 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (indx != -1);
8177 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8178 1.1 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
8179 1.1 christos outrel.r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8180 1.1 christos }
8181 1.1 christos else
8182 1.1 christos {
8183 1.1 christos outrel.r_addend = relocation + rel->r_addend;
8184 1.1 christos
8185 1.1 christos if (r_type != R_PPC_ADDR32)
8186 1.7 christos {
8187 1.7 christos if (ifunc != NULL)
8188 1.1 christos {
8189 1.1 christos /* If we get here when building a static
8190 1.1 christos executable, then the libc startup function
8191 1.1 christos responsible for applying indirect function
8192 1.1 christos relocations is going to complain about
8193 1.1 christos the reloc type.
8194 1.1 christos If we get here when building a dynamic
8195 1.1 christos executable, it will be because we have
8196 1.1 christos a text relocation. The dynamic loader
8197 1.1 christos will set the text segment writable and
8198 1.1 christos non-executable to apply text relocations.
8199 1.1 christos So we'll segfault when trying to run the
8200 1.1 christos indirection function to resolve the reloc. */
8201 1.1 christos info->callbacks->einfo
8202 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
8203 1.1 christos (_("%H: relocation %s for indirect "
8204 1.1 christos "function %s unsupported\n"),
8205 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8206 1.1 christos howto->name,
8207 1.1 christos sym_name);
8208 1.1 christos ret = FALSE;
8209 1.1 christos }
8210 1.1 christos else if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF || bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
8211 1.1 christos ;
8212 1.1 christos else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
8213 1.1 christos {
8214 1.1 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8215 1.1 christos ret = FALSE;
8216 1.1 christos }
8217 1.1 christos else
8218 1.1 christos {
8219 1.1 christos asection *osec;
8220 1.1 christos
8221 1.1 christos /* We are turning this relocation into one
8222 1.1 christos against a section symbol. It would be
8223 1.1 christos proper to subtract the symbol's value,
8224 1.1 christos osec->vma, from the emitted reloc addend,
8225 1.1 christos but ld.so expects buggy relocs.
8226 1.1 christos FIXME: Why not always use a zero index? */
8227 1.1 christos osec = sec->output_section;
8228 1.1 christos indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
8229 1.1 christos if (indx == 0)
8230 1.1 christos {
8231 1.1 christos osec = htab->elf.text_index_section;
8232 1.1 christos indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
8233 1.1 christos }
8234 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (indx != 0);
8235 1.7 christos #ifdef DEBUG
8236 1.7 christos if (indx == 0)
8237 1.7 christos printf ("indx=%ld section=%s flags=%08x name=%s\n",
8238 1.7 christos indx, osec->name, osec->flags,
8239 1.7 christos h->root.root.string);
8240 1.7 christos #endif
8241 1.7 christos }
8242 1.7 christos
8243 1.7 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
8244 1.7 christos }
8245 1.7 christos else if (ifunc != NULL)
8246 1.7 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
8247 1.1 christos else
8248 1.1 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
8249 1.1 christos }
8250 1.1 christos
8251 1.1 christos sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
8252 1.6 christos if (ifunc)
8253 1.1 christos {
8254 1.7 christos sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
8255 1.7 christos if (indx == 0)
8256 1.7 christos htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
8257 1.1 christos else if (is_static_defined (h))
8258 1.1 christos htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
8259 1.1 christos }
8260 1.1 christos if (sreloc == NULL)
8261 1.1 christos return FALSE;
8262 1.1 christos
8263 1.1 christos loc = sreloc->contents;
8264 1.1 christos loc += sreloc->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8265 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
8266 1.1 christos
8267 1.1 christos if (skip == -1)
8268 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
8269 1.1 christos
8270 1.1 christos /* This reloc will be computed at runtime. Clear the memory
8271 1.1 christos so that it contains a predictable value for prelink. */
8272 1.1 christos if (!skip)
8273 1.1 christos {
8274 1.6 christos relocation = howto->pc_relative ? outrel.r_offset : 0;
8275 1.1 christos addend = 0;
8276 1.1 christos break;
8277 1.1 christos }
8278 1.1 christos }
8279 1.1 christos break;
8280 1.1 christos
8281 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
8282 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
8283 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
8284 1.7 christos {
8285 1.7 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
8286 1.1 christos bfd_vma got2_addend = 0;
8287 1.1 christos
8288 1.7 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
8289 1.1 christos {
8290 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8291 1.1 christos got2_addend = addend;
8292 1.3 christos addend = 0;
8293 1.3 christos }
8294 1.3 christos ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2, got2_addend);
8295 1.3 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
8296 1.3 christos relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
8297 1.6 christos + htab->glink->output_offset
8298 1.3 christos + ent->glink_offset);
8299 1.3 christos else
8300 1.3 christos relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
8301 1.3 christos + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
8302 1.3 christos + ent->plt.offset);
8303 1.7 christos }
8304 1.7 christos /* Fall through. */
8305 1.7 christos
8306 1.3 christos case R_PPC_RELAX:
8307 1.3 christos {
8308 1.3 christos const int *stub;
8309 1.3 christos size_t size;
8310 1.3 christos size_t insn_offset = rel->r_offset;
8311 1.3 christos unsigned int insn;
8312 1.3 christos
8313 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8314 1.1 christos {
8315 1.1 christos relocation -= (input_section->output_section->vma
8316 1.6 christos + input_section->output_offset
8317 1.3 christos + rel->r_offset - 4);
8318 1.1 christos stub = shared_stub_entry;
8319 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[0], contents + insn_offset - 12);
8320 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[1], contents + insn_offset - 8);
8321 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[2], contents + insn_offset - 4);
8322 1.7 christos stub += 3;
8323 1.3 christos size = ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry) - 3;
8324 1.3 christos }
8325 1.3 christos else
8326 1.3 christos {
8327 1.7 christos stub = stub_entry;
8328 1.3 christos size = ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
8329 1.3 christos }
8330 1.3 christos
8331 1.3 christos relocation += addend;
8332 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
8333 1.3 christos relocation = 0;
8334 1.3 christos
8335 1.7 christos /* First insn is HA, second is LO. */
8336 1.3 christos insn = *stub++;
8337 1.3 christos insn |= ((relocation + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
8338 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8339 1.1 christos insn_offset += 4;
8340 1.1 christos
8341 1.1 christos insn = *stub++;
8342 1.1 christos insn |= relocation & 0xffff;
8343 1.6 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8344 1.6 christos insn_offset += 4;
8345 1.6 christos size -= 2;
8346 1.6 christos
8347 1.6 christos while (size != 0)
8348 1.6 christos {
8349 1.6 christos insn = *stub++;
8350 1.1 christos --size;
8351 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8352 1.1 christos insn_offset += 4;
8353 1.1 christos }
8354 1.1 christos
8355 1.1 christos /* Rewrite the reloc and convert one of the trailing nop
8356 1.1 christos relocs to describe this relocation. */
8357 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_NONE);
8358 1.1 christos /* The relocs are at the bottom 2 bytes */
8359 1.1 christos wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset + d_offset;
8360 1.1 christos wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
8361 1.1 christos wrel->r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8362 1.1 christos memmove (wrel + 1, wrel, (relend - wrel - 1) * sizeof (*wrel));
8363 1.1 christos wrel++, rel++;
8364 1.1 christos wrel->r_offset += 4;
8365 1.1 christos wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
8366 1.1 christos }
8367 1.1 christos continue;
8368 1.1 christos
8369 1.1 christos /* Indirect .sdata relocation. */
8370 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
8371 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[0].section != NULL);
8372 1.1 christos if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[0].sym))
8373 1.1 christos {
8374 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8375 1.1 christos break;
8376 1.1 christos }
8377 1.1 christos relocation
8378 1.1 christos = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[0],
8379 1.1 christos h, relocation, rel);
8380 1.1 christos addend = 0;
8381 1.1 christos break;
8382 1.1 christos
8383 1.1 christos /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation. */
8384 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
8385 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[1].section != NULL);
8386 1.1 christos if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[1].sym))
8387 1.1 christos {
8388 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8389 1.1 christos break;
8390 1.1 christos }
8391 1.1 christos relocation
8392 1.1 christos = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[1],
8393 1.1 christos h, relocation, rel);
8394 1.1 christos addend = 0;
8395 1.1 christos break;
8396 1.1 christos
8397 1.1 christos /* Handle the TOC16 reloc. We want to use the offset within the .got
8398 1.1 christos section, not the actual VMA. This is appropriate when generating
8399 1.1 christos an embedded ELF object, for which the .got section acts like the
8400 1.1 christos AIX .toc section. */
8401 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TOC16: /* phony GOT16 relocations */
8402 1.6 christos if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8403 1.6 christos {
8404 1.6 christos unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8405 1.6 christos break;
8406 1.1 christos }
8407 1.7 christos BFD_ASSERT (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (sec->owner, sec),
8408 1.1 christos ".got") == 0
8409 1.1 christos || strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (sec->owner, sec),
8410 1.1 christos ".cgot") == 0);
8411 1.1 christos
8412 1.1 christos addend -= sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset + 0x8000;
8413 1.1 christos break;
8414 1.1 christos
8415 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
8416 1.1 christos if (h != NULL && ifunc == NULL)
8417 1.1 christos {
8418 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
8419 1.1 christos
8420 1.1 christos ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2,
8421 1.1 christos bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
8422 1.1 christos if (ent == NULL
8423 1.7 christos || htab->elf.splt == NULL)
8424 1.7 christos {
8425 1.1 christos /* We didn't make a PLT entry for this symbol. This
8426 1.1 christos happens when statically linking PIC code, or when
8427 1.1 christos using -Bsymbolic. */
8428 1.1 christos }
8429 1.1 christos else
8430 1.1 christos {
8431 1.1 christos /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the
8432 1.1 christos procedure linkage table. */
8433 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8434 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
8435 1.8 christos relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
8436 1.8 christos + htab->glink->output_offset
8437 1.8 christos + ent->glink_offset);
8438 1.8 christos else
8439 1.8 christos relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
8440 1.8 christos + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
8441 1.8 christos + ent->plt.offset);
8442 1.8 christos }
8443 1.8 christos }
8444 1.8 christos
8445 1.8 christos /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special. If non-zero, the
8446 1.8 christos addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2.
8447 1.8 christos Don't apply it to the relocation field. */
8448 1.8 christos addend = 0;
8449 1.8 christos break;
8450 1.8 christos
8451 1.8 christos case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
8452 1.8 christos case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
8453 1.8 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
8454 1.8 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
8455 1.8 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8456 1.8 christos plt_list = NULL;
8457 1.8 christos if (h != NULL)
8458 1.8 christos plt_list = &h->plt.plist;
8459 1.8 christos else if (ifunc != NULL)
8460 1.8 christos plt_list = ifunc;
8461 1.8 christos else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
8462 1.8 christos {
8463 1.8 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt;
8464 1.8 christos local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
8465 1.8 christos + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
8466 1.8 christos plt_list = local_plt + r_symndx;
8467 1.8 christos }
8468 1.8 christos unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8469 1.8 christos if (plt_list != NULL)
8470 1.8 christos {
8471 1.8 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
8472 1.8 christos
8473 1.8 christos ent = find_plt_ent (plt_list, got2,
8474 1.8 christos bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
8475 1.8 christos if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
8476 1.8 christos {
8477 1.8 christos asection *plt;
8478 1.8 christos
8479 1.8 christos unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8480 1.8 christos plt = htab->elf.splt;
8481 1.8 christos if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
8482 1.8 christos || h == NULL
8483 1.8 christos || h->dynindx == -1)
8484 1.8 christos {
8485 1.8 christos if (ifunc != NULL)
8486 1.8 christos plt = htab->elf.iplt;
8487 1.8 christos else
8488 1.8 christos plt = htab->pltlocal;
8489 1.8 christos }
8490 1.8 christos relocation = (plt->output_section->vma
8491 1.8 christos + plt->output_offset
8492 1.8 christos + ent->plt.offset);
8493 1.8 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8494 1.1 christos {
8495 1.1 christos bfd_vma got = 0;
8496 1.1 christos
8497 1.1 christos if (ent->addend >= 32768)
8498 1.1 christos got = (ent->addend
8499 1.1 christos + ent->sec->output_section->vma
8500 1.1 christos + ent->sec->output_offset);
8501 1.1 christos else
8502 1.1 christos got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
8503 1.1 christos relocation -= got;
8504 1.1 christos }
8505 1.1 christos }
8506 1.1 christos }
8507 1.1 christos addend = 0;
8508 1.1 christos break;
8509 1.1 christos
8510 1.3 christos /* Relocate against _SDA_BASE_. */
8511 1.3 christos case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
8512 1.1 christos {
8513 1.8 christos const char *name;
8514 1.7 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8515 1.8 christos
8516 1.8 christos if (sec == NULL
8517 1.1 christos || sec->output_section == NULL
8518 1.1 christos || !is_static_defined (sda))
8519 1.1 christos {
8520 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8521 1.1 christos break;
8522 1.1 christos }
8523 1.1 christos addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8524 1.1 christos
8525 1.1 christos name = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd, sec->output_section);
8526 1.1 christos if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8527 1.1 christos || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0))
8528 1.1 christos {
8529 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler
8530 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
8531 1.1 christos (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8532 1.1 christos "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8533 1.1 christos input_bfd,
8534 1.1 christos sym_name,
8535 1.1 christos howto->name,
8536 1.1 christos name);
8537 1.1 christos }
8538 1.1 christos }
8539 1.1 christos break;
8540 1.1 christos
8541 1.3 christos /* Relocate against _SDA2_BASE_. */
8542 1.3 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
8543 1.1 christos {
8544 1.8 christos const char *name;
8545 1.7 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8546 1.8 christos
8547 1.8 christos if (sec == NULL
8548 1.1 christos || sec->output_section == NULL
8549 1.1 christos || !is_static_defined (sda))
8550 1.1 christos {
8551 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8552 1.1 christos break;
8553 1.1 christos }
8554 1.1 christos addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8555 1.1 christos
8556 1.1 christos name = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd, sec->output_section);
8557 1.3 christos if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8558 1.7 christos || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0))
8559 1.7 christos {
8560 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
8561 1.6 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
8562 1.1 christos (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8563 1.1 christos "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8564 1.3 christos input_bfd,
8565 1.7 christos sym_name,
8566 1.7 christos howto->name,
8567 1.7 christos name);
8568 1.6 christos }
8569 1.1 christos }
8570 1.1 christos break;
8571 1.3 christos
8572 1.7 christos case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
8573 1.7 christos relocation = relocation + addend;
8574 1.7 christos ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8575 1.6 christos contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8576 1.1 christos split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8577 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
8578 1.3 christos
8579 1.7 christos case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
8580 1.7 christos relocation = relocation + addend;
8581 1.7 christos ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8582 1.6 christos contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8583 1.1 christos split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8584 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
8585 1.3 christos
8586 1.7 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
8587 1.7 christos relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
8588 1.7 christos ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8589 1.6 christos contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8590 1.1 christos split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8591 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
8592 1.3 christos
8593 1.7 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
8594 1.7 christos relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
8595 1.7 christos ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8596 1.6 christos contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8597 1.1 christos split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8598 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
8599 1.1 christos
8600 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
8601 1.1 christos relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
8602 1.1 christos ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8603 1.1 christos contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8604 1.1 christos split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8605 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
8606 1.3 christos
8607 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
8608 1.1 christos relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
8609 1.1 christos ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8610 1.1 christos contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8611 1.1 christos split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8612 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
8613 1.1 christos
8614 1.1 christos /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_, _SDA2_BASE_, or 0. */
8615 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
8616 1.3 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
8617 1.3 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
8618 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
8619 1.1 christos {
8620 1.1 christos const char *name;
8621 1.1 christos int reg;
8622 1.3 christos unsigned int insn;
8623 1.3 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
8624 1.1 christos
8625 1.1 christos if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8626 1.1 christos {
8627 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8628 1.1 christos break;
8629 1.1 christos }
8630 1.1 christos
8631 1.1 christos name = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd, sec->output_section);
8632 1.1 christos if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8633 1.1 christos || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
8634 1.1 christos {
8635 1.8 christos reg = 13;
8636 1.7 christos sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8637 1.8 christos }
8638 1.8 christos else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8639 1.1 christos || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
8640 1.1 christos {
8641 1.1 christos reg = 2;
8642 1.1 christos sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8643 1.1 christos }
8644 1.1 christos else if (strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sdata0") == 0
8645 1.1 christos || strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0") == 0)
8646 1.6 christos {
8647 1.1 christos reg = 0;
8648 1.1 christos }
8649 1.1 christos else
8650 1.1 christos {
8651 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler
8652 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
8653 1.1 christos (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8654 1.1 christos "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8655 1.1 christos input_bfd,
8656 1.1 christos sym_name,
8657 1.1 christos howto->name,
8658 1.1 christos name);
8659 1.7 christos
8660 1.1 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8661 1.1 christos ret = FALSE;
8662 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
8663 1.1 christos }
8664 1.3 christos
8665 1.3 christos if (sda != NULL)
8666 1.3 christos {
8667 1.3 christos if (!is_static_defined (sda))
8668 1.3 christos {
8669 1.3 christos unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8670 1.3 christos break;
8671 1.3 christos }
8672 1.3 christos addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8673 1.3 christos }
8674 1.3 christos
8675 1.3 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
8676 1.3 christos if (reg == 0
8677 1.3 christos && (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
8678 1.3 christos || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO))
8679 1.7 christos {
8680 1.3 christos relocation = relocation + addend;
8681 1.3 christos addend = 0;
8682 1.3 christos
8683 1.3 christos /* Force e_li insn, keeping RT from original insn. */
8684 1.6 christos insn &= 0x1f << 21;
8685 1.1 christos insn |= 28u << 26;
8686 1.1 christos
8687 1.1 christos /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31. */
8688 1.1 christos /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20. */
8689 1.1 christos insn |= (relocation & 0xf0000) >> 5;
8690 1.3 christos /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15. */
8691 1.1 christos insn |= (relocation & 0xf800) << 5;
8692 1.1 christos /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31. */
8693 1.7 christos insn |= relocation & 0x7ff;
8694 1.1 christos
8695 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8696 1.1 christos
8697 1.1 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
8698 1.1 christos && ((relocation + 0x80000) & 0xffffffff) > 0x100000)
8699 1.1 christos goto overflow;
8700 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
8701 1.1 christos }
8702 1.1 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_SDA21
8703 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
8704 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO)
8705 1.1 christos {
8706 1.1 christos /* Fill in register field. */
8707 1.1 christos insn = (insn & ~RA_REGISTER_MASK) | (reg << RA_REGISTER_SHIFT);
8708 1.1 christos }
8709 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8710 1.1 christos }
8711 1.1 christos break;
8712 1.1 christos
8713 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
8714 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
8715 1.3 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
8716 1.3 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
8717 1.7 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
8718 1.3 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
8719 1.3 christos {
8720 1.7 christos bfd_vma value;
8721 1.1 christos const char *name;
8722 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
8723 1.7 christos
8724 1.7 christos if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8725 1.8 christos {
8726 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8727 1.1 christos break;
8728 1.1 christos }
8729 1.1 christos
8730 1.1 christos name = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd, sec->output_section);
8731 1.1 christos if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8732 1.1 christos || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
8733 1.1 christos sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8734 1.6 christos else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8735 1.1 christos || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
8736 1.1 christos sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8737 1.7 christos else
8738 1.1 christos {
8739 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
8740 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
8741 1.1 christos (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8742 1.7 christos "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8743 1.3 christos input_bfd,
8744 1.3 christos sym_name,
8745 1.7 christos howto->name,
8746 1.7 christos name);
8747 1.7 christos
8748 1.7 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8749 1.3 christos ret = FALSE;
8750 1.7 christos goto copy_reloc;
8751 1.7 christos }
8752 1.7 christos
8753 1.7 christos if (sda == NULL || !is_static_defined (sda))
8754 1.3 christos {
8755 1.3 christos unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8756 1.3 christos break;
8757 1.7 christos }
8758 1.7 christos value = relocation + addend - SYM_VAL (sda);
8759 1.7 christos
8760 1.7 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A)
8761 1.3 christos ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8762 1.3 christos contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8763 1.3 christos split16a_type,
8764 1.3 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8765 1.7 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D)
8766 1.7 christos ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8767 1.7 christos contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8768 1.7 christos split16d_type,
8769 1.3 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8770 1.3 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A)
8771 1.3 christos {
8772 1.3 christos value = value >> 16;
8773 1.7 christos ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8774 1.7 christos contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8775 1.7 christos split16a_type,
8776 1.7 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8777 1.3 christos }
8778 1.3 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D)
8779 1.3 christos {
8780 1.3 christos value = value >> 16;
8781 1.7 christos ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8782 1.7 christos contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8783 1.7 christos split16d_type,
8784 1.7 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8785 1.1 christos }
8786 1.1 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A)
8787 1.6 christos {
8788 1.1 christos value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
8789 1.8 christos ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8790 1.8 christos contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8791 1.8 christos split16a_type,
8792 1.8 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8793 1.1 christos }
8794 1.1 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D)
8795 1.1 christos {
8796 1.1 christos value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
8797 1.1 christos ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8798 1.1 christos contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8799 1.1 christos split16d_type,
8800 1.1 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8801 1.1 christos }
8802 1.1 christos }
8803 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
8804 1.1 christos
8805 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
8806 1.1 christos ppc_elf_vle_split20 (output_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset, relocation);
8807 1.1 christos continue;
8808 1.1 christos
8809 1.1 christos /* Relocate against the beginning of the section. */
8810 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
8811 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
8812 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
8813 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
8814 1.1 christos if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8815 1.1 christos {
8816 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8817 1.1 christos break;
8818 1.1 christos }
8819 1.1 christos addend -= sec->output_section->vma;
8820 1.1 christos break;
8821 1.1 christos
8822 1.1 christos /* Negative relocations. */
8823 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
8824 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
8825 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
8826 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
8827 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
8828 1.8 christos addend -= 2 * relocation;
8829 1.8 christos break;
8830 1.8 christos
8831 1.1 christos case R_PPC_COPY:
8832 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
8833 1.1 christos case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
8834 1.6 christos case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
8835 1.1 christos case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
8836 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLT32:
8837 1.8 christos case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
8838 1.8 christos case R_PPC_ADDR30:
8839 1.8 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
8840 1.8 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
8841 1.8 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
8842 1.8 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
8843 1.8 christos case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
8844 1.8 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
8845 1.8 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
8846 1.8 christos input_bfd, howto->name);
8847 1.8 christos
8848 1.8 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8849 1.8 christos ret = FALSE;
8850 1.8 christos goto copy_reloc;
8851 1.8 christos }
8852 1.8 christos
8853 1.8 christos switch (r_type)
8854 1.8 christos {
8855 1.8 christos default:
8856 1.8 christos break;
8857 1.8 christos
8858 1.8 christos case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
8859 1.8 christos if (unresolved_reloc)
8860 1.8 christos {
8861 1.8 christos bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset;
8862 1.8 christos unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8863 1.8 christos insn &= 1;
8864 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | insn, p);
8865 1.8 christos unresolved_reloc = save_unresolved_reloc;
8866 1.8 christos r_type = R_PPC_REL24;
8867 1.8 christos howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
8868 1.8 christos }
8869 1.8 christos else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
8870 1.8 christos info->callbacks->einfo
8871 1.8 christos (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
8872 1.8 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8873 1.8 christos howto->name);
8874 1.8 christos break;
8875 1.8 christos
8876 1.8 christos case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
8877 1.8 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8878 1.8 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
8879 1.1 christos if (unresolved_reloc)
8880 1.1 christos {
8881 1.1 christos bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
8882 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
8883 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8884 1.1 christos r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
8885 1.1 christos howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
8886 1.1 christos }
8887 1.6 christos else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
8888 1.1 christos info->callbacks->einfo
8889 1.1 christos (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
8890 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8891 1.1 christos howto->name);
8892 1.1 christos break;
8893 1.1 christos }
8894 1.1 christos
8895 1.1 christos /* Do any further special processing. */
8896 1.1 christos switch (r_type)
8897 1.1 christos {
8898 1.1 christos default:
8899 1.7 christos break;
8900 1.1 christos
8901 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
8902 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
8903 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
8904 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
8905 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8906 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
8907 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
8908 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
8909 1.1 christos /* It's just possible that this symbol is a weak symbol
8910 1.1 christos that's not actually defined anywhere. In that case,
8911 1.1 christos 'sec' would be NULL, and we should leave the symbol
8912 1.1 christos alone (it will be set to zero elsewhere in the link). */
8913 1.1 christos if (sec == NULL)
8914 1.1 christos break;
8915 1.1 christos /* Fall through. */
8916 1.1 christos
8917 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8918 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
8919 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
8920 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
8921 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
8922 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
8923 1.1 christos /* Add 0x10000 if sign bit in 0:15 is set.
8924 1.1 christos Bits 0:15 are not used. */
8925 1.1 christos addend += 0x8000;
8926 1.1 christos break;
8927 1.1 christos
8928 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16:
8929 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
8930 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16:
8931 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
8932 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
8933 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
8934 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
8935 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
8936 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
8937 1.7 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16:
8938 1.6 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
8939 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
8940 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
8941 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
8942 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
8943 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
8944 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
8945 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
8946 1.6 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
8947 1.6 christos {
8948 1.6 christos /* The 32-bit ABI lacks proper relocations to deal with
8949 1.1 christos certain 64-bit instructions. Prevent damage to bits
8950 1.1 christos that make up part of the insn opcode. */
8951 1.6 christos unsigned int insn, mask, lobit;
8952 1.1 christos
8953 1.7 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
8954 1.7 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
8955 1.1 christos mask = 0;
8956 1.1 christos if (is_insn_ds_form (insn))
8957 1.1 christos mask = 3;
8958 1.1 christos else if (is_insn_dq_form (insn))
8959 1.1 christos mask = 15;
8960 1.1 christos else
8961 1.1 christos break;
8962 1.1 christos relocation += addend;
8963 1.1 christos addend = insn & mask;
8964 1.1 christos lobit = mask & relocation;
8965 1.1 christos if (lobit != 0)
8966 1.1 christos {
8967 1.1 christos relocation ^= lobit;
8968 1.1 christos info->callbacks->einfo
8969 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
8970 1.1 christos (_("%H: error: %s against `%s' not a multiple of %u\n"),
8971 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8972 1.1 christos howto->name, sym_name, mask + 1);
8973 1.1 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8974 1.1 christos ret = FALSE;
8975 1.1 christos }
8976 1.1 christos }
8977 1.1 christos break;
8978 1.1 christos }
8979 1.1 christos
8980 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
8981 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, "\ttype = %s (%d), name = %s, symbol index = %ld, "
8982 1.7 christos "offset = %ld, addend = %ld\n",
8983 1.7 christos howto->name,
8984 1.1 christos (int) r_type,
8985 1.1 christos sym_name,
8986 1.1 christos r_symndx,
8987 1.1 christos (long) rel->r_offset,
8988 1.1 christos (long) addend);
8989 1.1 christos #endif
8990 1.3 christos
8991 1.3 christos if (unresolved_reloc
8992 1.3 christos && !((input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0
8993 1.3 christos && h->def_dynamic)
8994 1.3 christos && _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section,
8995 1.3 christos rel->r_offset) != (bfd_vma) -1)
8996 1.3 christos {
8997 1.3 christos info->callbacks->einfo
8998 1.3 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
8999 1.3 christos (_("%H: unresolvable %s relocation against symbol `%s'\n"),
9000 1.3 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
9001 1.3 christos howto->name,
9002 1.3 christos sym_name);
9003 1.3 christos ret = FALSE;
9004 1.3 christos }
9005 1.3 christos
9006 1.3 christos /* 16-bit fields in insns mostly have signed values, but a
9007 1.3 christos few insns have 16-bit unsigned values. Really, we should
9008 1.3 christos have different reloc types. */
9009 1.3 christos if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain_overflow_dont
9010 1.3 christos && howto->dst_mask == 0xffff
9011 1.3 christos && (input_section->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
9012 1.3 christos {
9013 1.3 christos enum complain_overflow complain = complain_overflow_signed;
9014 1.3 christos
9015 1.3 christos if ((elf_section_flags (input_section) & SHF_PPC_VLE) == 0)
9016 1.3 christos {
9017 1.3 christos unsigned int insn;
9018 1.3 christos
9019 1.6 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
9020 1.6 christos if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 10u << 26 /* cmpli */)
9021 1.6 christos complain = complain_overflow_bitfield;
9022 1.6 christos else if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi */
9023 1.6 christos || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori */
9024 1.6 christos || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori */)
9025 1.6 christos complain = complain_overflow_unsigned;
9026 1.6 christos }
9027 1.6 christos if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain)
9028 1.6 christos {
9029 1.6 christos alt_howto = *howto;
9030 1.6 christos alt_howto.complain_on_overflow = complain;
9031 1.6 christos howto = &alt_howto;
9032 1.6 christos }
9033 1.6 christos }
9034 1.6 christos
9035 1.6 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
9036 1.6 christos {
9037 1.6 christos /* Split field reloc isn't handled by _bfd_final_link_relocate. */
9038 1.6 christos if (rel->r_offset + 4 > input_section->size)
9039 1.6 christos r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
9040 1.6 christos else
9041 1.6 christos {
9042 1.6 christos unsigned int insn;
9043 1.1 christos
9044 1.1 christos relocation += addend;
9045 1.1 christos relocation -= (rel->r_offset
9046 1.1 christos + input_section->output_offset
9047 1.1 christos + input_section->output_section->vma);
9048 1.3 christos relocation >>= 16;
9049 1.5 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
9050 1.5 christos insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
9051 1.5 christos insn |= (relocation & 0xffc1) | ((relocation & 0x3e) << 15);
9052 1.5 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
9053 1.5 christos r = bfd_reloc_ok;
9054 1.5 christos }
9055 1.5 christos }
9056 1.6 christos else
9057 1.6 christos r = _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section, contents,
9058 1.6 christos rel->r_offset, relocation, addend);
9059 1.1 christos
9060 1.1 christos if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
9061 1.1 christos {
9062 1.1 christos if (r == bfd_reloc_overflow)
9063 1.7 christos {
9064 1.7 christos overflow:
9065 1.1 christos /* On code like "if (foo) foo();" don't report overflow
9066 1.1 christos on a branch to zero when foo is undefined. */
9067 1.1 christos if (!warned
9068 1.1 christos && !(h != NULL
9069 1.1 christos && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
9070 1.6 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
9071 1.6 christos && is_branch_reloc (r_type)))
9072 1.6 christos info->callbacks->reloc_overflow
9073 1.6 christos (info, (h ? &h->root : NULL), sym_name, howto->name,
9074 1.6 christos rel->r_addend, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
9075 1.6 christos }
9076 1.6 christos else
9077 1.6 christos {
9078 1.6 christos info->callbacks->einfo
9079 1.6 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
9080 1.6 christos (_("%H: %s reloc against `%s': error %d\n"),
9081 1.6 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
9082 1.6 christos howto->name, sym_name, (int) r);
9083 1.6 christos ret = FALSE;
9084 1.6 christos }
9085 1.6 christos }
9086 1.6 christos copy_reloc:
9087 1.6 christos if (wrel != rel)
9088 1.6 christos *wrel = *rel;
9089 1.6 christos }
9090 1.6 christos
9091 1.6 christos if (wrel != rel)
9092 1.6 christos {
9093 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
9094 1.6 christos size_t deleted = rel - wrel;
9095 1.1 christos
9096 1.1 christos rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section->output_section);
9097 1.1 christos rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
9098 1.1 christos if (rel_hdr->sh_size == 0)
9099 1.1 christos {
9100 1.1 christos /* It is too late to remove an empty reloc section. Leave
9101 1.3 christos one NONE reloc.
9102 1.3 christos ??? What is wrong with an empty section??? */
9103 1.3 christos rel_hdr->sh_size = rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
9104 1.3 christos deleted -= 1;
9105 1.3 christos wrel++;
9106 1.3 christos }
9107 1.3 christos relend = wrel;
9108 1.3 christos rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section);
9109 1.3 christos rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
9110 1.3 christos input_section->reloc_count -= deleted;
9111 1.3 christos }
9112 1.3 christos
9113 1.6 christos #ifdef DEBUG
9114 1.3 christos fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9115 1.3 christos #endif
9116 1.3 christos
9117 1.3 christos if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
9118 1.3 christos && input_section->size != input_section->rawsize
9119 1.3 christos && (strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
9120 1.3 christos || strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0))
9121 1.3 christos {
9122 1.3 christos /* Branch around the trampolines. */
9123 1.3 christos unsigned int insn = B + input_section->size - input_section->rawsize;
9124 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + input_section->rawsize);
9125 1.3 christos }
9126 1.3 christos
9127 1.3 christos if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
9128 1.3 christos && input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
9129 1.3 christos && (!bfd_link_relocatable (info)
9130 1.3 christos || (input_section->output_section->alignment_power
9131 1.3 christos >= htab->params->pagesize_p2)))
9132 1.3 christos {
9133 1.3 christos bfd_vma start_addr, end_addr, addr;
9134 1.3 christos bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
9135 1.3 christos
9136 1.3 christos if (relax_info->workaround_size != 0)
9137 1.3 christos {
9138 1.3 christos bfd_byte *p;
9139 1.3 christos unsigned int n;
9140 1.3 christos bfd_byte fill[4];
9141 1.3 christos
9142 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, BA, fill);
9143 1.3 christos p = contents + input_section->size - relax_info->workaround_size;
9144 1.3 christos n = relax_info->workaround_size >> 2;
9145 1.3 christos while (n--)
9146 1.3 christos {
9147 1.3 christos memcpy (p, fill, 4);
9148 1.3 christos p += 4;
9149 1.3 christos }
9150 1.3 christos }
9151 1.3 christos
9152 1.3 christos /* The idea is: Replace the last instruction on a page with a
9153 1.3 christos branch to a patch area. Put the insn there followed by a
9154 1.3 christos branch back to the next page. Complicated a little by
9155 1.3 christos needing to handle moved conditional branches, and by not
9156 1.3 christos wanting to touch data-in-text. */
9157 1.3 christos
9158 1.3 christos start_addr = (input_section->output_section->vma
9159 1.3 christos + input_section->output_offset);
9160 1.3 christos end_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
9161 1.3 christos - relax_info->workaround_size);
9162 1.3 christos for (addr = ((start_addr & -pagesize) + pagesize - 4);
9163 1.3 christos addr < end_addr;
9164 1.3 christos addr += pagesize)
9165 1.3 christos {
9166 1.3 christos bfd_vma offset = addr - start_addr;
9167 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *lo, *hi;
9168 1.3 christos bfd_boolean is_data;
9169 1.3 christos bfd_vma patch_off, patch_addr;
9170 1.3 christos unsigned int insn;
9171 1.3 christos
9172 1.3 christos /* Do we have a data reloc at this offset? If so, leave
9173 1.3 christos the word alone. */
9174 1.3 christos is_data = FALSE;
9175 1.3 christos lo = relocs;
9176 1.3 christos hi = relend;
9177 1.3 christos rel = NULL;
9178 1.3 christos while (lo < hi)
9179 1.3 christos {
9180 1.3 christos rel = lo + (hi - lo) / 2;
9181 1.3 christos if (rel->r_offset < offset)
9182 1.3 christos lo = rel + 1;
9183 1.3 christos else if (rel->r_offset > offset + 3)
9184 1.3 christos hi = rel;
9185 1.3 christos else
9186 1.3 christos {
9187 1.3 christos switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
9188 1.3 christos {
9189 1.3 christos case R_PPC_ADDR32:
9190 1.3 christos case R_PPC_UADDR32:
9191 1.3 christos case R_PPC_REL32:
9192 1.3 christos case R_PPC_ADDR30:
9193 1.3 christos is_data = TRUE;
9194 1.3 christos break;
9195 1.3 christos default:
9196 1.3 christos break;
9197 1.3 christos }
9198 1.3 christos break;
9199 1.3 christos }
9200 1.3 christos }
9201 1.3 christos if (is_data)
9202 1.3 christos continue;
9203 1.3 christos
9204 1.3 christos /* Some instructions can be left alone too. Unconditional
9205 1.3 christos branches, except for bcctr with BO=0x14 (bctr, bctrl),
9206 1.3 christos avoid the icache failure.
9207 1.3 christos
9208 1.3 christos The problem occurs due to prefetch across a page boundary
9209 1.3 christos where stale instructions can be fetched from the next
9210 1.3 christos page, and the mechanism for flushing these bad
9211 1.3 christos instructions fails under certain circumstances. The
9212 1.3 christos unconditional branches:
9213 1.3 christos 1) Branch: b, bl, ba, bla,
9214 1.3 christos 2) Branch Conditional: bc, bca, bcl, bcla,
9215 1.3 christos 3) Branch Conditional to Link Register: bclr, bclrl,
9216 1.3 christos where (2) and (3) have BO=0x14 making them unconditional,
9217 1.3 christos prevent the bad prefetch because the prefetch itself is
9218 1.3 christos affected by these instructions. This happens even if the
9219 1.3 christos instruction is not executed.
9220 1.3 christos
9221 1.3 christos A bctr example:
9222 1.3 christos .
9223 1.6 christos . lis 9,new_page@ha
9224 1.6 christos . addi 9,9,new_page@l
9225 1.6 christos . mtctr 9
9226 1.6 christos . bctr
9227 1.3 christos . nop
9228 1.6 christos . nop
9229 1.6 christos . new_page:
9230 1.3 christos .
9231 1.3 christos The bctr is not predicted taken due to ctr not being
9232 1.8 christos ready, so prefetch continues on past the bctr into the
9233 1.8 christos new page which might have stale instructions. If they
9234 1.8 christos fail to be flushed, then they will be executed after the
9235 1.3 christos bctr executes. Either of the following modifications
9236 1.3 christos prevent the bad prefetch from happening in the first
9237 1.8 christos place:
9238 1.3 christos .
9239 1.3 christos . lis 9,new_page@ha lis 9,new_page@ha
9240 1.3 christos . addi 9,9,new_page@l addi 9,9,new_page@l
9241 1.3 christos . mtctr 9 mtctr 9
9242 1.3 christos . bctr bctr
9243 1.3 christos . nop b somewhere_else
9244 1.3 christos . b somewhere_else nop
9245 1.3 christos . new_page: new_page:
9246 1.3 christos . */
9247 1.3 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset);
9248 1.3 christos if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (18u << 26) /* b,bl,ba,bla */
9249 1.3 christos || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc,bcl,bca,bcla*/
9250 1.5 christos && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)) /* with BO=0x14 */
9251 1.5 christos || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (19u << 26)
9252 1.3 christos && (insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == (16u << 1) /* bclr,bclrl */
9253 1.3 christos && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)))/* with BO=0x14 */
9254 1.3 christos continue;
9255 1.3 christos
9256 1.3 christos patch_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
9257 1.3 christos - relax_info->workaround_size);
9258 1.3 christos patch_addr = (patch_addr + 15) & -16;
9259 1.3 christos patch_off = patch_addr - start_addr;
9260 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B + patch_off - offset, contents + offset);
9261 1.3 christos
9262 1.3 christos if (rel != NULL
9263 1.3 christos && rel->r_offset >= offset
9264 1.5 christos && rel->r_offset < offset + 4)
9265 1.5 christos {
9266 1.5 christos asection *sreloc;
9267 1.5 christos
9268 1.5 christos /* If the insn we are patching had a reloc, adjust the
9269 1.5 christos reloc r_offset so that the reloc applies to the moved
9270 1.5 christos location. This matters for -r and --emit-relocs. */
9271 1.5 christos if (rel + 1 != relend)
9272 1.5 christos {
9273 1.5 christos Elf_Internal_Rela tmp = *rel;
9274 1.5 christos
9275 1.5 christos /* Keep the relocs sorted by r_offset. */
9276 1.5 christos memmove (rel, rel + 1, (relend - (rel + 1)) * sizeof (*rel));
9277 1.5 christos relend[-1] = tmp;
9278 1.5 christos }
9279 1.5 christos relend[-1].r_offset += patch_off - offset;
9280 1.5 christos
9281 1.5 christos /* Adjust REL16 addends too. */
9282 1.5 christos switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info))
9283 1.5 christos {
9284 1.5 christos case R_PPC_REL16:
9285 1.5 christos case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
9286 1.5 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
9287 1.5 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
9288 1.5 christos relend[-1].r_addend += patch_off - offset;
9289 1.5 christos break;
9290 1.5 christos default:
9291 1.5 christos break;
9292 1.5 christos }
9293 1.5 christos
9294 1.5 christos /* If we are building a PIE or shared library with
9295 1.5 christos non-PIC objects, perhaps we had a dynamic reloc too?
9296 1.5 christos If so, the dynamic reloc must move with the insn. */
9297 1.5 christos sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
9298 1.5 christos if (sreloc != NULL)
9299 1.5 christos {
9300 1.5 christos Elf32_External_Rela *slo, *shi, *srelend;
9301 1.5 christos bfd_vma soffset;
9302 1.5 christos
9303 1.5 christos slo = (Elf32_External_Rela *) sreloc->contents;
9304 1.5 christos shi = srelend = slo + sreloc->reloc_count;
9305 1.5 christos soffset = (offset + input_section->output_section->vma
9306 1.5 christos + input_section->output_offset);
9307 1.5 christos while (slo < shi)
9308 1.5 christos {
9309 1.5 christos Elf32_External_Rela *srel = slo + (shi - slo) / 2;
9310 1.5 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, (bfd_byte *) srel,
9311 1.5 christos &outrel);
9312 1.5 christos if (outrel.r_offset < soffset)
9313 1.5 christos slo = srel + 1;
9314 1.5 christos else if (outrel.r_offset > soffset + 3)
9315 1.3 christos shi = srel;
9316 1.3 christos else
9317 1.3 christos {
9318 1.3 christos if (srel + 1 != srelend)
9319 1.3 christos {
9320 1.3 christos memmove (srel, srel + 1,
9321 1.3 christos (srelend - (srel + 1)) * sizeof (*srel));
9322 1.3 christos srel = srelend - 1;
9323 1.3 christos }
9324 1.3 christos outrel.r_offset += patch_off - offset;
9325 1.6 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel,
9326 1.3 christos (bfd_byte *) srel);
9327 1.6 christos break;
9328 1.3 christos }
9329 1.3 christos }
9330 1.3 christos }
9331 1.3 christos }
9332 1.3 christos else
9333 1.3 christos rel = NULL;
9334 1.3 christos
9335 1.3 christos if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc */
9336 1.3 christos && (insn & 2) == 0 /* relative */)
9337 1.3 christos {
9338 1.3 christos bfd_vma delta = ((insn & 0xfffc) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
9339 1.3 christos
9340 1.3 christos delta += offset - patch_off;
9341 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
9342 1.3 christos delta = 0;
9343 1.3 christos if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
9344 1.3 christos {
9345 1.3 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
9346 1.3 christos
9347 1.3 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info);
9348 1.3 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN)
9349 1.3 christos insn |= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9350 1.3 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
9351 1.3 christos insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9352 1.3 christos else
9353 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT (r_type == R_PPC_REL14);
9354 1.3 christos
9355 1.3 christos if ((r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
9356 1.3 christos || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
9357 1.3 christos && delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000
9358 1.3 christos && (bfd_signed_vma) delta < 0)
9359 1.3 christos insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9360 1.3 christos }
9361 1.3 christos if (delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
9362 1.3 christos {
9363 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9364 1.3 christos (insn & ~0xfffc) | (delta & 0xfffc),
9365 1.3 christos contents + patch_off);
9366 1.3 christos patch_off += 4;
9367 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9368 1.3 christos B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9369 1.3 christos contents + patch_off);
9370 1.3 christos patch_off += 4;
9371 1.3 christos }
9372 1.3 christos else
9373 1.3 christos {
9374 1.3 christos if (rel != NULL)
9375 1.3 christos {
9376 1.3 christos unsigned int r_sym = ELF32_R_SYM (relend[-1].r_info);
9377 1.3 christos
9378 1.3 christos relend[-1].r_offset += 8;
9379 1.3 christos relend[-1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_sym, R_PPC_REL24);
9380 1.3 christos }
9381 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9382 1.3 christos (insn & ~0xfffc) | 8,
9383 1.3 christos contents + patch_off);
9384 1.3 christos patch_off += 4;
9385 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9386 1.3 christos B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9387 1.3 christos contents + patch_off);
9388 1.3 christos patch_off += 4;
9389 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9390 1.3 christos B | ((delta - 8) & 0x3fffffc),
9391 1.3 christos contents + patch_off);
9392 1.3 christos patch_off += 4;
9393 1.1 christos }
9394 1.1 christos }
9395 1.1 christos else
9396 1.8 christos {
9397 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + patch_off);
9398 1.1 christos patch_off += 4;
9399 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9400 1.1 christos B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9401 1.8 christos contents + patch_off);
9402 1.8 christos patch_off += 4;
9403 1.1 christos }
9404 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (patch_off <= input_section->size);
9405 1.1 christos relax_info->workaround_size = input_section->size - patch_off;
9406 1.1 christos }
9407 1.1 christos }
9408 1.1 christos
9409 1.1 christos return ret;
9410 1.1 christos }
9411 1.1 christos
9412 1.1 christos /* Write out the PLT relocs and entries for H. */
9414 1.1 christos
9415 1.8 christos static bfd_boolean
9416 1.8 christos write_global_sym_plt (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
9417 1.1 christos {
9418 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
9419 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9420 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
9421 1.1 christos bfd_boolean doneone;
9422 1.1 christos
9423 1.1 christos doneone = FALSE;
9424 1.1 christos for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9425 1.1 christos if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9426 1.1 christos {
9427 1.1 christos if (!doneone)
9428 1.1 christos {
9429 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9430 1.1 christos bfd_byte *loc;
9431 1.1 christos bfd_vma reloc_index;
9432 1.1 christos asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
9433 1.1 christos asection *relplt = htab->elf.srelplt;
9434 1.1 christos
9435 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
9436 1.1 christos || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9437 1.1 christos || h->dynindx == -1)
9438 1.1 christos reloc_index = ent->plt.offset / 4;
9439 1.1 christos else
9440 1.1 christos {
9441 1.1 christos reloc_index = ((ent->plt.offset - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
9442 1.1 christos / htab->plt_slot_size);
9443 1.1 christos if (reloc_index > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES
9444 1.6 christos && htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
9445 1.1 christos reloc_index -= (reloc_index - PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES) / 2;
9446 1.1 christos }
9447 1.1 christos
9448 1.6 christos /* This symbol has an entry in the procedure linkage table.
9449 1.1 christos Set it up. */
9450 1.8 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS
9451 1.1 christos && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9452 1.8 christos && h->dynindx != -1)
9453 1.8 christos {
9454 1.1 christos bfd_vma got_offset;
9455 1.8 christos const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
9456 1.1 christos
9457 1.1 christos /* The first three entries in .got.plt are reserved. */
9458 1.1 christos got_offset = (reloc_index + 3) * 4;
9459 1.1 christos
9460 1.1 christos /* Use the right PLT. */
9461 1.8 christos plt_entry = bfd_link_pic (info) ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
9462 1.1 christos : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry;
9463 1.8 christos
9464 1.8 christos /* Fill in the .plt on VxWorks. */
9465 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9466 1.8 christos {
9467 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9468 1.1 christos plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_offset),
9469 1.8 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
9470 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9471 1.8 christos plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_offset),
9472 1.8 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
9473 1.1 christos }
9474 1.1 christos else
9475 1.1 christos {
9476 1.1 christos bfd_vma got_loc = got_offset + SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9477 1.1 christos
9478 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9479 1.1 christos plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_loc),
9480 1.8 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
9481 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9482 1.8 christos plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_loc),
9483 1.1 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
9484 1.1 christos }
9485 1.1 christos
9486 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[2],
9487 1.1 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 8);
9488 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[3],
9489 1.8 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 12);
9490 1.1 christos
9491 1.1 christos /* This instruction is an immediate load. The value loaded is
9492 1.8 christos the byte offset of the R_PPC_JMP_SLOT relocation from the
9493 1.8 christos start of the .rela.plt section. The value is stored in the
9494 1.8 christos low-order 16 bits of the load instruction. */
9495 1.8 christos /* NOTE: It appears that this is now an index rather than a
9496 1.8 christos prescaled offset. */
9497 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9498 1.1 christos plt_entry[4] | reloc_index,
9499 1.1 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 16);
9500 1.1 christos /* This instruction is a PC-relative branch whose target is
9501 1.8 christos the start of the PLT section. The address of this branch
9502 1.8 christos instruction is 20 bytes beyond the start of this PLT entry.
9503 1.8 christos The address is encoded in bits 6-29, inclusive. The value
9504 1.7 christos stored is right-shifted by two bits, permitting a 26-bit
9505 1.1 christos offset. */
9506 1.6 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9507 1.1 christos (plt_entry[5]
9508 1.1 christos | (-(ent->plt.offset + 20) & 0x03fffffc)),
9509 1.1 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 20);
9510 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[6],
9511 1.1 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 24);
9512 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[7],
9513 1.1 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 28);
9514 1.1 christos
9515 1.8 christos /* Fill in the GOT entry corresponding to this PLT slot with
9516 1.8 christos the address immediately after the "bctr" instruction
9517 1.1 christos in this PLT entry. */
9518 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, (plt->output_section->vma
9519 1.1 christos + plt->output_offset
9520 1.1 christos + ent->plt.offset + 16),
9521 1.8 christos htab->elf.sgotplt->contents + got_offset);
9522 1.1 christos
9523 1.1 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9524 1.1 christos {
9525 1.8 christos /* Fill in a couple of entries in .rela.plt.unloaded. */
9526 1.8 christos loc = htab->srelplt2->contents
9527 1.1 christos + ((VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS + reloc_index
9528 1.1 christos * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS)
9529 1.1 christos * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9530 1.1 christos
9531 1.8 christos /* Provide the @ha relocation for the first instruction. */
9532 1.1 christos rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9533 1.1 christos + plt->output_offset
9534 1.1 christos + ent->plt.offset + 2);
9535 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
9536 1.7 christos R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
9537 1.7 christos rela.r_addend = got_offset;
9538 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9539 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9540 1.1 christos
9541 1.1 christos /* Provide the @l relocation for the second instruction. */
9542 1.8 christos rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9543 1.1 christos + plt->output_offset
9544 1.1 christos + ent->plt.offset + 6);
9545 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
9546 1.1 christos R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
9547 1.1 christos rela.r_addend = got_offset;
9548 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9549 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9550 1.7 christos
9551 1.7 christos /* Provide a relocation for the GOT entry corresponding to this
9552 1.1 christos PLT slot. Point it at the middle of the .plt entry. */
9553 1.8 christos rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
9554 1.1 christos + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
9555 1.1 christos + got_offset);
9556 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx,
9557 1.8 christos R_PPC_ADDR32);
9558 1.1 christos rela.r_addend = ent->plt.offset + 16;
9559 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9560 1.8 christos }
9561 1.8 christos
9562 1.8 christos /* VxWorks uses non-standard semantics for R_PPC_JMP_SLOT.
9563 1.8 christos In particular, the offset for the relocation is not the
9564 1.8 christos address of the PLT entry for this function, as specified
9565 1.8 christos by the ABI. Instead, the offset is set to the address of
9566 1.8 christos the GOT slot for this function. See EABI 4.4.4.1. */
9567 1.8 christos rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
9568 1.8 christos + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
9569 1.8 christos + got_offset);
9570 1.8 christos rela.r_addend = 0;
9571 1.8 christos }
9572 1.8 christos else
9573 1.8 christos {
9574 1.8 christos rela.r_addend = 0;
9575 1.8 christos if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9576 1.1 christos || h->dynindx == -1)
9577 1.8 christos {
9578 1.1 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9579 1.8 christos {
9580 1.8 christos plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9581 1.1 christos relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
9582 1.1 christos }
9583 1.1 christos else
9584 1.8 christos {
9585 1.8 christos plt = htab->pltlocal;
9586 1.8 christos relplt = bfd_link_pic (info) ? htab->relpltlocal : NULL;
9587 1.8 christos }
9588 1.8 christos if (h->def_regular
9589 1.8 christos && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
9590 1.8 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
9591 1.8 christos rela.r_addend = SYM_VAL (h);
9592 1.8 christos }
9593 1.8 christos
9594 1.8 christos if (relplt == NULL)
9595 1.8 christos {
9596 1.8 christos loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
9597 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, rela.r_addend, loc);
9598 1.8 christos }
9599 1.8 christos else
9600 1.8 christos {
9601 1.8 christos rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9602 1.8 christos + plt->output_offset
9603 1.1 christos + ent->plt.offset);
9604 1.1 christos
9605 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
9606 1.8 christos || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9607 1.1 christos || h->dynindx == -1)
9608 1.8 christos {
9609 1.8 christos /* We don't need to fill in the .plt. The ppc dynamic
9610 1.8 christos linker will fill it in. */
9611 1.8 christos }
9612 1.8 christos else
9613 1.8 christos {
9614 1.8 christos bfd_vma val = (htab->glink_pltresolve + ent->plt.offset
9615 1.8 christos + htab->glink->output_section->vma
9616 1.8 christos + htab->glink->output_offset);
9617 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val,
9618 1.8 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset);
9619 1.8 christos }
9620 1.8 christos }
9621 1.1 christos }
9622 1.8 christos
9623 1.8 christos if (relplt != NULL)
9624 1.8 christos {
9625 1.8 christos /* Fill in the entry in the .rela.plt section. */
9626 1.8 christos if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9627 1.1 christos || h->dynindx == -1)
9628 1.8 christos {
9629 1.1 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9630 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
9631 1.1 christos else
9632 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
9633 1.1 christos loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
9634 1.1 christos * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9635 1.1 christos htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9636 1.1 christos }
9637 1.1 christos else
9638 1.8 christos {
9639 1.8 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_JMP_SLOT);
9640 1.1 christos loc = relplt->contents + (reloc_index
9641 1.1 christos * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9642 1.1 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && is_static_defined (h))
9643 1.8 christos htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9644 1.8 christos }
9645 1.8 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9646 1.8 christos }
9647 1.1 christos doneone = TRUE;
9648 1.1 christos }
9649 1.8 christos
9650 1.8 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
9651 1.1 christos || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9652 1.6 christos || h->dynindx == -1)
9653 1.1 christos {
9654 1.1 christos unsigned char *p;
9655 1.1 christos asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
9656 1.1 christos
9657 1.1 christos if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9658 1.1 christos || h->dynindx == -1)
9659 1.8 christos {
9660 1.8 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9661 1.8 christos plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9662 1.8 christos else
9663 1.8 christos break;
9664 1.8 christos }
9665 1.8 christos
9666 1.8 christos p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
9667 1.8 christos write_glink_stub (h, ent, plt, p, info);
9668 1.8 christos
9669 1.8 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9670 1.8 christos /* We only need one non-PIC glink stub. */
9671 1.8 christos break;
9672 1.8 christos }
9673 1.8 christos else
9674 1.8 christos break;
9675 1.8 christos }
9676 1.8 christos return TRUE;
9677 1.8 christos }
9678 1.8 christos
9679 1.8 christos /* Finish up PLT handling. */
9680 1.8 christos
9681 1.8 christos bfd_boolean
9682 1.8 christos ppc_finish_symbols (struct bfd_link_info *info)
9683 1.8 christos {
9684 1.8 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9685 1.8 christos bfd *ibfd;
9686 1.8 christos
9687 1.8 christos if (!htab)
9688 1.8 christos return TRUE;
9689 1.8 christos
9690 1.8 christos elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, write_global_sym_plt, info);
9691 1.8 christos
9692 1.8 christos for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
9693 1.8 christos {
9694 1.8 christos bfd_vma *local_got, *end_local_got;
9695 1.8 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt, **lplt, **end_local_plt;
9696 1.8 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
9697 1.8 christos bfd_size_type locsymcount;
9698 1.8 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms = NULL;
9699 1.8 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
9700 1.8 christos
9701 1.8 christos if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
9702 1.8 christos continue;
9703 1.8 christos
9704 1.8 christos local_got = elf_local_got_offsets (ibfd);
9705 1.8 christos if (!local_got)
9706 1.8 christos continue;
9707 1.8 christos
9708 1.8 christos symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
9709 1.8 christos locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
9710 1.8 christos end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
9711 1.8 christos local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
9712 1.8 christos end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
9713 1.8 christos for (lplt = local_plt; lplt < end_local_plt; ++lplt)
9714 1.8 christos for (ent = *lplt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9715 1.8 christos {
9716 1.8 christos if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9717 1.8 christos {
9718 1.8 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
9719 1.8 christos asection *sym_sec;
9720 1.8 christos asection *plt, *relplt;
9721 1.8 christos bfd_byte *loc;
9722 1.8 christos bfd_vma val;
9723 1.8 christos Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9724 1.8 christos
9725 1.8 christos if (!get_sym_h (NULL, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
9726 1.8 christos lplt - local_plt, ibfd))
9727 1.8 christos {
9728 1.8 christos if (local_syms != NULL
9729 1.8 christos && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9730 1.8 christos free (local_syms);
9731 1.8 christos return FALSE;
9732 1.8 christos }
9733 1.8 christos
9734 1.8 christos val = sym->st_value;
9735 1.8 christos if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
9736 1.8 christos val += sym_sec->output_offset + sym_sec->output_section->vma;
9737 1.8 christos
9738 1.8 christos if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9739 1.8 christos {
9740 1.8 christos htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9741 1.8 christos plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9742 1.8 christos relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
9743 1.8 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
9744 1.8 christos }
9745 1.8 christos else
9746 1.8 christos {
9747 1.8 christos plt = htab->pltlocal;
9748 1.8 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9749 1.8 christos {
9750 1.8 christos relplt = htab->relpltlocal;
9751 1.8 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
9752 1.8 christos }
9753 1.8 christos else
9754 1.8 christos {
9755 1.8 christos loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
9756 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val, loc);
9757 1.8 christos continue;
9758 1.8 christos }
9759 1.8 christos }
9760 1.8 christos
9761 1.8 christos rela.r_offset = (ent->plt.offset
9762 1.8 christos + plt->output_offset
9763 1.8 christos + plt->output_section->vma);
9764 1.8 christos rela.r_addend = val;
9765 1.8 christos loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
9766 1.8 christos * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9767 1.8 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9768 1.8 christos }
9769 1.8 christos if ((ent->glink_offset & 1) == 0)
9770 1.8 christos {
9771 1.8 christos unsigned char *p = ((unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents
9772 1.8 christos + ent->glink_offset);
9773 1.8 christos
9774 1.8 christos write_glink_stub (NULL, ent, htab->elf.iplt, p, info);
9775 1.8 christos ent->glink_offset |= 1;
9776 1.8 christos }
9777 1.8 christos }
9778 1.8 christos
9779 1.8 christos if (local_syms != NULL
9780 1.8 christos && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9781 1.8 christos {
9782 1.8 christos if (!info->keep_memory)
9783 1.8 christos free (local_syms);
9784 1.8 christos else
9785 1.8 christos symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
9786 1.8 christos }
9787 1.8 christos }
9788 1.8 christos return TRUE;
9789 1.8 christos }
9790 1.8 christos
9791 1.8 christos /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling. We set the contents of various
9792 1.8 christos dynamic sections here. */
9793 1.8 christos
9794 1.8 christos static bfd_boolean
9795 1.8 christos ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
9796 1.8 christos struct bfd_link_info *info,
9797 1.8 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
9798 1.8 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
9799 1.8 christos {
9800 1.8 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9801 1.8 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
9802 1.8 christos
9803 1.8 christos #ifdef DEBUG
9804 1.8 christos fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol called for %s",
9805 1.8 christos h->root.root.string);
9806 1.8 christos #endif
9807 1.8 christos
9808 1.8 christos if (!h->def_regular
9809 1.8 christos || (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && !bfd_link_pic (info)))
9810 1.8 christos for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9811 1.8 christos if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9812 1.8 christos {
9813 1.8 christos if (!h->def_regular)
9814 1.8 christos {
9815 1.8 christos /* Mark the symbol as undefined, rather than as
9816 1.8 christos defined in the .plt section. Leave the value if
9817 1.8 christos there were any relocations where pointer equality
9818 1.8 christos matters (this is a clue for the dynamic linker, to
9819 1.8 christos make function pointer comparisons work between an
9820 1.8 christos application and shared library), otherwise set it
9821 1.8 christos to zero. */
9822 1.8 christos sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
9823 1.8 christos if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
9824 1.8 christos sym->st_value = 0;
9825 1.8 christos else if (!h->ref_regular_nonweak)
9826 1.8 christos {
9827 1.8 christos /* This breaks function pointer comparisons, but
9828 1.8 christos that is better than breaking tests for a NULL
9829 1.8 christos function pointer. */
9830 1.8 christos sym->st_value = 0;
9831 1.8 christos }
9832 1.8 christos }
9833 1.8 christos else
9834 1.1 christos {
9835 1.1 christos /* Set the value of ifunc symbols in a non-pie
9836 1.1 christos executable to the glink entry. This is to avoid
9837 1.1 christos text relocations. We can't do this for ifunc in
9838 1.1 christos allocate_dynrelocs, as we do for normal dynamic
9839 1.1 christos function symbols with plt entries, because we need
9840 1.1 christos to keep the original value around for the ifunc
9841 1.1 christos relocation. */
9842 1.1 christos sym->st_shndx
9843 1.1 christos = (_bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
9844 1.1 christos (info->output_bfd, htab->glink->output_section));
9845 1.1 christos sym->st_value = (ent->glink_offset
9846 1.1 christos + htab->glink->output_offset
9847 1.1 christos + htab->glink->output_section->vma);
9848 1.1 christos }
9849 1.1 christos break;
9850 1.1 christos }
9851 1.7 christos
9852 1.7 christos if (h->needs_copy)
9853 1.1 christos {
9854 1.7 christos asection *s;
9855 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9856 1.1 christos bfd_byte *loc;
9857 1.1 christos
9858 1.1 christos /* This symbols needs a copy reloc. Set it up. */
9859 1.1 christos
9860 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
9861 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, ", copy");
9862 1.1 christos #endif
9863 1.1 christos
9864 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
9865 1.1 christos
9866 1.1 christos if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
9867 1.1 christos s = htab->relsbss;
9868 1.1 christos else if (h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
9869 1.1 christos s = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
9870 1.1 christos else
9871 1.1 christos s = htab->elf.srelbss;
9872 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
9873 1.1 christos
9874 1.1 christos rela.r_offset = SYM_VAL (h);
9875 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_COPY);
9876 1.1 christos rela.r_addend = 0;
9877 1.1 christos loc = s->contents + s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9878 1.7 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9879 1.1 christos }
9880 1.1 christos
9881 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
9882 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9883 1.1 christos #endif
9884 1.1 christos
9885 1.1 christos return TRUE;
9886 1.1 christos }
9887 1.1 christos
9888 1.1 christos static enum elf_reloc_type_class
9890 1.1 christos ppc_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info,
9891 1.1 christos const asection *rel_sec,
9892 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela)
9893 1.1 christos {
9894 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9895 1.1 christos
9896 1.1 christos if (rel_sec == htab->elf.irelplt)
9897 1.1 christos return reloc_class_ifunc;
9898 1.1 christos
9899 1.1 christos switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rela->r_info))
9900 1.1 christos {
9901 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
9902 1.1 christos return reloc_class_relative;
9903 1.1 christos case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
9904 1.1 christos return reloc_class_plt;
9905 1.1 christos case R_PPC_COPY:
9906 1.1 christos return reloc_class_copy;
9907 1.1 christos default:
9908 1.1 christos return reloc_class_normal;
9909 1.1 christos }
9910 1.1 christos }
9911 1.7 christos
9912 1.1 christos /* Finish up the dynamic sections. */
9914 1.1 christos
9915 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
9916 1.1 christos ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
9917 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info)
9918 1.1 christos {
9919 1.1 christos asection *sdyn;
9920 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9921 1.1 christos bfd_vma got;
9922 1.7 christos bfd *dynobj;
9923 1.1 christos bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
9924 1.1 christos
9925 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
9926 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections called\n");
9927 1.1 christos #endif
9928 1.1 christos
9929 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9930 1.1 christos dynobj = htab->elf.dynobj;
9931 1.1 christos sdyn = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".dynamic");
9932 1.1 christos
9933 1.1 christos got = 0;
9934 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
9935 1.1 christos got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9936 1.1 christos
9937 1.7 christos if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
9938 1.1 christos {
9939 1.7 christos Elf32_External_Dyn *dyncon, *dynconend;
9940 1.1 christos
9941 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.splt != NULL && sdyn != NULL);
9942 1.1 christos
9943 1.1 christos dyncon = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) sdyn->contents;
9944 1.7 christos dynconend = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) (sdyn->contents + sdyn->size);
9945 1.1 christos for (; dyncon < dynconend; dyncon++)
9946 1.1 christos {
9947 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
9948 1.7 christos asection *s;
9949 1.1 christos
9950 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_in (dynobj, dyncon, &dyn);
9951 1.1 christos
9952 1.1 christos switch (dyn.d_tag)
9953 1.1 christos {
9954 1.1 christos case DT_PLTGOT:
9955 1.1 christos if (htab->is_vxworks)
9956 1.7 christos s = htab->elf.sgotplt;
9957 1.7 christos else
9958 1.7 christos s = htab->elf.splt;
9959 1.7 christos dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
9960 1.7 christos break;
9961 1.7 christos
9962 1.7 christos case DT_PLTRELSZ:
9963 1.7 christos dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->elf.srelplt->size;
9964 1.7 christos break;
9965 1.1 christos
9966 1.1 christos case DT_JMPREL:
9967 1.1 christos s = htab->elf.srelplt;
9968 1.1 christos dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
9969 1.1 christos break;
9970 1.1 christos
9971 1.1 christos case DT_PPC_GOT:
9972 1.1 christos dyn.d_un.d_ptr = got;
9973 1.1 christos break;
9974 1.1 christos
9975 1.1 christos case DT_TEXTREL:
9976 1.1 christos if (htab->local_ifunc_resolver)
9977 1.1 christos info->callbacks->einfo
9978 1.7 christos (_("%X%P: text relocations and GNU indirect "
9979 1.7 christos "functions will result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
9980 1.1 christos else if (htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver)
9981 1.7 christos info->callbacks->einfo
9982 1.7 christos (_("%P: warning: text relocations and GNU indirect "
9983 1.1 christos "functions may result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
9984 1.1 christos continue;
9985 1.1 christos
9986 1.1 christos default:
9987 1.1 christos if (htab->is_vxworks
9988 1.1 christos && elf_vxworks_finish_dynamic_entry (output_bfd, &dyn))
9989 1.1 christos break;
9990 1.1 christos continue;
9991 1.1 christos }
9992 1.1 christos
9993 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
9994 1.1 christos }
9995 1.1 christos }
9996 1.1 christos
9997 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
9998 1.1 christos && htab->elf.sgot->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
9999 1.1 christos {
10000 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgot
10001 1.1 christos || htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgotplt)
10002 1.1 christos {
10003 1.1 christos unsigned char *p = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->contents;
10004 1.1 christos
10005 1.1 christos p += htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
10006 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
10007 1.7 christos {
10008 1.8 christos /* Add a blrl instruction at _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_-4
10009 1.8 christos so that a function can easily find the address of
10010 1.8 christos _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
10011 1.8 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value - 4
10012 1.1 christos < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
10013 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0x4e800021, p - 4);
10014 1.1 christos }
10015 1.1 christos
10016 1.7 christos if (sdyn != NULL)
10017 1.1 christos {
10018 1.1 christos bfd_vma val = sdyn->output_section->vma + sdyn->output_offset;
10019 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value
10020 1.7 christos < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
10021 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, val, p);
10022 1.7 christos }
10023 1.7 christos }
10024 1.1 christos else
10025 1.7 christos {
10026 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
10027 1.6 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%s not defined in linker created %pA"),
10028 1.1 christos htab->elf.hgot->root.root.string,
10029 1.1 christos (htab->elf.sgotplt != NULL
10030 1.1 christos ? htab->elf.sgotplt : htab->elf.sgot));
10031 1.6 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
10032 1.1 christos ret = FALSE;
10033 1.1 christos }
10034 1.1 christos
10035 1.1 christos elf_section_data (htab->elf.sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize = 4;
10036 1.1 christos }
10037 1.1 christos
10038 1.1 christos /* Fill in the first entry in the VxWorks procedure linkage table. */
10039 1.1 christos if (htab->is_vxworks
10040 1.1 christos && htab->elf.splt != NULL
10041 1.1 christos && htab->elf.splt->size != 0
10042 1.1 christos && htab->elf.splt->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
10043 1.1 christos {
10044 1.1 christos asection *splt = htab->elf.splt;
10045 1.1 christos /* Use the right PLT. */
10046 1.1 christos const bfd_vma *plt_entry = (bfd_link_pic (info)
10047 1.1 christos ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
10048 1.1 christos : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry);
10049 1.1 christos
10050 1.1 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
10051 1.1 christos {
10052 1.6 christos bfd_vma got_value = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
10053 1.1 christos
10054 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_value),
10055 1.1 christos splt->contents + 0);
10056 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_value),
10057 1.1 christos splt->contents + 4);
10058 1.1 christos }
10059 1.1 christos else
10060 1.7 christos {
10061 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0], splt->contents + 0);
10062 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1], splt->contents + 4);
10063 1.1 christos }
10064 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], splt->contents + 8);
10065 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], splt->contents + 12);
10066 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], splt->contents + 16);
10067 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], splt->contents + 20);
10068 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], splt->contents + 24);
10069 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], splt->contents + 28);
10070 1.7 christos
10071 1.1 christos if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
10072 1.1 christos {
10073 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
10074 1.1 christos bfd_byte *loc;
10075 1.1 christos
10076 1.1 christos loc = htab->srelplt2->contents;
10077 1.1 christos
10078 1.1 christos /* Output the @ha relocation for the first instruction. */
10079 1.1 christos rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
10080 1.1 christos + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
10081 1.1 christos + 2);
10082 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
10083 1.1 christos rela.r_addend = 0;
10084 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
10085 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10086 1.1 christos
10087 1.1 christos /* Output the @l relocation for the second instruction. */
10088 1.1 christos rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
10089 1.1 christos + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
10090 1.1 christos + 6);
10091 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
10092 1.1 christos rela.r_addend = 0;
10093 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
10094 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10095 1.1 christos
10096 1.1 christos /* Fix up the remaining relocations. They may have the wrong
10097 1.1 christos symbol index for _G_O_T_ or _P_L_T_ depending on the order
10098 1.1 christos in which symbols were output. */
10099 1.1 christos while (loc < htab->srelplt2->contents + htab->srelplt2->size)
10100 1.1 christos {
10101 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
10102 1.1 christos
10103 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10104 1.1 christos rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
10105 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10106 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10107 1.1 christos
10108 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10109 1.1 christos rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
10110 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10111 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10112 1.1 christos
10113 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10114 1.1 christos rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx, R_PPC_ADDR32);
10115 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10116 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10117 1.1 christos }
10118 1.1 christos }
10119 1.1 christos }
10120 1.1 christos
10121 1.1 christos if (htab->glink != NULL
10122 1.1 christos && htab->glink->contents != NULL
10123 1.1 christos && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
10124 1.1 christos {
10125 1.1 christos unsigned char *p;
10126 1.1 christos unsigned char *endp;
10127 1.1 christos bfd_vma res0;
10128 1.1 christos
10129 1.1 christos /*
10130 1.1 christos * PIC glink code is the following:
10131 1.1 christos *
10132 1.1 christos * # ith PLT code stub.
10133 1.1 christos * addis 11,30,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@ha
10134 1.1 christos * lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@l(11)
10135 1.1 christos * mtctr 11
10136 1.1 christos * bctr
10137 1.8 christos *
10138 1.1 christos * # A table of branches, one for each plt entry.
10139 1.8 christos * # The idea is that the plt call stub loads ctr and r11 with these
10140 1.8 christos * # addresses, so (r11 - res_0) gives the plt index * 4.
10141 1.1 christos * res_0: b PLTresolve
10142 1.1 christos * res_1: b PLTresolve
10143 1.8 christos * .
10144 1.1 christos * # Some number of entries towards the end can be nops
10145 1.8 christos * res_n_m3: nop
10146 1.1 christos * res_n_m2: nop
10147 1.1 christos * res_n_m1:
10148 1.1 christos *
10149 1.1 christos * PLTresolve:
10150 1.1 christos * addis 11,11,(1f-res_0)@ha
10151 1.1 christos * mflr 0
10152 1.1 christos * bcl 20,31,1f
10153 1.1 christos * 1: addi 11,11,(1b-res_0)@l
10154 1.1 christos * mflr 12
10155 1.1 christos * mtlr 0
10156 1.1 christos * sub 11,11,12 # r11 = index * 4
10157 1.1 christos * addis 12,12,(got+4-1b)@ha
10158 1.1 christos * lwz 0,(got+4-1b)@l(12) # got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
10159 1.8 christos * lwz 12,(got+8-1b)@l(12) # got[2] contains the map address
10160 1.8 christos * mtctr 0
10161 1.1 christos * add 0,11,11
10162 1.1 christos * add 11,0,11 # r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
10163 1.8 christos * bctr
10164 1.8 christos *
10165 1.1 christos * Non-PIC glink code is a little simpler.
10166 1.1 christos *
10167 1.1 christos * # ith PLT code stub.
10168 1.1 christos * lis 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@ha
10169 1.1 christos * lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@l(11)
10170 1.1 christos * mtctr 11
10171 1.1 christos * bctr
10172 1.1 christos *
10173 1.1 christos * The branch table is the same, then comes
10174 1.3 christos *
10175 1.1 christos * PLTresolve:
10176 1.1 christos * lis 12,(got+4)@ha
10177 1.1 christos * addis 11,11,(-res_0)@ha
10178 1.1 christos * lwz 0,(got+4)@l(12) # got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
10179 1.1 christos * addi 11,11,(-res_0)@l # r11 = index * 4
10180 1.1 christos * mtctr 0
10181 1.1 christos * add 0,11,11
10182 1.1 christos * lwz 12,(got+8)@l(12) # got[2] contains the map address
10183 1.1 christos * add 11,0,11 # r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
10184 1.1 christos * bctr
10185 1.1 christos */
10186 1.1 christos
10187 1.1 christos /* Build the branch table, one for each plt entry (less one),
10188 1.1 christos and perhaps some padding. */
10189 1.3 christos p = htab->glink->contents;
10190 1.3 christos p += htab->glink_pltresolve;
10191 1.3 christos endp = htab->glink->contents;
10192 1.3 christos endp += htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
10193 1.3 christos while (p < endp - (htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 0 : 8 * 4))
10194 1.3 christos {
10195 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B + endp - p, p);
10196 1.3 christos p += 4;
10197 1.3 christos }
10198 1.3 christos while (p < endp)
10199 1.3 christos {
10200 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
10201 1.3 christos p += 4;
10202 1.3 christos }
10203 1.3 christos
10204 1.3 christos res0 = (htab->glink_pltresolve
10205 1.3 christos + htab->glink->output_section->vma
10206 1.3 christos + htab->glink->output_offset);
10207 1.3 christos
10208 1.3 christos if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround)
10209 1.3 christos {
10210 1.3 christos /* Ensure that a call stub at the end of a page doesn't
10211 1.3 christos result in prefetch over the end of the page into the
10212 1.3 christos glink branch table. */
10213 1.3 christos bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
10214 1.3 christos bfd_vma page_addr;
10215 1.3 christos bfd_vma glink_start = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
10216 1.3 christos + htab->glink->output_offset);
10217 1.3 christos
10218 1.3 christos for (page_addr = res0 & -pagesize;
10219 1.3 christos page_addr > glink_start;
10220 1.3 christos page_addr -= pagesize)
10221 1.3 christos {
10222 1.1 christos /* We have a plt call stub that may need fixing. */
10223 1.8 christos bfd_byte *loc;
10224 1.6 christos unsigned int insn;
10225 1.1 christos
10226 1.1 christos loc = htab->glink->contents + page_addr - 4 - glink_start;
10227 1.1 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
10228 1.1 christos if (insn == BCTR)
10229 1.1 christos {
10230 1.1 christos /* By alignment, we know that there must be at least
10231 1.1 christos one other call stub before this one. */
10232 1.8 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc - 16);
10233 1.8 christos if (insn == BCTR)
10234 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-16 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
10235 1.8 christos else
10236 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-20 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
10237 1.8 christos }
10238 1.8 christos }
10239 1.8 christos }
10240 1.8 christos
10241 1.8 christos /* Last comes the PLTresolve stub. */
10242 1.8 christos endp = p + GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
10243 1.8 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
10244 1.8 christos {
10245 1.8 christos bfd_vma bcl;
10246 1.8 christos
10247 1.8 christos bcl = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 3*4
10248 1.1 christos + htab->glink->output_section->vma
10249 1.1 christos + htab->glink->output_offset);
10250 1.8 christos
10251 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (bcl - res0), p);
10252 1.8 christos p += 4;
10253 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_0, p);
10254 1.1 christos p += 4;
10255 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCL_20_31, p);
10256 1.1 christos p += 4;
10257 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (bcl - res0), p);
10258 1.8 christos p += 4;
10259 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_12, p);
10260 1.8 christos p += 4;
10261 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTLR_0, p);
10262 1.8 christos p += 4;
10263 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, SUB_11_11_12, p);
10264 1.8 christos p += 4;
10265 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_12_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10266 1.1 christos p += 4;
10267 1.1 christos if (PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl) == PPC_HA (got + 8 - bcl))
10268 1.8 christos {
10269 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10270 1.8 christos p += 4;
10271 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8 - bcl), p);
10272 1.8 christos p += 4;
10273 1.8 christos }
10274 1.8 christos else
10275 1.8 christos {
10276 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10277 1.8 christos p += 4;
10278 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
10279 1.8 christos p += 4;
10280 1.8 christos }
10281 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
10282 1.8 christos p += 4;
10283 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
10284 1.8 christos }
10285 1.1 christos else
10286 1.8 christos {
10287 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4), p);
10288 1.8 christos p += 4;
10289 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (-res0), p);
10290 1.8 christos p += 4;
10291 1.8 christos if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
10292 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
10293 1.8 christos else
10294 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
10295 1.8 christos p += 4;
10296 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (-res0), p);
10297 1.8 christos p += 4;
10298 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
10299 1.8 christos p += 4;
10300 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
10301 1.1 christos p += 4;
10302 1.1 christos if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
10303 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8), p);
10304 1.1 christos else
10305 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
10306 1.1 christos }
10307 1.1 christos p += 4;
10308 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_11_0_11, p);
10309 1.1 christos p += 4;
10310 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
10311 1.1 christos p += 4;
10312 1.1 christos while (p < endp)
10313 1.1 christos {
10314 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
10315 1.1 christos htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
10316 1.1 christos p += 4;
10317 1.1 christos }
10318 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (p == endp);
10319 1.1 christos }
10320 1.1 christos
10321 1.1 christos if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
10322 1.1 christos && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
10323 1.1 christos {
10324 1.1 christos unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
10325 1.1 christos bfd_vma val;
10326 1.1 christos
10327 1.1 christos p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
10328 1.1 christos /* FDE length. */
10329 1.1 christos p += 4;
10330 1.1 christos /* CIE pointer. */
10331 1.3 christos p += 4;
10332 1.1 christos /* Offset to .glink. */
10333 1.3 christos val = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
10334 1.1 christos + htab->glink->output_offset);
10335 1.1 christos val -= (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->vma
10336 1.1 christos + htab->glink_eh_frame->output_offset);
10337 1.1 christos val -= p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
10338 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
10339 1.3 christos
10340 1.8 christos if (htab->glink_eh_frame->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME
10341 1.1 christos && !_bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame (output_bfd, info,
10342 1.1 christos htab->glink_eh_frame,
10343 1.1 christos htab->glink_eh_frame->contents))
10344 1.1 christos return FALSE;
10345 1.1 christos }
10346 1.1 christos
10347 1.1 christos return ret;
10348 1.1 christos }
10349 1.1 christos
10350 1.1 christos #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM powerpc_elf32_le_vec
10352 1.7 christos #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME "elf32-powerpcle"
10353 1.1 christos #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_vec
10354 1.1 christos #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc"
10355 1.1 christos #define ELF_ARCH bfd_arch_powerpc
10356 1.3 christos #define ELF_TARGET_ID PPC32_ELF_DATA
10357 1.1 christos #define ELF_MACHINE_CODE EM_PPC
10358 1.1 christos #define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE 0x10000
10359 1.1 christos #define ELF_COMMONPAGESIZE 0x1000
10360 1.1 christos #define ELF_RELROPAGESIZE ELF_MAXPAGESIZE
10361 1.1 christos #define elf_info_to_howto ppc_elf_info_to_howto
10362 1.1 christos
10363 1.1 christos #ifdef EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
10364 1.1 christos #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT1 EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
10365 1.1 christos #endif
10366 1.1 christos
10367 1.1 christos #ifdef EM_PPC_OLD
10368 1.1 christos #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT2 EM_PPC_OLD
10369 1.1 christos #endif
10370 1.1 christos
10371 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 1
10372 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_want_dynrelro 1
10373 1.8 christos #define elf_backend_can_gc_sections 1
10374 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_can_refcount 1
10375 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_rela_normal 1
10376 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_caches_rawsize 1
10377 1.1 christos
10378 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_mkobject ppc_elf_mkobject
10379 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_merge_private_bfd_data ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data
10380 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_relax_section ppc_elf_relax_section
10381 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_type_lookup ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup
10382 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_name_lookup ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup
10383 1.8 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_set_private_flags ppc_elf_set_private_flags
10384 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create
10385 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab
10386 1.1 christos
10387 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_object_p ppc_elf_object_p
10388 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_gc_mark_hook ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook
10389 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_section_from_shdr ppc_elf_section_from_shdr
10390 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_relocate_section ppc_elf_relocate_section
10391 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_create_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections
10392 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_check_relocs ppc_elf_check_relocs
10393 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_relocs_compatible _bfd_elf_relocs_compatible
10394 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_copy_indirect_symbol ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol
10395 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_adjust_dynamic_symbol ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol
10396 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook
10397 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_size_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections
10398 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_hash_symbol ppc_elf_hash_symbol
10399 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_symbol ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol
10400 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections
10401 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_fake_sections ppc_elf_fake_sections
10402 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_additional_program_headers ppc_elf_additional_program_headers
10403 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_modify_segment_map ppc_elf_modify_segment_map
10404 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_grok_prstatus ppc_elf_grok_prstatus
10405 1.3 christos #define elf_backend_grok_psinfo ppc_elf_grok_psinfo
10406 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_write_core_note ppc_elf_write_core_note
10407 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_reloc_type_class ppc_elf_reloc_type_class
10408 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_begin_write_processing ppc_elf_begin_write_processing
10409 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_final_write_processing ppc_elf_final_write_processing
10410 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_write_section ppc_elf_write_section
10411 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr
10412 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_plt_sym_val ppc_elf_plt_sym_val
10413 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_action_discarded ppc_elf_action_discarded
10414 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_init_index_section _bfd_elf_init_1_index_section
10415 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_lookup_section_flags_hook ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags
10416 1.1 christos
10417 1.1 christos #include "elf32-target.h"
10418 1.1 christos
10419 1.1 christos /* FreeBSD Target */
10420 1.1 christos
10421 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
10422 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
10423 1.3 christos
10424 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
10425 1.1 christos #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_fbsd_vec
10426 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
10427 1.1 christos #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-freebsd"
10428 1.1 christos
10429 1.1 christos #undef ELF_OSABI
10430 1.1 christos #define ELF_OSABI ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
10431 1.7 christos
10432 1.1 christos #undef elf32_bed
10433 1.1 christos #define elf32_bed elf32_powerpc_fbsd_bed
10434 1.1 christos
10435 1.1 christos #include "elf32-target.h"
10436 1.1 christos
10437 1.1 christos /* VxWorks Target */
10438 1.1 christos
10439 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
10440 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
10441 1.1 christos
10442 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
10443 1.1 christos #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_vxworks_vec
10444 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
10445 1.1 christos #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-vxworks"
10446 1.1 christos
10447 1.1 christos #undef ELF_OSABI
10448 1.1 christos
10449 1.1 christos /* VxWorks uses the elf default section flags for .plt. */
10450 1.1 christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
10451 1.1 christos ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
10452 1.1 christos {
10453 1.8 christos if (sec->name == NULL)
10454 1.1 christos return NULL;
10455 1.1 christos
10456 1.1 christos if (strcmp (sec->name, ".plt") == 0)
10457 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
10458 1.1 christos
10459 1.1 christos return ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
10460 1.1 christos }
10461 1.1 christos
10462 1.1 christos /* Like ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create, but overrides
10463 1.1 christos appropriately for VxWorks. */
10464 1.1 christos static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
10465 1.1 christos ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
10466 1.1 christos {
10467 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_hash_table *ret;
10468 1.7 christos
10469 1.7 christos ret = ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (abfd);
10470 1.1 christos if (ret)
10471 1.1 christos {
10472 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab
10473 1.7 christos = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *)ret;
10474 1.7 christos htab->is_vxworks = 1;
10475 1.1 christos htab->plt_type = PLT_VXWORKS;
10476 1.1 christos htab->plt_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
10477 1.7 christos htab->plt_slot_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
10478 1.1 christos htab->plt_initial_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE;
10479 1.1 christos }
10480 1.1 christos return ret;
10481 1.1 christos }
10482 1.1 christos
10483 1.7 christos /* Tweak magic VxWorks symbols as they are loaded. */
10484 1.7 christos static bfd_boolean
10485 1.1 christos ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
10486 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info,
10487 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
10488 1.1 christos const char **namep,
10489 1.1 christos flagword *flagsp,
10490 1.1 christos asection **secp,
10491 1.1 christos bfd_vma *valp)
10492 1.1 christos {
10493 1.1 christos if (!elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp,
10494 1.1 christos valp))
10495 1.1 christos return FALSE;
10496 1.1 christos
10497 1.1 christos return ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp, valp);
10498 1.1 christos }
10499 1.1 christos
10500 1.1 christos static void
10501 1.7 christos ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean linker)
10502 1.7 christos {
10503 1.1 christos ppc_elf_final_write_processing (abfd, linker);
10504 1.1 christos elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (abfd, linker);
10505 1.1 christos }
10506 1.1 christos
10507 1.1 christos /* On VxWorks, we emit relocations against _PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_, so
10508 1.1 christos define it. */
10509 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_want_plt_sym
10510 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_want_plt_sym 1
10511 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_want_got_plt
10512 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_want_got_plt 1
10513 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_got_symbol_offset
10514 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_got_symbol_offset 0
10515 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_plt_not_loaded
10516 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 0
10517 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_plt_readonly
10518 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_plt_readonly 1
10519 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_got_header_size
10520 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_got_header_size 12
10521 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt
10522 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt 1
10523 1.1 christos
10524 1.1 christos #undef bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab
10525 1.1 christos
10526 1.1 christos #undef bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create
10527 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create \
10528 1.1 christos ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create
10529 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_add_symbol_hook
10530 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook \
10531 ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook
10532 #undef elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook
10533 #define elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook \
10534 elf_vxworks_link_output_symbol_hook
10535 #undef elf_backend_final_write_processing
10536 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing \
10537 ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing
10538 #undef elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr
10539 #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr \
10540 ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr
10541 #undef elf_backend_emit_relocs
10542 #define elf_backend_emit_relocs \
10543 elf_vxworks_emit_relocs
10544
10545 #undef elf32_bed
10546 #define elf32_bed ppc_elf_vxworks_bed
10547 #undef elf_backend_post_process_headers
10548
10549 #include "elf32-target.h"
10550